You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

25805 lines
687KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}@@@var{id}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program optionally followed by "@@@var{id}".
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{FILTER_NAME} ::= @var{NAME}["@@"@var{NAME}]
  173. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  174. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  175. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  176. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{FILTER_NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  177. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  178. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  179. @end example
  180. @anchor{filtergraph escaping}
  181. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  182. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  183. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  184. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  185. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  186. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  187. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  188. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  189. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  190. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  191. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  192. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  193. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  194. characters contained within it.
  195. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  196. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  197. @example
  198. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  199. @end example
  200. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  201. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  202. @example
  203. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  204. @end example
  205. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  206. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  207. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  208. @example
  209. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  210. @end example
  211. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  212. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  213. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  214. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  215. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  216. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  217. previous string will finally result in:
  218. @example
  219. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  220. @end example
  221. @chapter Timeline editing
  222. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  223. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  224. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  225. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  226. next filter in the filtergraph.
  227. The expression accepts the following values:
  228. @table @samp
  229. @item t
  230. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  231. @item n
  232. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  233. @item pos
  234. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  235. @item w
  236. @item h
  237. width and height of the input frame if video
  238. @end table
  239. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  240. to re-define the expression.
  241. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  242. rules.
  243. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  244. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  245. @example
  246. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  247. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  248. @end example
  249. See @code{ffmpeg -filters} to view which filters have timeline support.
  250. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  251. @anchor{commands}
  252. @chapter Changing options at runtime with a command
  253. Some options can be changed during the operation of the filter using
  254. a command. These options are marked 'T' on the output of
  255. @command{ffmpeg} @option{-h filter=<name of filter>}.
  256. The name of the command is the name of the option and the argument is
  257. the new value.
  258. @anchor{framesync}
  259. @chapter Options for filters with several inputs (framesync)
  260. @c man begin OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  261. Some filters with several inputs support a common set of options.
  262. These options can only be set by name, not with the short notation.
  263. @table @option
  264. @item eof_action
  265. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  266. one of the following values:
  267. @table @option
  268. @item repeat
  269. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  270. @item endall
  271. End both streams.
  272. @item pass
  273. Pass the main input through.
  274. @end table
  275. @item shortest
  276. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  277. terminates. Default value is 0.
  278. @item repeatlast
  279. If set to 1, force the filter to extend the last frame of secondary streams
  280. until the end of the primary stream. A value of 0 disables this behavior.
  281. Default value is 1.
  282. @end table
  283. @c man end OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  284. @chapter Audio Filters
  285. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  286. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  287. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  288. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  289. build.
  290. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  291. @section acompressor
  292. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  293. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  294. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  295. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  296. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  297. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  298. but can also destroy a track completely).
  299. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  300. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  301. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  302. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  303. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  304. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  305. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  306. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  307. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  308. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  309. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  310. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  311. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  312. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  313. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  314. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  315. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  316. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  317. The filter accepts the following options:
  318. @table @option
  319. @item level_in
  320. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  321. @item mode
  322. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  323. Default is @code{downward}.
  324. @item threshold
  325. If a signal of stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  326. reduction.
  327. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  328. @item ratio
  329. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  330. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  331. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  332. @item attack
  333. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  334. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  335. @item release
  336. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  337. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  338. @item makeup
  339. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  340. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  341. @item knee
  342. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  343. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  344. @item link
  345. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  346. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  347. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  348. @item detection
  349. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  350. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  351. @item mix
  352. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  353. Range is between 0 and 1.
  354. @end table
  355. @subsection Commands
  356. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  357. @section acontrast
  358. Simple audio dynamic range compression/expansion filter.
  359. The filter accepts the following options:
  360. @table @option
  361. @item contrast
  362. Set contrast. Default is 33. Allowed range is between 0 and 100.
  363. @end table
  364. @section acopy
  365. Copy the input audio source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  366. testing purposes.
  367. @section acrossfade
  368. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  369. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  370. The filter accepts the following options:
  371. @table @option
  372. @item nb_samples, ns
  373. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  374. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  375. silent. Default is 44100.
  376. @item duration, d
  377. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  378. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  379. for the accepted syntax.
  380. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  381. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  382. @item overlap, o
  383. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  384. @item curve1
  385. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  386. @item curve2
  387. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  388. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  389. @end table
  390. @subsection Examples
  391. @itemize
  392. @item
  393. Cross fade from one input to another:
  394. @example
  395. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  396. @end example
  397. @item
  398. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  399. @example
  400. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  401. @end example
  402. @end itemize
  403. @section acrossover
  404. Split audio stream into several bands.
  405. This filter splits audio stream into two or more frequency ranges.
  406. Summing all streams back will give flat output.
  407. The filter accepts the following options:
  408. @table @option
  409. @item split
  410. Set split frequencies. Those must be positive and increasing.
  411. @item order
  412. Set filter order, can be @var{2nd}, @var{4th} or @var{8th}.
  413. Default is @var{4th}.
  414. @end table
  415. @section acrusher
  416. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  417. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  418. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  419. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  420. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  421. This filter is able to even round to continuous values instead of discrete
  422. bit depths.
  423. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  424. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  425. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  426. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  427. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  428. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  429. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception,
  430. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  431. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  432. The filter accepts the following options:
  433. @table @option
  434. @item level_in
  435. Set level in.
  436. @item level_out
  437. Set level out.
  438. @item bits
  439. Set bit reduction.
  440. @item mix
  441. Set mixing amount.
  442. @item mode
  443. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  444. @item dc
  445. Set DC.
  446. @item aa
  447. Set anti-aliasing.
  448. @item samples
  449. Set sample reduction.
  450. @item lfo
  451. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  452. @item lforange
  453. Set LFO range.
  454. @item lforate
  455. Set LFO rate.
  456. @end table
  457. @section acue
  458. Delay audio filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. See the @ref{cue}
  459. filter.
  460. @section adeclick
  461. Remove impulsive noise from input audio.
  462. Samples detected as impulsive noise are replaced by interpolated samples using
  463. autoregressive modelling.
  464. @table @option
  465. @item w
  466. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to
  467. @code{100}. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  468. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  469. @item o
  470. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  471. @code{50} to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  472. Setting this to a very high value increases impulsive noise removal but makes
  473. whole process much slower.
  474. @item a
  475. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  476. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{2} percent. This option also
  477. controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  478. @item t
  479. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  480. Default value is @code{2}.
  481. This controls the strength of impulsive noise which is going to be removed.
  482. The lower value, the more samples will be detected as impulsive noise.
  483. @item b
  484. Set burst fusion, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is @code{0} to
  485. @code{10}. Default value is @code{2}.
  486. If any two samples detected as noise are spaced less than this value then any
  487. sample between those two samples will be also detected as noise.
  488. @item m
  489. Set overlap method.
  490. It accepts the following values:
  491. @table @option
  492. @item a
  493. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly
  494. changed with this method.
  495. @item s
  496. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  497. @end table
  498. Default value is @code{a}.
  499. @end table
  500. @section adeclip
  501. Remove clipped samples from input audio.
  502. Samples detected as clipped are replaced by interpolated samples using
  503. autoregressive modelling.
  504. @table @option
  505. @item w
  506. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to @code{100}.
  507. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  508. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  509. @item o
  510. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from @code{50}
  511. to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  512. @item a
  513. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  514. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{8} percent. This option also controls
  515. quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  516. @item t
  517. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  518. Default value is @code{10}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  519. @item n
  520. Set size of histogram used to detect clips. Allowed range is from @code{100} to @code{9999}.
  521. Default value is @code{1000}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  522. @item m
  523. Set overlap method.
  524. It accepts the following values:
  525. @table @option
  526. @item a
  527. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed
  528. with this method.
  529. @item s
  530. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  531. @end table
  532. Default value is @code{a}.
  533. @end table
  534. @section adelay
  535. Delay one or more audio channels.
  536. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  537. The filter accepts the following option:
  538. @table @option
  539. @item delays
  540. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  541. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  542. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  543. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  544. If you want instead to delay in seconds, append 's' to number.
  545. @item all
  546. Use last set delay for all remaining channels. By default is disabled.
  547. This option if enabled changes how option @code{delays} is interpreted.
  548. @end table
  549. @subsection Examples
  550. @itemize
  551. @item
  552. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  553. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  554. @example
  555. adelay=1500|0|500
  556. @end example
  557. @item
  558. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  559. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  560. @example
  561. adelay=0|500S|700S
  562. @end example
  563. @item
  564. Delay all channels by same number of samples:
  565. @example
  566. adelay=delays=64S:all=1
  567. @end example
  568. @end itemize
  569. @section aderivative, aintegral
  570. Compute derivative/integral of audio stream.
  571. Applying both filters one after another produces original audio.
  572. @section aecho
  573. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  574. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  575. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  576. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  577. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  578. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  579. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  580. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  581. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  582. @table @option
  583. @item in_gain
  584. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  585. @item out_gain
  586. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  587. @item delays
  588. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  589. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  590. Default is @code{1000}.
  591. @item decays
  592. Set list of loudness of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  593. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  594. Default is @code{0.5}.
  595. @end table
  596. @subsection Examples
  597. @itemize
  598. @item
  599. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  600. @example
  601. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  602. @end example
  603. @item
  604. If delay is very short, then it sounds like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  605. @example
  606. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  607. @end example
  608. @item
  609. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  610. @example
  611. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  612. @end example
  613. @item
  614. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  615. @example
  616. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  617. @end example
  618. @end itemize
  619. @section aemphasis
  620. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  621. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  622. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  623. this recording medium.
  624. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  625. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  626. The filter accepts the following options:
  627. @table @option
  628. @item level_in
  629. Set input gain.
  630. @item level_out
  631. Set output gain.
  632. @item mode
  633. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  634. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  635. @item type
  636. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  637. @table @option
  638. @item col
  639. select Columbia.
  640. @item emi
  641. select EMI.
  642. @item bsi
  643. select BSI (78RPM).
  644. @item riaa
  645. select RIAA.
  646. @item cd
  647. select Compact Disc (CD).
  648. @item 50fm
  649. select 50µs (FM).
  650. @item 75fm
  651. select 75µs (FM).
  652. @item 50kf
  653. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  654. @item 75kf
  655. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  656. @end table
  657. @end table
  658. @section aeval
  659. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  660. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  661. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  662. It accepts the following parameters:
  663. @table @option
  664. @item exprs
  665. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  666. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  667. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  668. output channels.
  669. @item channel_layout, c
  670. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  671. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  672. use by default the same input channel layout.
  673. @end table
  674. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  675. @table @option
  676. @item ch
  677. channel number of the current expression
  678. @item n
  679. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  680. @item s
  681. sample rate
  682. @item t
  683. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  684. @item nb_in_channels
  685. @item nb_out_channels
  686. input and output number of channels
  687. @item val(CH)
  688. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  689. @end table
  690. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  691. dedicated filter.
  692. @subsection Examples
  693. @itemize
  694. @item
  695. Half volume:
  696. @example
  697. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  698. @end example
  699. @item
  700. Invert phase of the second channel:
  701. @example
  702. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  703. @end example
  704. @end itemize
  705. @anchor{afade}
  706. @section afade
  707. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  708. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  709. @table @option
  710. @item type, t
  711. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  712. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  713. @item start_sample, ss
  714. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  715. effect. Default is 0.
  716. @item nb_samples, ns
  717. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  718. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  719. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  720. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  721. @item start_time, st
  722. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  723. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  724. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  725. for the accepted syntax.
  726. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  727. @item duration, d
  728. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  729. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  730. for the accepted syntax.
  731. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  732. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  733. the output audio will be silence.
  734. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  735. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  736. @item curve
  737. Set curve for fade transition.
  738. It accepts the following values:
  739. @table @option
  740. @item tri
  741. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  742. @item qsin
  743. select quarter of sine wave
  744. @item hsin
  745. select half of sine wave
  746. @item esin
  747. select exponential sine wave
  748. @item log
  749. select logarithmic
  750. @item ipar
  751. select inverted parabola
  752. @item qua
  753. select quadratic
  754. @item cub
  755. select cubic
  756. @item squ
  757. select square root
  758. @item cbr
  759. select cubic root
  760. @item par
  761. select parabola
  762. @item exp
  763. select exponential
  764. @item iqsin
  765. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  766. @item ihsin
  767. select inverted half of sine wave
  768. @item dese
  769. select double-exponential seat
  770. @item desi
  771. select double-exponential sigmoid
  772. @item losi
  773. select logistic sigmoid
  774. @item nofade
  775. no fade applied
  776. @end table
  777. @end table
  778. @subsection Examples
  779. @itemize
  780. @item
  781. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  782. @example
  783. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  784. @end example
  785. @item
  786. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  787. @example
  788. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  789. @end example
  790. @end itemize
  791. @section afftdn
  792. Denoise audio samples with FFT.
  793. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  794. @table @option
  795. @item nr
  796. Set the noise reduction in dB, allowed range is 0.01 to 97.
  797. Default value is 12 dB.
  798. @item nf
  799. Set the noise floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  800. Default value is -50 dB.
  801. @item nt
  802. Set the noise type.
  803. It accepts the following values:
  804. @table @option
  805. @item w
  806. Select white noise.
  807. @item v
  808. Select vinyl noise.
  809. @item s
  810. Select shellac noise.
  811. @item c
  812. Select custom noise, defined in @code{bn} option.
  813. Default value is white noise.
  814. @end table
  815. @item bn
  816. Set custom band noise for every one of 15 bands.
  817. Bands are separated by ' ' or '|'.
  818. @item rf
  819. Set the residual floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  820. Default value is -38 dB.
  821. @item tn
  822. Enable noise tracking. By default is disabled.
  823. With this enabled, noise floor is automatically adjusted.
  824. @item tr
  825. Enable residual tracking. By default is disabled.
  826. @item om
  827. Set the output mode.
  828. It accepts the following values:
  829. @table @option
  830. @item i
  831. Pass input unchanged.
  832. @item o
  833. Pass noise filtered out.
  834. @item n
  835. Pass only noise.
  836. Default value is @var{o}.
  837. @end table
  838. @end table
  839. @subsection Commands
  840. This filter supports the following commands:
  841. @table @option
  842. @item sample_noise, sn
  843. Start or stop measuring noise profile.
  844. Syntax for the command is : "start" or "stop" string.
  845. After measuring noise profile is stopped it will be
  846. automatically applied in filtering.
  847. @item noise_reduction, nr
  848. Change noise reduction. Argument is single float number.
  849. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_reduction}"
  850. @item noise_floor, nf
  851. Change noise floor. Argument is single float number.
  852. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_floor}"
  853. @item output_mode, om
  854. Change output mode operation.
  855. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  856. @end table
  857. @section afftfilt
  858. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  859. @table @option
  860. @item real
  861. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  862. by '|'. Default is "re".
  863. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  864. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  865. output channels.
  866. @item imag
  867. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  868. separated by '|'. Default is "im".
  869. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  870. constants and functions:
  871. @table @option
  872. @item sr
  873. sample rate
  874. @item b
  875. current frequency bin number
  876. @item nb
  877. number of available bins
  878. @item ch
  879. channel number of the current expression
  880. @item chs
  881. number of channels
  882. @item pts
  883. current frame pts
  884. @item re
  885. current real part of frequency bin of current channel
  886. @item im
  887. current imaginary part of frequency bin of current channel
  888. @item real(b, ch)
  889. Return the value of real part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  890. @item imag(b, ch)
  891. Return the value of imaginary part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  892. @end table
  893. @item win_size
  894. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 131072.
  895. Default is @code{4096}
  896. @item win_func
  897. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  898. @item overlap
  899. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  900. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  901. @end table
  902. @subsection Examples
  903. @itemize
  904. @item
  905. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  906. @example
  907. afftfilt="'real=re * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))':imag='im * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))'"
  908. @end example
  909. @item
  910. Apply robotize effect:
  911. @example
  912. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*sin(0)':imag='hypot(re,im)*cos(0)':win_size=512:overlap=0.75"
  913. @end example
  914. @item
  915. Apply whisper effect:
  916. @example
  917. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*cos((random(0)*2-1)*2*3.14)':imag='hypot(re,im)*sin((random(1)*2-1)*2*3.14)':win_size=128:overlap=0.8"
  918. @end example
  919. @end itemize
  920. @anchor{afir}
  921. @section afir
  922. Apply an arbitrary Finite Impulse Response filter.
  923. This filter is designed for applying long FIR filters,
  924. up to 60 seconds long.
  925. It can be used as component for digital crossover filters,
  926. room equalization, cross talk cancellation, wavefield synthesis,
  927. auralization, ambiophonics, ambisonics and spatialization.
  928. This filter uses the streams higher than first one as FIR coefficients.
  929. If the non-first stream holds a single channel, it will be used
  930. for all input channels in the first stream, otherwise
  931. the number of channels in the non-first stream must be same as
  932. the number of channels in the first stream.
  933. It accepts the following parameters:
  934. @table @option
  935. @item dry
  936. Set dry gain. This sets input gain.
  937. @item wet
  938. Set wet gain. This sets final output gain.
  939. @item length
  940. Set Impulse Response filter length. Default is 1, which means whole IR is processed.
  941. @item gtype
  942. Enable applying gain measured from power of IR.
  943. Set which approach to use for auto gain measurement.
  944. @table @option
  945. @item none
  946. Do not apply any gain.
  947. @item peak
  948. select peak gain, very conservative approach. This is default value.
  949. @item dc
  950. select DC gain, limited application.
  951. @item gn
  952. select gain to noise approach, this is most popular one.
  953. @end table
  954. @item irgain
  955. Set gain to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.
  956. Allowed range is 0 to 1. This gain is applied after any gain applied with @var{gtype} option.
  957. @item irfmt
  958. Set format of IR stream. Can be @code{mono} or @code{input}.
  959. Default is @code{input}.
  960. @item maxir
  961. Set max allowed Impulse Response filter duration in seconds. Default is 30 seconds.
  962. Allowed range is 0.1 to 60 seconds.
  963. @item response
  964. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  965. By default it is disabled.
  966. @item channel
  967. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  968. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  969. @item size
  970. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  971. @item rate
  972. Set video stream frame rate. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  973. @item minp
  974. Set minimal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  975. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32768}.
  976. Lower values decreases latency at cost of higher CPU usage.
  977. @item maxp
  978. Set maximal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  979. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  980. Lower values may increase CPU usage.
  981. @item nbirs
  982. Set number of input impulse responses streams which will be switchable at runtime.
  983. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32}. Default is @var{1}.
  984. @item ir
  985. Set IR stream which will be used for convolution, starting from @var{0}, should always be
  986. lower than supplied value by @code{nbirs} option. Default is @var{0}.
  987. This option can be changed at runtime via @ref{commands}.
  988. @end table
  989. @subsection Examples
  990. @itemize
  991. @item
  992. Apply reverb to stream using mono IR file as second input, complete command using ffmpeg:
  993. @example
  994. ffmpeg -i input.wav -i middle_tunnel_1way_mono.wav -lavfi afir output.wav
  995. @end example
  996. @end itemize
  997. @anchor{aformat}
  998. @section aformat
  999. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  1000. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  1001. It accepts the following parameters:
  1002. @table @option
  1003. @item sample_fmts, f
  1004. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  1005. @item sample_rates, r
  1006. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  1007. @item channel_layouts, cl
  1008. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  1009. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1010. for the required syntax.
  1011. @end table
  1012. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  1013. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  1014. @example
  1015. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  1016. @end example
  1017. @section agate
  1018. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  1019. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  1020. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  1021. and dividing it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  1022. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  1023. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  1024. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  1025. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  1026. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  1027. has to rise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  1028. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  1029. @table @option
  1030. @item level_in
  1031. Set input level before filtering.
  1032. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  1033. @item mode
  1034. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  1035. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  1036. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  1037. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  1038. @item range
  1039. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  1040. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1041. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  1042. @item threshold
  1043. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  1044. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1045. @item ratio
  1046. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced.
  1047. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  1048. @item attack
  1049. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  1050. reduction stops.
  1051. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1052. @item release
  1053. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  1054. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  1055. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1056. @item makeup
  1057. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  1058. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  1059. @item knee
  1060. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  1061. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  1062. @item detection
  1063. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  1064. Default is @code{rms}. Can be @code{peak} or @code{rms}.
  1065. @item link
  1066. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  1067. the reduction.
  1068. Default is @code{average}. Can be @code{average} or @code{maximum}.
  1069. @end table
  1070. @section aiir
  1071. Apply an arbitrary Infinite Impulse Response filter.
  1072. It accepts the following parameters:
  1073. @table @option
  1074. @item zeros, z
  1075. Set numerator/zeros coefficients.
  1076. @item poles, p
  1077. Set denominator/poles coefficients.
  1078. @item gains, k
  1079. Set channels gains.
  1080. @item dry_gain
  1081. Set input gain.
  1082. @item wet_gain
  1083. Set output gain.
  1084. @item format, f
  1085. Set coefficients format.
  1086. @table @samp
  1087. @item tf
  1088. digital transfer function
  1089. @item zp
  1090. Z-plane zeros/poles, cartesian (default)
  1091. @item pr
  1092. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar radians
  1093. @item pd
  1094. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar degrees
  1095. @item sp
  1096. S-plane zeros/poles
  1097. @end table
  1098. @item process, r
  1099. Set kind of processing.
  1100. Can be @code{d} - direct or @code{s} - serial cascading. Default is @code{s}.
  1101. @item precision, e
  1102. Set filtering precision.
  1103. @table @samp
  1104. @item dbl
  1105. double-precision floating-point (default)
  1106. @item flt
  1107. single-precision floating-point
  1108. @item i32
  1109. 32-bit integers
  1110. @item i16
  1111. 16-bit integers
  1112. @end table
  1113. @item normalize, n
  1114. Normalize filter coefficients, by default is enabled.
  1115. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  1116. @item mix
  1117. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1118. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1119. @item response
  1120. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  1121. By default it is disabled.
  1122. @item channel
  1123. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  1124. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1125. @item size
  1126. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1127. @end table
  1128. Coefficients in @code{tf} format are separated by spaces and are in ascending
  1129. order.
  1130. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are separated by spaces and order of coefficients
  1131. doesn't matter. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are complex numbers with @var{i}
  1132. imaginary unit.
  1133. Different coefficients and gains can be provided for every channel, in such case
  1134. use '|' to separate coefficients or gains. Last provided coefficients will be
  1135. used for all remaining channels.
  1136. @subsection Examples
  1137. @itemize
  1138. @item
  1139. Apply 2 pole elliptic notch at around 5000Hz for 48000 Hz sample rate:
  1140. @example
  1141. aiir=k=1:z=7.957584807809675810E-1 -2.575128568908332300 3.674839853930788710 -2.57512875289799137 7.957586296317130880E-1:p=1 -2.86950072432325953 3.63022088054647218 -2.28075678147272232 6.361362326477423500E-1:f=tf:r=d
  1142. @end example
  1143. @item
  1144. Same as above but in @code{zp} format:
  1145. @example
  1146. aiir=k=0.79575848078096756:z=0.80918701+0.58773007i 0.80918701-0.58773007i 0.80884700+0.58784055i 0.80884700-0.58784055i:p=0.63892345+0.59951235i 0.63892345-0.59951235i 0.79582691+0.44198673i 0.79582691-0.44198673i:f=zp:r=s
  1147. @end example
  1148. @end itemize
  1149. @section alimiter
  1150. The limiter prevents an input signal from rising over a desired threshold.
  1151. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  1152. It means that there is a small delay after the signal is processed. Keep in mind
  1153. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  1154. The filter accepts the following options:
  1155. @table @option
  1156. @item level_in
  1157. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  1158. @item level_out
  1159. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  1160. @item limit
  1161. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  1162. @item attack
  1163. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  1164. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  1165. @item release
  1166. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  1167. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  1168. @item asc
  1169. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  1170. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  1171. time.
  1172. @item asc_level
  1173. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  1174. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  1175. @item level
  1176. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  1177. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  1178. @end table
  1179. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  1180. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  1181. @section allpass
  1182. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  1183. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  1184. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  1185. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  1186. The filter accepts the following options:
  1187. @table @option
  1188. @item frequency, f
  1189. Set frequency in Hz.
  1190. @item width_type, t
  1191. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1192. @table @option
  1193. @item h
  1194. Hz
  1195. @item q
  1196. Q-Factor
  1197. @item o
  1198. octave
  1199. @item s
  1200. slope
  1201. @item k
  1202. kHz
  1203. @end table
  1204. @item width, w
  1205. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1206. @item mix, m
  1207. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1208. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1209. @item channels, c
  1210. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1211. @item normalize, n
  1212. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  1213. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  1214. @item order, o
  1215. Set the filter order, can be 1 or 2. Default is 2.
  1216. @end table
  1217. @subsection Commands
  1218. This filter supports the following commands:
  1219. @table @option
  1220. @item frequency, f
  1221. Change allpass frequency.
  1222. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1223. @item width_type, t
  1224. Change allpass width_type.
  1225. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1226. @item width, w
  1227. Change allpass width.
  1228. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1229. @item mix, m
  1230. Change allpass mix.
  1231. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1232. @end table
  1233. @section aloop
  1234. Loop audio samples.
  1235. The filter accepts the following options:
  1236. @table @option
  1237. @item loop
  1238. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  1239. Default is 0.
  1240. @item size
  1241. Set maximal number of samples. Default is 0.
  1242. @item start
  1243. Set first sample of loop. Default is 0.
  1244. @end table
  1245. @anchor{amerge}
  1246. @section amerge
  1247. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  1248. The filter accepts the following options:
  1249. @table @option
  1250. @item inputs
  1251. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  1252. @end table
  1253. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  1254. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  1255. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  1256. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  1257. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  1258. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  1259. channels.
  1260. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  1261. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  1262. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  1263. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  1264. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  1265. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  1266. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  1267. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  1268. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  1269. shortest.
  1270. @subsection Examples
  1271. @itemize
  1272. @item
  1273. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  1274. @example
  1275. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  1276. @end example
  1277. @item
  1278. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  1279. @example
  1280. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  1281. @end example
  1282. @end itemize
  1283. @section amix
  1284. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  1285. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  1286. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  1287. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  1288. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  1289. For example
  1290. @example
  1291. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  1292. @end example
  1293. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  1294. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  1295. It accepts the following parameters:
  1296. @table @option
  1297. @item inputs
  1298. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  1299. @item duration
  1300. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  1301. @table @option
  1302. @item longest
  1303. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  1304. @item shortest
  1305. The duration of the shortest input.
  1306. @item first
  1307. The duration of the first input.
  1308. @end table
  1309. @item dropout_transition
  1310. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  1311. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  1312. @item weights
  1313. Specify weight of each input audio stream as sequence.
  1314. Each weight is separated by space. By default all inputs have same weight.
  1315. @end table
  1316. @subsection Commands
  1317. This filter supports the following commands:
  1318. @table @option
  1319. @item weights
  1320. Syntax is same as option with same name.
  1321. @end table
  1322. @section amultiply
  1323. Multiply first audio stream with second audio stream and store result
  1324. in output audio stream. Multiplication is done by multiplying each
  1325. sample from first stream with sample at same position from second stream.
  1326. With this element-wise multiplication one can create amplitude fades and
  1327. amplitude modulations.
  1328. @section anequalizer
  1329. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  1330. It accepts the following parameters:
  1331. @table @option
  1332. @item params
  1333. This option string is in format:
  1334. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  1335. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  1336. @table @option
  1337. @item chn
  1338. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  1339. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  1340. @item f
  1341. Set central frequency for band.
  1342. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  1343. @item w
  1344. Set band width in hertz.
  1345. @item g
  1346. Set band gain in dB.
  1347. @item t
  1348. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  1349. @table @samp
  1350. @item 0
  1351. Butterworth, this is default.
  1352. @item 1
  1353. Chebyshev type 1.
  1354. @item 2
  1355. Chebyshev type 2.
  1356. @end table
  1357. @end table
  1358. @item curves
  1359. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  1360. in video stream.
  1361. @item size
  1362. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1363. @item mgain
  1364. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1365. Setting this to a reasonable value makes it possible to display gain which is derived from
  1366. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  1367. when both are activated.
  1368. @item fscale
  1369. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  1370. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  1371. @item colors
  1372. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  1373. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  1374. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  1375. @end table
  1376. @subsection Examples
  1377. @itemize
  1378. @item
  1379. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  1380. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  1381. @example
  1382. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  1383. @end example
  1384. @end itemize
  1385. @subsection Commands
  1386. This filter supports the following commands:
  1387. @table @option
  1388. @item change
  1389. Alter existing filter parameters.
  1390. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  1391. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  1392. error is returned.
  1393. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  1394. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  1395. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  1396. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  1397. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  1398. @end table
  1399. @section anlmdn
  1400. Reduce broadband noise in audio samples using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  1401. Each sample is adjusted by looking for other samples with similar contexts. This
  1402. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  1403. @option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r} around the sample.
  1404. The filter accepts the following options:
  1405. @table @option
  1406. @item s
  1407. Set denoising strength. Allowed range is from 0.00001 to 10. Default value is 0.00001.
  1408. @item p
  1409. Set patch radius duration. Allowed range is from 1 to 100 milliseconds.
  1410. Default value is 2 milliseconds.
  1411. @item r
  1412. Set research radius duration. Allowed range is from 2 to 300 milliseconds.
  1413. Default value is 6 milliseconds.
  1414. @item o
  1415. Set the output mode.
  1416. It accepts the following values:
  1417. @table @option
  1418. @item i
  1419. Pass input unchanged.
  1420. @item o
  1421. Pass noise filtered out.
  1422. @item n
  1423. Pass only noise.
  1424. Default value is @var{o}.
  1425. @end table
  1426. @item m
  1427. Set smooth factor. Default value is @var{11}. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{15}.
  1428. @end table
  1429. @subsection Commands
  1430. This filter supports the following commands:
  1431. @table @option
  1432. @item s
  1433. Change denoise strength. Argument is single float number.
  1434. Syntax for the command is : "@var{s}"
  1435. @item o
  1436. Change output mode.
  1437. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  1438. @end table
  1439. @section anlms
  1440. Apply Normalized Least-Mean-Squares algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.
  1441. This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by finding the filter coefficients that
  1442. relate to producing the least mean square of the error signal (difference between the desired,
  1443. 2nd input audio stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio stream).
  1444. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1445. @table @option
  1446. @item order
  1447. Set filter order.
  1448. @item mu
  1449. Set filter mu.
  1450. @item eps
  1451. Set the filter eps.
  1452. @item leakage
  1453. Set the filter leakage.
  1454. @item out_mode
  1455. It accepts the following values:
  1456. @table @option
  1457. @item i
  1458. Pass the 1st input.
  1459. @item d
  1460. Pass the 2nd input.
  1461. @item o
  1462. Pass filtered samples.
  1463. @item n
  1464. Pass difference between desired and filtered samples.
  1465. Default value is @var{o}.
  1466. @end table
  1467. @end table
  1468. @subsection Examples
  1469. @itemize
  1470. @item
  1471. One of many usages of this filter is noise reduction, input audio is filtered
  1472. with same samples that are delayed by fixed amount, one such example for stereo audio is:
  1473. @example
  1474. asplit[a][b],[a]adelay=32S|32S[a],[b][a]anlms=order=128:leakage=0.0005:mu=.5:out_mode=o
  1475. @end example
  1476. @end itemize
  1477. @subsection Commands
  1478. This filter supports the same commands as options, excluding option @code{order}.
  1479. @section anull
  1480. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  1481. @section apad
  1482. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  1483. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  1484. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  1485. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1486. @table @option
  1487. @item packet_size
  1488. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  1489. @item pad_len
  1490. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  1491. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  1492. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  1493. @item whole_len
  1494. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  1495. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  1496. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  1497. with @option{pad_len}.
  1498. @item pad_dur
  1499. Specify the duration of samples of silence to add. See
  1500. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1501. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value.
  1502. @item whole_dur
  1503. Specify the minimum total duration in the output audio stream. See
  1504. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1505. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value. If the value is longer than
  1506. the input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached.
  1507. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{pad_dur}
  1508. @end table
  1509. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} nor @option{pad_dur}
  1510. nor @option{whole_dur} option is set, the filter will add silence to the end of
  1511. the input stream indefinitely.
  1512. @subsection Examples
  1513. @itemize
  1514. @item
  1515. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  1516. @example
  1517. apad=pad_len=1024
  1518. @end example
  1519. @item
  1520. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1521. the input with silence if required:
  1522. @example
  1523. apad=whole_len=10000
  1524. @end example
  1525. @item
  1526. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1527. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1528. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1529. option:
  1530. @example
  1531. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1532. @end example
  1533. @end itemize
  1534. @section aphaser
  1535. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1536. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1537. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1538. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1539. @table @option
  1540. @item in_gain
  1541. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1542. @item out_gain
  1543. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1544. @item delay
  1545. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1546. @item decay
  1547. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1548. @item speed
  1549. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1550. @item type
  1551. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1552. It accepts the following values:
  1553. @table @samp
  1554. @item triangular, t
  1555. @item sinusoidal, s
  1556. @end table
  1557. @end table
  1558. @section apulsator
  1559. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1560. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1561. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1562. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1563. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1564. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1565. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1566. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1567. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1568. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1569. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1570. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1571. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1572. The filter accepts the following options:
  1573. @table @option
  1574. @item level_in
  1575. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1576. @item level_out
  1577. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1578. @item mode
  1579. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1580. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1581. @item amount
  1582. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1583. @item offset_l
  1584. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1585. @item offset_r
  1586. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1587. @item width
  1588. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1589. @item timing
  1590. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1591. @item bpm
  1592. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1593. is set to bpm.
  1594. @item ms
  1595. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1596. is set to ms.
  1597. @item hz
  1598. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1599. if timing is set to hz.
  1600. @end table
  1601. @anchor{aresample}
  1602. @section aresample
  1603. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1604. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1605. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1606. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1607. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1608. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1609. The filter accepts the syntax
  1610. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1611. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1612. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1613. @ref{Resampler Options,,"Resampler Options" section in the
  1614. ffmpeg-resampler(1) manual,ffmpeg-resampler}
  1615. for the complete list of supported options.
  1616. @subsection Examples
  1617. @itemize
  1618. @item
  1619. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1620. @example
  1621. aresample=44100
  1622. @end example
  1623. @item
  1624. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1625. samples per second compensation:
  1626. @example
  1627. aresample=async=1000
  1628. @end example
  1629. @end itemize
  1630. @section areverse
  1631. Reverse an audio clip.
  1632. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1633. is suggested.
  1634. @subsection Examples
  1635. @itemize
  1636. @item
  1637. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1638. @example
  1639. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1640. @end example
  1641. @end itemize
  1642. @section arnndn
  1643. Reduce noise from speech using Recurrent Neural Networks.
  1644. This filter accepts the following options:
  1645. @table @option
  1646. @item model, m
  1647. Set train model file to load. This option is always required.
  1648. @end table
  1649. @section asetnsamples
  1650. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1651. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1652. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1653. signals its end.
  1654. The filter accepts the following options:
  1655. @table @option
  1656. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1657. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1658. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1659. Default value is 1024.
  1660. @item pad, p
  1661. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1662. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1663. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1664. @end table
  1665. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1666. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1667. @example
  1668. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1669. @end example
  1670. @section asetrate
  1671. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1672. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1673. The filter accepts the following options:
  1674. @table @option
  1675. @item sample_rate, r
  1676. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1677. @end table
  1678. @section ashowinfo
  1679. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1680. The input audio is not modified.
  1681. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1682. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1683. The following values are shown in the output:
  1684. @table @option
  1685. @item n
  1686. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1687. @item pts
  1688. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1689. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1690. @item pts_time
  1691. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1692. @item pos
  1693. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1694. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1695. @item fmt
  1696. The sample format.
  1697. @item chlayout
  1698. The channel layout.
  1699. @item rate
  1700. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1701. @item nb_samples
  1702. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1703. @item checksum
  1704. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1705. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1706. @item plane_checksums
  1707. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1708. @end table
  1709. @section asoftclip
  1710. Apply audio soft clipping.
  1711. Soft clipping is a type of distortion effect where the amplitude of a signal is saturated
  1712. along a smooth curve, rather than the abrupt shape of hard-clipping.
  1713. This filter accepts the following options:
  1714. @table @option
  1715. @item type
  1716. Set type of soft-clipping.
  1717. It accepts the following values:
  1718. @table @option
  1719. @item tanh
  1720. @item atan
  1721. @item cubic
  1722. @item exp
  1723. @item alg
  1724. @item quintic
  1725. @item sin
  1726. @end table
  1727. @item param
  1728. Set additional parameter which controls sigmoid function.
  1729. @end table
  1730. @subsection Commands
  1731. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  1732. @section asr
  1733. Automatic Speech Recognition
  1734. This filter uses PocketSphinx for speech recognition. To enable
  1735. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  1736. @code{--enable-pocketsphinx}.
  1737. It accepts the following options:
  1738. @table @option
  1739. @item rate
  1740. Set sampling rate of input audio. Defaults is @code{16000}.
  1741. This need to match speech models, otherwise one will get poor results.
  1742. @item hmm
  1743. Set dictionary containing acoustic model files.
  1744. @item dict
  1745. Set pronunciation dictionary.
  1746. @item lm
  1747. Set language model file.
  1748. @item lmctl
  1749. Set language model set.
  1750. @item lmname
  1751. Set which language model to use.
  1752. @item logfn
  1753. Set output for log messages.
  1754. @end table
  1755. The filter exports recognized speech as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.asr.text}.
  1756. @anchor{astats}
  1757. @section astats
  1758. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1759. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1760. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1761. It accepts the following option:
  1762. @table @option
  1763. @item length
  1764. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1765. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 10]}.
  1766. @item metadata
  1767. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1768. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1769. disabled.
  1770. Available keys for each channel are:
  1771. DC_offset
  1772. Min_level
  1773. Max_level
  1774. Min_difference
  1775. Max_difference
  1776. Mean_difference
  1777. RMS_difference
  1778. Peak_level
  1779. RMS_peak
  1780. RMS_trough
  1781. Crest_factor
  1782. Flat_factor
  1783. Peak_count
  1784. Noise_floor
  1785. Noise_floor_count
  1786. Bit_depth
  1787. Dynamic_range
  1788. Zero_crossings
  1789. Zero_crossings_rate
  1790. Number_of_NaNs
  1791. Number_of_Infs
  1792. Number_of_denormals
  1793. and for Overall:
  1794. DC_offset
  1795. Min_level
  1796. Max_level
  1797. Min_difference
  1798. Max_difference
  1799. Mean_difference
  1800. RMS_difference
  1801. Peak_level
  1802. RMS_level
  1803. RMS_peak
  1804. RMS_trough
  1805. Flat_factor
  1806. Peak_count
  1807. Noise_floor
  1808. Noise_floor_count
  1809. Bit_depth
  1810. Number_of_samples
  1811. Number_of_NaNs
  1812. Number_of_Infs
  1813. Number_of_denormals
  1814. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1815. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1816. For description what each key means read below.
  1817. @item reset
  1818. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1819. Default is disabled.
  1820. @item measure_perchannel
  1821. Select the entries which need to be measured per channel. The metadata keys can
  1822. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1823. @option{none} disables all per channel measurement.
  1824. @item measure_overall
  1825. Select the entries which need to be measured overall. The metadata keys can
  1826. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1827. @option{none} disables all overall measurement.
  1828. @end table
  1829. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1830. @table @option
  1831. @item DC offset
  1832. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1833. @item Min level
  1834. Minimal sample level.
  1835. @item Max level
  1836. Maximal sample level.
  1837. @item Min difference
  1838. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1839. @item Max difference
  1840. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1841. @item Mean difference
  1842. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1843. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1844. @item RMS difference
  1845. Root Mean Square difference between two consecutive samples.
  1846. @item Peak level dB
  1847. @item RMS level dB
  1848. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1849. @item RMS peak dB
  1850. @item RMS trough dB
  1851. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1852. @item Crest factor
  1853. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1854. @item Flat factor
  1855. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1856. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1857. @item Peak count
  1858. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1859. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1860. @item Noise floor dB
  1861. Minimum local peak measured in dBFS over a short window.
  1862. @item Noise floor count
  1863. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained
  1864. @var{Noise floor}.
  1865. @item Bit depth
  1866. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1867. @item Dynamic range
  1868. Measured dynamic range of audio in dB.
  1869. @item Zero crossings
  1870. Number of points where the waveform crosses the zero level axis.
  1871. @item Zero crossings rate
  1872. Rate of Zero crossings and number of audio samples.
  1873. @end table
  1874. @section asubboost
  1875. Boost subwoofer frequencies.
  1876. The filter accepts the following options:
  1877. @table @option
  1878. @item dry
  1879. Set dry gain, how much of original signal is kept. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1880. Default value is 0.5.
  1881. @item wet
  1882. Set wet gain, how much of filtered signal is kept. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1883. Default value is 0.8.
  1884. @item decay
  1885. Set delay line decay gain value. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1886. Default value is 0.7.
  1887. @item feedback
  1888. Set delay line feedback gain value. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1889. Default value is 0.5.
  1890. @item cutoff
  1891. Set cutoff frequency in herz. Allowed range is 50 to 900.
  1892. Default value is 100.
  1893. @item slope
  1894. Set slope amount for cutoff frequency. Allowed range is 0.0001 to 1.
  1895. Default value is 0.5.
  1896. @item delay
  1897. Set delay. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  1898. Default value is 20.
  1899. @end table
  1900. @subsection Commands
  1901. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  1902. @section atempo
  1903. Adjust audio tempo.
  1904. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1905. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1906. be in the [0.5, 100.0] range.
  1907. Note that tempo greater than 2 will skip some samples rather than
  1908. blend them in. If for any reason this is a concern it is always
  1909. possible to daisy-chain several instances of atempo to achieve the
  1910. desired product tempo.
  1911. @subsection Examples
  1912. @itemize
  1913. @item
  1914. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1915. @example
  1916. atempo=0.8
  1917. @end example
  1918. @item
  1919. To speed up audio to 300% tempo:
  1920. @example
  1921. atempo=3
  1922. @end example
  1923. @item
  1924. To speed up audio to 300% tempo by daisy-chaining two atempo instances:
  1925. @example
  1926. atempo=sqrt(3),atempo=sqrt(3)
  1927. @end example
  1928. @end itemize
  1929. @subsection Commands
  1930. This filter supports the following commands:
  1931. @table @option
  1932. @item tempo
  1933. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  1934. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  1935. @end table
  1936. @section atrim
  1937. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1938. It accepts the following parameters:
  1939. @table @option
  1940. @item start
  1941. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1942. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1943. @item end
  1944. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1945. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1946. the last sample in the output.
  1947. @item start_pts
  1948. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1949. instead of seconds.
  1950. @item end_pts
  1951. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1952. of seconds.
  1953. @item duration
  1954. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1955. @item start_sample
  1956. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1957. @item end_sample
  1958. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1959. @end table
  1960. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1961. duration specifications; see
  1962. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1963. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1964. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1965. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1966. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1967. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1968. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1969. atrim filter.
  1970. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1971. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1972. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1973. filters.
  1974. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1975. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1976. Examples:
  1977. @itemize
  1978. @item
  1979. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1980. @example
  1981. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1982. @end example
  1983. @item
  1984. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1985. @example
  1986. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1987. @end example
  1988. @end itemize
  1989. @section axcorrelate
  1990. Calculate normalized cross-correlation between two input audio streams.
  1991. Resulted samples are always between -1 and 1 inclusive.
  1992. If result is 1 it means two input samples are highly correlated in that selected segment.
  1993. Result 0 means they are not correlated at all.
  1994. If result is -1 it means two input samples are out of phase, which means they cancel each
  1995. other.
  1996. The filter accepts the following options:
  1997. @table @option
  1998. @item size
  1999. Set size of segment over which cross-correlation is calculated.
  2000. Default is 256. Allowed range is from 2 to 131072.
  2001. @item algo
  2002. Set algorithm for cross-correlation. Can be @code{slow} or @code{fast}.
  2003. Default is @code{slow}. Fast algorithm assumes mean values over any given segment
  2004. are always zero and thus need much less calculations to make.
  2005. This is generally not true, but is valid for typical audio streams.
  2006. @end table
  2007. @subsection Examples
  2008. @itemize
  2009. @item
  2010. Calculate correlation between channels in stereo audio stream:
  2011. @example
  2012. ffmpeg -i stereo.wav -af channelsplit,axcorrelate=size=1024:algo=fast correlation.wav
  2013. @end example
  2014. @end itemize
  2015. @section bandpass
  2016. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  2017. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  2018. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  2019. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  2020. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  2021. The filter accepts the following options:
  2022. @table @option
  2023. @item frequency, f
  2024. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  2025. @item csg
  2026. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  2027. @item width_type, t
  2028. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2029. @table @option
  2030. @item h
  2031. Hz
  2032. @item q
  2033. Q-Factor
  2034. @item o
  2035. octave
  2036. @item s
  2037. slope
  2038. @item k
  2039. kHz
  2040. @end table
  2041. @item width, w
  2042. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2043. @item mix, m
  2044. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2045. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2046. @item channels, c
  2047. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2048. @item normalize, n
  2049. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2050. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2051. @end table
  2052. @subsection Commands
  2053. This filter supports the following commands:
  2054. @table @option
  2055. @item frequency, f
  2056. Change bandpass frequency.
  2057. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2058. @item width_type, t
  2059. Change bandpass width_type.
  2060. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2061. @item width, w
  2062. Change bandpass width.
  2063. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2064. @item mix, m
  2065. Change bandpass mix.
  2066. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2067. @end table
  2068. @section bandreject
  2069. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  2070. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  2071. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  2072. The filter accepts the following options:
  2073. @table @option
  2074. @item frequency, f
  2075. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  2076. @item width_type, t
  2077. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2078. @table @option
  2079. @item h
  2080. Hz
  2081. @item q
  2082. Q-Factor
  2083. @item o
  2084. octave
  2085. @item s
  2086. slope
  2087. @item k
  2088. kHz
  2089. @end table
  2090. @item width, w
  2091. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2092. @item mix, m
  2093. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2094. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2095. @item channels, c
  2096. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2097. @item normalize, n
  2098. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2099. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2100. @end table
  2101. @subsection Commands
  2102. This filter supports the following commands:
  2103. @table @option
  2104. @item frequency, f
  2105. Change bandreject frequency.
  2106. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2107. @item width_type, t
  2108. Change bandreject width_type.
  2109. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2110. @item width, w
  2111. Change bandreject width.
  2112. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2113. @item mix, m
  2114. Change bandreject mix.
  2115. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2116. @end table
  2117. @section bass, lowshelf
  2118. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2119. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2120. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2121. The filter accepts the following options:
  2122. @table @option
  2123. @item gain, g
  2124. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  2125. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  2126. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2127. @item frequency, f
  2128. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2129. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2130. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  2131. @item width_type, t
  2132. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2133. @table @option
  2134. @item h
  2135. Hz
  2136. @item q
  2137. Q-Factor
  2138. @item o
  2139. octave
  2140. @item s
  2141. slope
  2142. @item k
  2143. kHz
  2144. @end table
  2145. @item width, w
  2146. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2147. @item mix, m
  2148. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2149. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2150. @item channels, c
  2151. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2152. @item normalize, n
  2153. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2154. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2155. @end table
  2156. @subsection Commands
  2157. This filter supports the following commands:
  2158. @table @option
  2159. @item frequency, f
  2160. Change bass frequency.
  2161. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2162. @item width_type, t
  2163. Change bass width_type.
  2164. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2165. @item width, w
  2166. Change bass width.
  2167. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2168. @item gain, g
  2169. Change bass gain.
  2170. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2171. @item mix, m
  2172. Change bass mix.
  2173. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2174. @end table
  2175. @section biquad
  2176. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  2177. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  2178. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  2179. and @var{channels}, @var{c} specify which channels to filter, by default all
  2180. available are filtered.
  2181. @subsection Commands
  2182. This filter supports the following commands:
  2183. @table @option
  2184. @item a0
  2185. @item a1
  2186. @item a2
  2187. @item b0
  2188. @item b1
  2189. @item b2
  2190. Change biquad parameter.
  2191. Syntax for the command is : "@var{value}"
  2192. @item mix, m
  2193. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2194. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2195. @item channels, c
  2196. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2197. @item normalize, n
  2198. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2199. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2200. @end table
  2201. @section bs2b
  2202. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  2203. stereo audio records.
  2204. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2205. @code{--enable-libbs2b}.
  2206. It accepts the following parameters:
  2207. @table @option
  2208. @item profile
  2209. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  2210. @table @option
  2211. @item default
  2212. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  2213. @item cmoy
  2214. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  2215. @item jmeier
  2216. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  2217. @end table
  2218. @item fcut
  2219. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  2220. @item feed
  2221. Feed level (in Hz).
  2222. @end table
  2223. @section channelmap
  2224. Remap input channels to new locations.
  2225. It accepts the following parameters:
  2226. @table @option
  2227. @item map
  2228. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2229. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  2230. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  2231. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  2232. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  2233. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  2234. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  2235. @item channel_layout
  2236. The channel layout of the output stream.
  2237. @end table
  2238. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  2239. output channels, preserving indices.
  2240. @subsection Examples
  2241. @itemize
  2242. @item
  2243. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  2244. @example
  2245. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  2246. @end example
  2247. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  2248. the input.
  2249. @item
  2250. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  2251. @example
  2252. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  2253. @end example
  2254. @end itemize
  2255. @section channelsplit
  2256. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  2257. It accepts the following parameters:
  2258. @table @option
  2259. @item channel_layout
  2260. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  2261. @item channels
  2262. A channel layout describing the channels to be extracted as separate output streams
  2263. or "all" to extract each input channel as a separate stream. The default is "all".
  2264. Choosing channels not present in channel layout in the input will result in an error.
  2265. @end table
  2266. @subsection Examples
  2267. @itemize
  2268. @item
  2269. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  2270. @example
  2271. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  2272. @end example
  2273. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  2274. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  2275. @item
  2276. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  2277. @example
  2278. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  2279. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  2280. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  2281. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  2282. side_right.wav
  2283. @end example
  2284. @item
  2285. Extract only LFE from a 5.1 WAV file:
  2286. @example
  2287. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1:channels=LFE[LFE]'
  2288. -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav
  2289. @end example
  2290. @end itemize
  2291. @section chorus
  2292. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  2293. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  2294. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  2295. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  2296. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  2297. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  2298. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  2299. off key.
  2300. It accepts the following parameters:
  2301. @table @option
  2302. @item in_gain
  2303. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  2304. @item out_gain
  2305. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  2306. @item delays
  2307. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  2308. @item decays
  2309. Set decays.
  2310. @item speeds
  2311. Set speeds.
  2312. @item depths
  2313. Set depths.
  2314. @end table
  2315. @subsection Examples
  2316. @itemize
  2317. @item
  2318. A single delay:
  2319. @example
  2320. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  2321. @end example
  2322. @item
  2323. Two delays:
  2324. @example
  2325. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  2326. @end example
  2327. @item
  2328. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  2329. @example
  2330. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  2331. @end example
  2332. @end itemize
  2333. @section compand
  2334. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  2335. It accepts the following parameters:
  2336. @table @option
  2337. @item attacks
  2338. @item decays
  2339. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  2340. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  2341. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  2342. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  2343. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  2344. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  2345. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  2346. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  2347. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  2348. @item points
  2349. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  2350. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  2351. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  2352. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  2353. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  2354. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  2355. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  2356. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20|1/0}.
  2357. @item soft-knee
  2358. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  2359. @item gain
  2360. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  2361. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  2362. It defaults to 0.
  2363. @item volume
  2364. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  2365. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  2366. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  2367. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  2368. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  2369. @item delay
  2370. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  2371. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  2372. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  2373. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  2374. @end table
  2375. @subsection Examples
  2376. @itemize
  2377. @item
  2378. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  2379. noisy environment:
  2380. @example
  2381. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  2382. @end example
  2383. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  2384. @example
  2385. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  2386. @end example
  2387. @item
  2388. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  2389. @example
  2390. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  2391. @end example
  2392. @item
  2393. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  2394. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  2395. @example
  2396. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  2397. @end example
  2398. @item
  2399. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  2400. @example
  2401. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  2402. @end example
  2403. @item
  2404. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  2405. @example
  2406. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  2407. @end example
  2408. @item
  2409. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  2410. @example
  2411. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  2412. @end example
  2413. @item
  2414. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  2415. @example
  2416. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  2417. @end example
  2418. @item
  2419. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  2420. @example
  2421. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  2422. @end example
  2423. @item
  2424. Compressor/Gate:
  2425. @example
  2426. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  2427. @end example
  2428. @item
  2429. Expander:
  2430. @example
  2431. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  2432. @end example
  2433. @item
  2434. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  2435. @example
  2436. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  2437. @end example
  2438. @item
  2439. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  2440. @example
  2441. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  2442. @end example
  2443. @item
  2444. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  2445. @example
  2446. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  2447. @end example
  2448. @item
  2449. Soft limiter:
  2450. @example
  2451. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  2452. @end example
  2453. @end itemize
  2454. @section compensationdelay
  2455. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  2456. positions of microphones or speakers.
  2457. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  2458. different locations. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  2459. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  2460. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  2461. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that a distance of
  2462. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone capture the signal in
  2463. antiphase to the other microphone. That makes the final mix sound moody.
  2464. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  2465. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  2466. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  2467. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  2468. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  2469. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  2470. The filter accepts the following parameters:
  2471. @table @option
  2472. @item mm
  2473. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  2474. Default is 0.
  2475. @item cm
  2476. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  2477. Default is 0.
  2478. @item m
  2479. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  2480. Default is 0.
  2481. @item dry
  2482. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  2483. Default is 0.
  2484. @item wet
  2485. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  2486. Default is 1.
  2487. @item temp
  2488. Set temperature in degrees Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  2489. Default is 20.
  2490. @end table
  2491. @section crossfeed
  2492. Apply headphone crossfeed filter.
  2493. Crossfeed is the process of blending the left and right channels of stereo
  2494. audio recording.
  2495. It is mainly used to reduce extreme stereo separation of low frequencies.
  2496. The intent is to produce more speaker like sound to the listener.
  2497. The filter accepts the following options:
  2498. @table @option
  2499. @item strength
  2500. Set strength of crossfeed. Default is 0.2. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2501. This sets gain of low shelf filter for side part of stereo image.
  2502. Default is -6dB. Max allowed is -30db when strength is set to 1.
  2503. @item range
  2504. Set soundstage wideness. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2505. This sets cut off frequency of low shelf filter. Default is cut off near
  2506. 1550 Hz. With range set to 1 cut off frequency is set to 2100 Hz.
  2507. @item slope
  2508. Set curve slope of low shelf filter. Default is 0.5.
  2509. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 1.
  2510. @item level_in
  2511. Set input gain. Default is 0.9.
  2512. @item level_out
  2513. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  2514. @end table
  2515. @subsection Commands
  2516. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2517. @section crystalizer
  2518. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  2519. The filter accepts the following options:
  2520. @table @option
  2521. @item i
  2522. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  2523. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  2524. @item c
  2525. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2526. @end table
  2527. @subsection Commands
  2528. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2529. @section dcshift
  2530. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  2531. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  2532. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  2533. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  2534. a signal has a DC offset.
  2535. @table @option
  2536. @item shift
  2537. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  2538. the audio.
  2539. @item limitergain
  2540. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  2541. used to prevent clipping.
  2542. @end table
  2543. @section deesser
  2544. Apply de-essing to the audio samples.
  2545. @table @option
  2546. @item i
  2547. Set intensity for triggering de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2548. Default is 0.
  2549. @item m
  2550. Set amount of ducking on treble part of sound. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2551. Default is 0.5.
  2552. @item f
  2553. How much of original frequency content to keep when de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2554. Default is 0.5.
  2555. @item s
  2556. Set the output mode.
  2557. It accepts the following values:
  2558. @table @option
  2559. @item i
  2560. Pass input unchanged.
  2561. @item o
  2562. Pass ess filtered out.
  2563. @item e
  2564. Pass only ess.
  2565. Default value is @var{o}.
  2566. @end table
  2567. @end table
  2568. @section drmeter
  2569. Measure audio dynamic range.
  2570. DR values of 14 and higher is found in very dynamic material. DR of 8 to 13
  2571. is found in transition material. And anything less that 8 have very poor dynamics
  2572. and is very compressed.
  2573. The filter accepts the following options:
  2574. @table @option
  2575. @item length
  2576. Set window length in seconds used to split audio into segments of equal length.
  2577. Default is 3 seconds.
  2578. @end table
  2579. @section dynaudnorm
  2580. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  2581. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  2582. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  2583. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  2584. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  2585. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  2586. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  2587. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  2588. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  2589. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  2590. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  2591. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  2592. @table @option
  2593. @item framelen, f
  2594. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  2595. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  2596. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  2597. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  2598. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  2599. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  2600. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  2601. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  2602. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  2603. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  2604. been found to give good results with most files.
  2605. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  2606. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  2607. @item gausssize, g
  2608. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  2609. number. Default is 31.
  2610. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  2611. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  2612. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  2613. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  2614. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  2615. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  2616. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  2617. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  2618. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  2619. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2620. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  2621. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2622. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  2623. @item peak, p
  2624. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  2625. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  2626. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  2627. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  2628. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  2629. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  2630. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  2631. @item maxgain, m
  2632. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  2633. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  2634. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  2635. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  2636. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  2637. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  2638. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  2639. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  2640. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  2641. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  2642. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  2643. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  2644. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  2645. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  2646. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  2647. value.
  2648. @item targetrms, r
  2649. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  2650. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  2651. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  2652. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  2653. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  2654. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  2655. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  2656. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  2657. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  2658. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  2659. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  2660. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  2661. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  2662. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  2663. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  2664. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  2665. @item coupling, n
  2666. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  2667. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  2668. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  2669. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  2670. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  2671. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  2672. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  2673. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  2674. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  2675. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  2676. @item correctdc, c
  2677. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  2678. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  2679. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  2680. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  2681. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  2682. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  2683. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  2684. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  2685. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  2686. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  2687. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  2688. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  2689. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  2690. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  2691. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  2692. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  2693. between neighbouring frames.
  2694. @item altboundary, b
  2695. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  2696. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  2697. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  2698. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  2699. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  2700. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  2701. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  2702. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  2703. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  2704. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  2705. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  2706. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  2707. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  2708. @item compress, s
  2709. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  2710. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  2711. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  2712. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  2713. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  2714. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  2715. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  2716. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  2717. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  2718. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  2719. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  2720. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  2721. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  2722. frame.
  2723. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  2724. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  2725. @item threshold, t
  2726. Set the target threshold value. This specifies the lowest permissible
  2727. magnitude level for the audio input which will be normalized.
  2728. If input frame volume is above this value frame will be normalized.
  2729. Otherwise frame may not be normalized at all. The default value is set
  2730. to 0, which means all input frames will be normalized.
  2731. This option is mostly useful if digital noise is not wanted to be amplified.
  2732. @end table
  2733. @subsection Commands
  2734. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2735. @section earwax
  2736. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  2737. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  2738. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  2739. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  2740. the listener (standard for speakers).
  2741. Ported from SoX.
  2742. @section equalizer
  2743. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  2744. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  2745. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  2746. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  2747. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  2748. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  2749. The filter accepts the following options:
  2750. @table @option
  2751. @item frequency, f
  2752. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  2753. @item width_type, t
  2754. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2755. @table @option
  2756. @item h
  2757. Hz
  2758. @item q
  2759. Q-Factor
  2760. @item o
  2761. octave
  2762. @item s
  2763. slope
  2764. @item k
  2765. kHz
  2766. @end table
  2767. @item width, w
  2768. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2769. @item gain, g
  2770. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  2771. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2772. @item mix, m
  2773. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2774. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2775. @item channels, c
  2776. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2777. @item normalize, n
  2778. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2779. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2780. @end table
  2781. @subsection Examples
  2782. @itemize
  2783. @item
  2784. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  2785. @example
  2786. equalizer=f=1000:t=h:width=200:g=-10
  2787. @end example
  2788. @item
  2789. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  2790. @example
  2791. equalizer=f=1000:t=q:w=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:t=q:w=2:g=-5
  2792. @end example
  2793. @end itemize
  2794. @subsection Commands
  2795. This filter supports the following commands:
  2796. @table @option
  2797. @item frequency, f
  2798. Change equalizer frequency.
  2799. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2800. @item width_type, t
  2801. Change equalizer width_type.
  2802. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2803. @item width, w
  2804. Change equalizer width.
  2805. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2806. @item gain, g
  2807. Change equalizer gain.
  2808. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2809. @item mix, m
  2810. Change equalizer mix.
  2811. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2812. @end table
  2813. @section extrastereo
  2814. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  2815. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  2816. The filter accepts the following options:
  2817. @table @option
  2818. @item m
  2819. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  2820. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  2821. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  2822. @item c
  2823. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2824. @end table
  2825. @subsection Commands
  2826. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2827. @section firequalizer
  2828. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  2829. The filter accepts the following option:
  2830. @table @option
  2831. @item gain
  2832. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  2833. @table @option
  2834. @item f
  2835. the evaluated frequency
  2836. @item sr
  2837. sample rate
  2838. @item ch
  2839. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2840. @item chid
  2841. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  2842. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2843. @item chs
  2844. number of channels
  2845. @item chlayout
  2846. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  2847. @end table
  2848. and functions:
  2849. @table @option
  2850. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  2851. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  2852. @item cubic_interpolate(f)
  2853. same as gain_interpolate, but smoother
  2854. @end table
  2855. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  2856. @item gain_entry
  2857. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  2858. contain functions:
  2859. @table @option
  2860. @item entry(f, g)
  2861. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  2862. @end table
  2863. This option is also available as command.
  2864. @item delay
  2865. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  2866. Default is @code{0.01}.
  2867. @item accuracy
  2868. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  2869. Default is @code{5}.
  2870. @item wfunc
  2871. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  2872. @table @option
  2873. @item rectangular
  2874. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  2875. @item hann
  2876. hann window (default)
  2877. @item hamming
  2878. hamming window
  2879. @item blackman
  2880. blackman window
  2881. @item nuttall3
  2882. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2883. @item mnuttall3
  2884. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  2885. @item nuttall
  2886. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2887. @item bnuttall
  2888. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2889. @item bharris
  2890. blackman-harris window
  2891. @item tukey
  2892. tukey window
  2893. @end table
  2894. @item fixed
  2895. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2896. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2897. @item multi
  2898. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2899. @item zero_phase
  2900. Enable zero phase mode by subtracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2901. Default is disabled.
  2902. @item scale
  2903. Set scale used by gain. Acceptable values are:
  2904. @table @option
  2905. @item linlin
  2906. linear frequency, linear gain
  2907. @item linlog
  2908. linear frequency, logarithmic (in dB) gain (default)
  2909. @item loglin
  2910. logarithmic (in octave scale where 20 Hz is 0) frequency, linear gain
  2911. @item loglog
  2912. logarithmic frequency, logarithmic gain
  2913. @end table
  2914. @item dumpfile
  2915. Set file for dumping, suitable for gnuplot.
  2916. @item dumpscale
  2917. Set scale for dumpfile. Acceptable values are same with scale option.
  2918. Default is linlog.
  2919. @item fft2
  2920. Enable 2-channel convolution using complex FFT. This improves speed significantly.
  2921. Default is disabled.
  2922. @item min_phase
  2923. Enable minimum phase impulse response. Default is disabled.
  2924. @end table
  2925. @subsection Examples
  2926. @itemize
  2927. @item
  2928. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2929. @example
  2930. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2931. @end example
  2932. @item
  2933. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2934. @example
  2935. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2936. @end example
  2937. @item
  2938. custom equalization:
  2939. @example
  2940. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2941. @end example
  2942. @item
  2943. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2944. @example
  2945. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2946. @end example
  2947. @item
  2948. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2949. @example
  2950. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2951. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2952. @end example
  2953. @end itemize
  2954. @section flanger
  2955. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2956. The filter accepts the following options:
  2957. @table @option
  2958. @item delay
  2959. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2960. @item depth
  2961. Set added sweep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2962. @item regen
  2963. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2964. Default value is 0.
  2965. @item width
  2966. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2967. Default value is 71.
  2968. @item speed
  2969. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2970. @item shape
  2971. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2972. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2973. @item phase
  2974. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2975. Default value is 25.
  2976. @item interp
  2977. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2978. Default is @var{linear}.
  2979. @end table
  2980. @section haas
  2981. Apply Haas effect to audio.
  2982. Note that this makes most sense to apply on mono signals.
  2983. With this filter applied to mono signals it give some directionality and
  2984. stretches its stereo image.
  2985. The filter accepts the following options:
  2986. @table @option
  2987. @item level_in
  2988. Set input level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB
  2989. @item level_out
  2990. Set output level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB.
  2991. @item side_gain
  2992. Set gain applied to side part of signal. By default is @var{1}.
  2993. @item middle_source
  2994. Set kind of middle source. Can be one of the following:
  2995. @table @samp
  2996. @item left
  2997. Pick left channel.
  2998. @item right
  2999. Pick right channel.
  3000. @item mid
  3001. Pick middle part signal of stereo image.
  3002. @item side
  3003. Pick side part signal of stereo image.
  3004. @end table
  3005. @item middle_phase
  3006. Change middle phase. By default is disabled.
  3007. @item left_delay
  3008. Set left channel delay. By default is @var{2.05} milliseconds.
  3009. @item left_balance
  3010. Set left channel balance. By default is @var{-1}.
  3011. @item left_gain
  3012. Set left channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  3013. @item left_phase
  3014. Change left phase. By default is disabled.
  3015. @item right_delay
  3016. Set right channel delay. By defaults is @var{2.12} milliseconds.
  3017. @item right_balance
  3018. Set right channel balance. By default is @var{1}.
  3019. @item right_gain
  3020. Set right channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  3021. @item right_phase
  3022. Change right phase. By default is enabled.
  3023. @end table
  3024. @section hdcd
  3025. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  3026. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  3027. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  3028. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  3029. @example
  3030. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  3031. @end example
  3032. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  3033. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  3034. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  3035. @example
  3036. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  3037. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -c:a pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  3038. @end example
  3039. The filter accepts the following options:
  3040. @table @option
  3041. @item disable_autoconvert
  3042. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  3043. @item process_stereo
  3044. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  3045. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  3046. @item cdt_ms
  3047. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  3048. @item force_pe
  3049. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  3050. @item analyze_mode
  3051. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  3052. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  3053. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  3054. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  3055. Modes are:
  3056. @table @samp
  3057. @item 0, off
  3058. Disabled
  3059. @item 1, lle
  3060. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  3061. @item 2, pe
  3062. Samples where peak extend occurs
  3063. @item 3, cdt
  3064. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  3065. @item 4, tgm
  3066. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  3067. @end table
  3068. @end table
  3069. @section headphone
  3070. Apply head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3071. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones.
  3072. The HRIRs are provided via additional streams, for each channel
  3073. one stereo input stream is needed.
  3074. The filter accepts the following options:
  3075. @table @option
  3076. @item map
  3077. Set mapping of input streams for convolution.
  3078. The argument is a '|'-separated list of channel names in order as they
  3079. are given as additional stream inputs for filter.
  3080. This also specify number of input streams. Number of input streams
  3081. must be not less than number of channels in first stream plus one.
  3082. @item gain
  3083. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3084. @item type
  3085. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3086. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3087. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3088. Default is @var{freq}.
  3089. @item lfe
  3090. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3091. @item size
  3092. Set size of frame in number of samples which will be processed at once.
  3093. Default value is @var{1024}. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.
  3094. @item hrir
  3095. Set format of hrir stream.
  3096. Default value is @var{stereo}. Alternative value is @var{multich}.
  3097. If value is set to @var{stereo}, number of additional streams should
  3098. be greater or equal to number of input channels in first input stream.
  3099. Also each additional stream should have stereo number of channels.
  3100. If value is set to @var{multich}, number of additional streams should
  3101. be exactly one. Also number of input channels of additional stream
  3102. should be equal or greater than twice number of channels of first input
  3103. stream.
  3104. @end table
  3105. @subsection Examples
  3106. @itemize
  3107. @item
  3108. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3109. each amovie filter use stereo file with IR coefficients as input.
  3110. The files give coefficients for each position of virtual loudspeaker:
  3111. @example
  3112. ffmpeg -i input.wav
  3113. -filter_complex "amovie=azi_270_ele_0_DFC.wav[sr];amovie=azi_90_ele_0_DFC.wav[sl];amovie=azi_225_ele_0_DFC.wav[br];amovie=azi_135_ele_0_DFC.wav[bl];amovie=azi_0_ele_0_DFC.wav,asplit[fc][lfe];amovie=azi_35_ele_0_DFC.wav[fl];amovie=azi_325_ele_0_DFC.wav[fr];[0:a][fl][fr][fc][lfe][bl][br][sl][sr]headphone=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR"
  3114. output.wav
  3115. @end example
  3116. @item
  3117. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3118. but now in @var{multich} @var{hrir} format.
  3119. @example
  3120. ffmpeg -i input.wav -filter_complex "amovie=minp.wav[hrirs];[0:a][hrirs]headphone=map=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR:hrir=multich"
  3121. output.wav
  3122. @end example
  3123. @end itemize
  3124. @section highpass
  3125. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3126. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  3127. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3128. The filter accepts the following options:
  3129. @table @option
  3130. @item frequency, f
  3131. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  3132. @item poles, p
  3133. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3134. @item width_type, t
  3135. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3136. @table @option
  3137. @item h
  3138. Hz
  3139. @item q
  3140. Q-Factor
  3141. @item o
  3142. octave
  3143. @item s
  3144. slope
  3145. @item k
  3146. kHz
  3147. @end table
  3148. @item width, w
  3149. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3150. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3151. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3152. @item mix, m
  3153. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3154. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3155. @item channels, c
  3156. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3157. @item normalize, n
  3158. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3159. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3160. @end table
  3161. @subsection Commands
  3162. This filter supports the following commands:
  3163. @table @option
  3164. @item frequency, f
  3165. Change highpass frequency.
  3166. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3167. @item width_type, t
  3168. Change highpass width_type.
  3169. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3170. @item width, w
  3171. Change highpass width.
  3172. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3173. @item mix, m
  3174. Change highpass mix.
  3175. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3176. @end table
  3177. @section join
  3178. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  3179. It accepts the following parameters:
  3180. @table @option
  3181. @item inputs
  3182. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  3183. @item channel_layout
  3184. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  3185. @item map
  3186. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  3187. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  3188. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  3189. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  3190. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  3191. channel.
  3192. @end table
  3193. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  3194. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  3195. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  3196. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  3197. @example
  3198. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  3199. @end example
  3200. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  3201. @example
  3202. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  3203. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  3204. out
  3205. @end example
  3206. @section ladspa
  3207. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  3208. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3209. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  3210. @table @option
  3211. @item file, f
  3212. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  3213. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  3214. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  3215. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  3216. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  3217. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  3218. @item plugin, p
  3219. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  3220. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  3221. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  3222. @item controls, c
  3223. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3224. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3225. threshold or gain).
  3226. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  3227. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  3228. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3229. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  3230. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  3231. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3232. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3233. their valid ranges are printed.
  3234. @item sample_rate, s
  3235. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3236. zero inputs.
  3237. @item nb_samples, n
  3238. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3239. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3240. @item duration, d
  3241. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3242. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3243. for the accepted syntax.
  3244. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3245. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3246. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3247. supposed to be generated forever.
  3248. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3249. @item latency, l
  3250. Enable latency compensation, by default is disabled.
  3251. Only used if plugin have inputs.
  3252. @end table
  3253. @subsection Examples
  3254. @itemize
  3255. @item
  3256. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  3257. @example
  3258. ladspa=file=amp
  3259. @end example
  3260. @item
  3261. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  3262. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  3263. @example
  3264. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  3265. @end example
  3266. @item
  3267. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  3268. plugin library:
  3269. @example
  3270. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  3271. @end example
  3272. @item
  3273. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  3274. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  3275. @example
  3276. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  3277. @end example
  3278. @item
  3279. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  3280. @example
  3281. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  3282. @end example
  3283. @item
  3284. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  3285. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3286. @example
  3287. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  3288. @end example
  3289. @item
  3290. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  3291. @example
  3292. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  3293. @end example
  3294. @item
  3295. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  3296. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3297. @example
  3298. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  3299. @end example
  3300. @item
  3301. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  3302. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3303. @example
  3304. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  3305. @end example
  3306. @item
  3307. Reduce stereo image using @code{Narrower} from the @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite}
  3308. (CAPS) library:
  3309. @example
  3310. ladspa=caps:Narrower
  3311. @end example
  3312. @item
  3313. Another white noise, now using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3314. @example
  3315. ladspa=caps:White:.2
  3316. @end example
  3317. @item
  3318. Some fractal noise, using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3319. @example
  3320. ladspa=caps:Fractal:c=c1=1
  3321. @end example
  3322. @item
  3323. Dynamic volume normalization using @code{VLevel} plugin:
  3324. @example
  3325. ladspa=vlevel-ladspa:vlevel_mono
  3326. @end example
  3327. @end itemize
  3328. @subsection Commands
  3329. This filter supports the following commands:
  3330. @table @option
  3331. @item cN
  3332. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  3333. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  3334. @end table
  3335. @section loudnorm
  3336. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  3337. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  3338. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak. In dynamic mode, to accurately
  3339. detect true peaks, the audio stream will be upsampled to 192 kHz.
  3340. Use the @code{-ar} option or @code{aresample} filter to explicitly set an output sample rate.
  3341. The filter accepts the following options:
  3342. @table @option
  3343. @item I, i
  3344. Set integrated loudness target.
  3345. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  3346. @item LRA, lra
  3347. Set loudness range target.
  3348. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  3349. @item TP, tp
  3350. Set maximum true peak.
  3351. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  3352. @item measured_I, measured_i
  3353. Measured IL of input file.
  3354. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3355. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  3356. Measured LRA of input file.
  3357. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  3358. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  3359. Measured true peak of input file.
  3360. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  3361. @item measured_thresh
  3362. Measured threshold of input file.
  3363. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3364. @item offset
  3365. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  3366. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  3367. @item linear
  3368. Normalize by linearly scaling the source audio.
  3369. @code{measured_I}, @code{measured_LRA}, @code{measured_TP},
  3370. and @code{measured_thresh} must all be specified. Target LRA shouldn't
  3371. be lower than source LRA and the change in integrated loudness shouldn't
  3372. result in a true peak which exceeds the target TP. If any of these
  3373. conditions aren't met, normalization mode will revert to @var{dynamic}.
  3374. Options are @code{true} or @code{false}. Default is @code{true}.
  3375. @item dual_mono
  3376. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  3377. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  3378. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  3379. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  3380. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  3381. @item print_format
  3382. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  3383. Default value is none.
  3384. @end table
  3385. @section lowpass
  3386. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3387. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  3388. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3389. The filter accepts the following options:
  3390. @table @option
  3391. @item frequency, f
  3392. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  3393. @item poles, p
  3394. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3395. @item width_type, t
  3396. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3397. @table @option
  3398. @item h
  3399. Hz
  3400. @item q
  3401. Q-Factor
  3402. @item o
  3403. octave
  3404. @item s
  3405. slope
  3406. @item k
  3407. kHz
  3408. @end table
  3409. @item width, w
  3410. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3411. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3412. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3413. @item mix, m
  3414. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3415. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3416. @item channels, c
  3417. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3418. @item normalize, n
  3419. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3420. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3421. @end table
  3422. @subsection Examples
  3423. @itemize
  3424. @item
  3425. Lowpass only LFE channel, it LFE is not present it does nothing:
  3426. @example
  3427. lowpass=c=LFE
  3428. @end example
  3429. @end itemize
  3430. @subsection Commands
  3431. This filter supports the following commands:
  3432. @table @option
  3433. @item frequency, f
  3434. Change lowpass frequency.
  3435. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3436. @item width_type, t
  3437. Change lowpass width_type.
  3438. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3439. @item width, w
  3440. Change lowpass width.
  3441. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3442. @item mix, m
  3443. Change lowpass mix.
  3444. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3445. @end table
  3446. @section lv2
  3447. Load a LV2 (LADSPA Version 2) plugin.
  3448. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3449. @code{--enable-lv2}.
  3450. @table @option
  3451. @item plugin, p
  3452. Specifies the plugin URI. You may need to escape ':'.
  3453. @item controls, c
  3454. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3455. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3456. threshold or gain).
  3457. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3458. their valid ranges are printed.
  3459. @item sample_rate, s
  3460. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3461. zero inputs.
  3462. @item nb_samples, n
  3463. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3464. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3465. @item duration, d
  3466. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3467. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3468. for the accepted syntax.
  3469. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3470. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3471. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3472. supposed to be generated forever.
  3473. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3474. @end table
  3475. @subsection Examples
  3476. @itemize
  3477. @item
  3478. Apply bass enhancer plugin from Calf:
  3479. @example
  3480. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/BassEnhancer:c=amount=2
  3481. @end example
  3482. @item
  3483. Apply vinyl plugin from Calf:
  3484. @example
  3485. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/Vinyl:c=drone=0.2|aging=0.5
  3486. @end example
  3487. @item
  3488. Apply bit crusher plugin from ArtyFX:
  3489. @example
  3490. lv2=p=http\\\\://www.openavproductions.com/artyfx#bitta:c=crush=0.3
  3491. @end example
  3492. @end itemize
  3493. @section mcompand
  3494. Multiband Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  3495. The input audio is divided into bands using 4th order Linkwitz-Riley IIRs.
  3496. This is akin to the crossover of a loudspeaker, and results in flat frequency
  3497. response when absent compander action.
  3498. It accepts the following parameters:
  3499. @table @option
  3500. @item args
  3501. This option syntax is:
  3502. attack,decay,[attack,decay..] soft-knee points crossover_frequency [delay [initial_volume [gain]]] | attack,decay ...
  3503. For explanation of each item refer to compand filter documentation.
  3504. @end table
  3505. @anchor{pan}
  3506. @section pan
  3507. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  3508. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  3509. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  3510. stream.
  3511. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  3512. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  3513. @table @option
  3514. @item l
  3515. output channel layout or number of channels
  3516. @item outdef
  3517. output channel specification, of the form:
  3518. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[(+-)[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  3519. @item out_name
  3520. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  3521. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  3522. @item gain
  3523. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  3524. @item in_name
  3525. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  3526. named and numbered input channels
  3527. @end table
  3528. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  3529. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  3530. avoiding clipping noise.
  3531. @subsection Mixing examples
  3532. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  3533. factor for the left channel:
  3534. @example
  3535. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  3536. @end example
  3537. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  3538. 7-channels surround:
  3539. @example
  3540. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  3541. @end example
  3542. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  3543. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  3544. needs.
  3545. @subsection Remapping examples
  3546. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  3547. @itemize
  3548. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  3549. @item only one input per channel output,
  3550. @end itemize
  3551. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  3552. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  3553. remapping.
  3554. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  3555. dropping the extra channels:
  3556. @example
  3557. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  3558. @end example
  3559. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  3560. and keep the input channel layout:
  3561. @example
  3562. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  3563. @end example
  3564. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  3565. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  3566. @example
  3567. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  3568. @end example
  3569. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  3570. front left and right:
  3571. @example
  3572. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  3573. @end example
  3574. @section replaygain
  3575. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  3576. outputs it unchanged.
  3577. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  3578. @section resample
  3579. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  3580. not meant to be used directly.
  3581. @section rubberband
  3582. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  3583. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3584. @code{--enable-librubberband}.
  3585. The filter accepts the following options:
  3586. @table @option
  3587. @item tempo
  3588. Set tempo scale factor.
  3589. @item pitch
  3590. Set pitch scale factor.
  3591. @item transients
  3592. Set transients detector.
  3593. Possible values are:
  3594. @table @var
  3595. @item crisp
  3596. @item mixed
  3597. @item smooth
  3598. @end table
  3599. @item detector
  3600. Set detector.
  3601. Possible values are:
  3602. @table @var
  3603. @item compound
  3604. @item percussive
  3605. @item soft
  3606. @end table
  3607. @item phase
  3608. Set phase.
  3609. Possible values are:
  3610. @table @var
  3611. @item laminar
  3612. @item independent
  3613. @end table
  3614. @item window
  3615. Set processing window size.
  3616. Possible values are:
  3617. @table @var
  3618. @item standard
  3619. @item short
  3620. @item long
  3621. @end table
  3622. @item smoothing
  3623. Set smoothing.
  3624. Possible values are:
  3625. @table @var
  3626. @item off
  3627. @item on
  3628. @end table
  3629. @item formant
  3630. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  3631. Possible values are:
  3632. @table @var
  3633. @item shifted
  3634. @item preserved
  3635. @end table
  3636. @item pitchq
  3637. Set pitch quality.
  3638. Possible values are:
  3639. @table @var
  3640. @item quality
  3641. @item speed
  3642. @item consistency
  3643. @end table
  3644. @item channels
  3645. Set channels.
  3646. Possible values are:
  3647. @table @var
  3648. @item apart
  3649. @item together
  3650. @end table
  3651. @end table
  3652. @subsection Commands
  3653. This filter supports the following commands:
  3654. @table @option
  3655. @item tempo
  3656. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  3657. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  3658. @item pitch
  3659. Change filter pitch scale factor.
  3660. Syntax for the command is : "@var{pitch}"
  3661. @end table
  3662. @section sidechaincompress
  3663. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  3664. detected signal using second input signal.
  3665. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3666. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3667. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  3668. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  3669. The filter accepts the following options:
  3670. @table @option
  3671. @item level_in
  3672. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3673. @item mode
  3674. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3675. Default is @code{downward}.
  3676. @item threshold
  3677. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  3678. reduction of first stream.
  3679. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  3680. @item ratio
  3681. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  3682. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  3683. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  3684. @item attack
  3685. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3686. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  3687. @item release
  3688. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  3689. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  3690. @item makeup
  3691. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  3692. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  3693. @item knee
  3694. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3695. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  3696. @item link
  3697. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  3698. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  3699. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  3700. @item detection
  3701. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  3702. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  3703. @item level_sc
  3704. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3705. @item mix
  3706. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  3707. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3708. @end table
  3709. @subsection Commands
  3710. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  3711. @subsection Examples
  3712. @itemize
  3713. @item
  3714. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  3715. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  3716. merged with 2nd input:
  3717. @example
  3718. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  3719. @end example
  3720. @end itemize
  3721. @section sidechaingate
  3722. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  3723. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  3724. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  3725. threshold.
  3726. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  3727. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  3728. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  3729. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  3730. guitar.
  3731. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3732. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3733. The filter accepts the following options:
  3734. @table @option
  3735. @item level_in
  3736. Set input level before filtering.
  3737. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3738. @item mode
  3739. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3740. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  3741. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  3742. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  3743. @item range
  3744. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  3745. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3746. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  3747. @item threshold
  3748. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  3749. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3750. @item ratio
  3751. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  3752. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  3753. @item attack
  3754. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3755. reduction stops.
  3756. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3757. @item release
  3758. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  3759. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  3760. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3761. @item makeup
  3762. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  3763. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  3764. @item knee
  3765. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3766. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  3767. @item detection
  3768. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  3769. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  3770. @item link
  3771. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  3772. the reduction.
  3773. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  3774. @item level_sc
  3775. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3776. @end table
  3777. @section silencedetect
  3778. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  3779. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  3780. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  3781. minimum detected noise duration.
  3782. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  3783. @code{lavfi.silence_start} or @code{lavfi.silence_start.X} metadata key
  3784. is set on the first frame whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection
  3785. duration and it contains the timestamp of the first frame of the silence.
  3786. The @code{lavfi.silence_duration} or @code{lavfi.silence_duration.X}
  3787. and @code{lavfi.silence_end} or @code{lavfi.silence_end.X} metadata
  3788. keys are set on the first frame after the silence. If @option{mono} is
  3789. enabled, and each channel is evaluated separately, the @code{.X}
  3790. suffixed keys are used, and @code{X} corresponds to the channel number.
  3791. The filter accepts the following options:
  3792. @table @option
  3793. @item noise, n
  3794. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  3795. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  3796. @item duration, d
  3797. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds). See
  3798. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3799. for the accepted syntax.
  3800. @item mono, m
  3801. Process each channel separately, instead of combined. By default is disabled.
  3802. @end table
  3803. @subsection Examples
  3804. @itemize
  3805. @item
  3806. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  3807. @example
  3808. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  3809. @end example
  3810. @item
  3811. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  3812. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  3813. @example
  3814. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  3815. @end example
  3816. @end itemize
  3817. @section silenceremove
  3818. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  3819. The filter accepts the following options:
  3820. @table @option
  3821. @item start_periods
  3822. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  3823. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  3824. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  3825. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  3826. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  3827. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  3828. Default value is @code{0}.
  3829. @item start_duration
  3830. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  3831. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  3832. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  3833. @item start_threshold
  3834. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  3835. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  3836. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  3837. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3838. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3839. @item start_silence
  3840. Specify max duration of silence at beginning that will be kept after
  3841. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3842. as silence.
  3843. @item start_mode
  3844. Specify mode of detection of silence end in start of multi-channel audio.
  3845. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3846. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3847. stopped trimming of silence.
  3848. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3849. stopped trimming of silence.
  3850. @item stop_periods
  3851. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  3852. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  3853. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  3854. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  3855. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  3856. in the middle of the audio.
  3857. Default value is @code{0}.
  3858. @item stop_duration
  3859. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  3860. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  3861. the audio.
  3862. Default value is @code{0}.
  3863. @item stop_threshold
  3864. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  3865. the end of audio.
  3866. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3867. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3868. @item stop_silence
  3869. Specify max duration of silence at end that will be kept after
  3870. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3871. as silence.
  3872. @item stop_mode
  3873. Specify mode of detection of silence start in end of multi-channel audio.
  3874. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3875. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3876. stopped trimming of silence.
  3877. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3878. stopped trimming of silence.
  3879. @item detection
  3880. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  3881. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  3882. Default value is @code{rms}.
  3883. @item window
  3884. Set duration in number of seconds used to calculate size of window in number
  3885. of samples for detecting silence.
  3886. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  3887. @end table
  3888. @subsection Examples
  3889. @itemize
  3890. @item
  3891. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  3892. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  3893. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  3894. @example
  3895. silenceremove=start_periods=1:start_duration=5:start_threshold=0.02
  3896. @end example
  3897. @item
  3898. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  3899. second of silence in audio:
  3900. @example
  3901. silenceremove=stop_periods=-1:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB
  3902. @end example
  3903. @item
  3904. Trim all digital silence samples, using peak detection, from beginning to end
  3905. where there is more than 0 samples of digital silence in audio and digital
  3906. silence is detected in all channels at same positions in stream:
  3907. @example
  3908. silenceremove=window=0:detection=peak:stop_mode=all:start_mode=all:stop_periods=-1:stop_threshold=0
  3909. @end example
  3910. @end itemize
  3911. @section sofalizer
  3912. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3913. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  3914. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  3915. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  3916. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  3917. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  3918. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3919. @code{--enable-libmysofa}.
  3920. The filter accepts the following options:
  3921. @table @option
  3922. @item sofa
  3923. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  3924. @item gain
  3925. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3926. @item rotation
  3927. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3928. @item elevation
  3929. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3930. @item radius
  3931. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  3932. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  3933. @item type
  3934. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3935. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3936. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3937. Default is @var{freq}.
  3938. @item speakers
  3939. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  3940. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  3941. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  3942. azimuth and elevation in degrees.
  3943. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  3944. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  3945. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  3946. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  3947. @item lfegain
  3948. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3949. @item framesize
  3950. Set custom frame size in number of samples. Default is 1024.
  3951. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000. Only used if option @samp{type}
  3952. is set to @var{freq}.
  3953. @item normalize
  3954. Should all IRs be normalized upon importing SOFA file.
  3955. By default is enabled.
  3956. @item interpolate
  3957. Should nearest IRs be interpolated with neighbor IRs if exact position
  3958. does not match. By default is disabled.
  3959. @item minphase
  3960. Minphase all IRs upon loading of SOFA file. By default is disabled.
  3961. @item anglestep
  3962. Set neighbor search angle step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3963. @item radstep
  3964. Set neighbor search radius step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3965. @end table
  3966. @subsection Examples
  3967. @itemize
  3968. @item
  3969. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  3970. @example
  3971. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  3972. @end example
  3973. @item
  3974. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  3975. @example
  3976. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  3977. @end example
  3978. @item
  3979. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, back left and back right
  3980. and also with custom gain:
  3981. @example
  3982. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|BL 135|BR 225:gain=28"
  3983. @end example
  3984. @end itemize
  3985. @section stereotools
  3986. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  3987. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  3988. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  3989. The filter accepts the following options:
  3990. @table @option
  3991. @item level_in
  3992. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3993. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3994. @item level_out
  3995. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3996. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3997. @item balance_in
  3998. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3999. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  4000. @item balance_out
  4001. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  4002. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  4003. @item softclip
  4004. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  4005. clipping. Disabled by default.
  4006. @item mutel
  4007. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  4008. @item muter
  4009. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  4010. @item phasel
  4011. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  4012. @item phaser
  4013. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  4014. @item mode
  4015. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  4016. @table @samp
  4017. @item lr>lr
  4018. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  4019. @item lr>ms
  4020. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  4021. @item ms>lr
  4022. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  4023. @item lr>ll
  4024. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  4025. @item lr>rr
  4026. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  4027. @item lr>l+r
  4028. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  4029. @item lr>rl
  4030. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  4031. @item ms>ll
  4032. Mid/Side to Left/Left.
  4033. @item ms>rr
  4034. Mid/Side to Right/Right.
  4035. @end table
  4036. @item slev
  4037. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  4038. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  4039. @item sbal
  4040. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  4041. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  4042. @item mlev
  4043. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  4044. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  4045. @item mpan
  4046. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  4047. @item base
  4048. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  4049. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  4050. @item delay
  4051. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  4052. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  4053. @item sclevel
  4054. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  4055. @item phase
  4056. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  4057. @item bmode_in, bmode_out
  4058. Set balance mode for balance_in/balance_out option.
  4059. Can be one of the following:
  4060. @table @samp
  4061. @item balance
  4062. Classic balance mode. Attenuate one channel at time.
  4063. Gain is raised up to 1.
  4064. @item amplitude
  4065. Similar as classic mode above but gain is raised up to 2.
  4066. @item power
  4067. Equal power distribution, from -6dB to +6dB range.
  4068. @end table
  4069. @end table
  4070. @subsection Examples
  4071. @itemize
  4072. @item
  4073. Apply karaoke like effect:
  4074. @example
  4075. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  4076. @end example
  4077. @item
  4078. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  4079. @example
  4080. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  4081. @end example
  4082. @end itemize
  4083. @section stereowiden
  4084. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  4085. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  4086. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  4087. The filter accepts the following options:
  4088. @table @option
  4089. @item delay
  4090. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  4091. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  4092. @item feedback
  4093. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  4094. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  4095. effect. Default is 0.3.
  4096. @item crossfeed
  4097. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  4098. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  4099. channels. Default is 0.3.
  4100. @item drymix
  4101. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  4102. @end table
  4103. @subsection Commands
  4104. This filter supports the all above options except @code{delay} as @ref{commands}.
  4105. @section superequalizer
  4106. Apply 18 band equalizer.
  4107. The filter accepts the following options:
  4108. @table @option
  4109. @item 1b
  4110. Set 65Hz band gain.
  4111. @item 2b
  4112. Set 92Hz band gain.
  4113. @item 3b
  4114. Set 131Hz band gain.
  4115. @item 4b
  4116. Set 185Hz band gain.
  4117. @item 5b
  4118. Set 262Hz band gain.
  4119. @item 6b
  4120. Set 370Hz band gain.
  4121. @item 7b
  4122. Set 523Hz band gain.
  4123. @item 8b
  4124. Set 740Hz band gain.
  4125. @item 9b
  4126. Set 1047Hz band gain.
  4127. @item 10b
  4128. Set 1480Hz band gain.
  4129. @item 11b
  4130. Set 2093Hz band gain.
  4131. @item 12b
  4132. Set 2960Hz band gain.
  4133. @item 13b
  4134. Set 4186Hz band gain.
  4135. @item 14b
  4136. Set 5920Hz band gain.
  4137. @item 15b
  4138. Set 8372Hz band gain.
  4139. @item 16b
  4140. Set 11840Hz band gain.
  4141. @item 17b
  4142. Set 16744Hz band gain.
  4143. @item 18b
  4144. Set 20000Hz band gain.
  4145. @end table
  4146. @section surround
  4147. Apply audio surround upmix filter.
  4148. This filter allows to produce multichannel output from audio stream.
  4149. The filter accepts the following options:
  4150. @table @option
  4151. @item chl_out
  4152. Set output channel layout. By default, this is @var{5.1}.
  4153. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4154. for the required syntax.
  4155. @item chl_in
  4156. Set input channel layout. By default, this is @var{stereo}.
  4157. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4158. for the required syntax.
  4159. @item level_in
  4160. Set input volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4161. @item level_out
  4162. Set output volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4163. @item lfe
  4164. Enable LFE channel output if output channel layout has it. By default, this is enabled.
  4165. @item lfe_low
  4166. Set LFE low cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{128} Hz.
  4167. @item lfe_high
  4168. Set LFE high cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{256} Hz.
  4169. @item lfe_mode
  4170. Set LFE mode, can be @var{add} or @var{sub}. Default is @var{add}.
  4171. In @var{add} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output.
  4172. In @var{sub} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output but
  4173. also all non-LFE output channels are subtracted with output LFE channel.
  4174. @item angle
  4175. Set angle of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{360}.
  4176. Default is @var{90}.
  4177. @item fc_in
  4178. Set front center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4179. @item fc_out
  4180. Set front center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4181. @item fl_in
  4182. Set front left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4183. @item fl_out
  4184. Set front left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4185. @item fr_in
  4186. Set front right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4187. @item fr_out
  4188. Set front right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4189. @item sl_in
  4190. Set side left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4191. @item sl_out
  4192. Set side left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4193. @item sr_in
  4194. Set side right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4195. @item sr_out
  4196. Set side right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4197. @item bl_in
  4198. Set back left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4199. @item bl_out
  4200. Set back left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4201. @item br_in
  4202. Set back right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4203. @item br_out
  4204. Set back right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4205. @item bc_in
  4206. Set back center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4207. @item bc_out
  4208. Set back center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4209. @item lfe_in
  4210. Set LFE input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4211. @item lfe_out
  4212. Set LFE output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4213. @item allx
  4214. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for all channels.
  4215. @item ally
  4216. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for all channels.
  4217. @item fcx, flx, frx, blx, brx, slx, srx, bcx
  4218. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for each channel.
  4219. @item fcy, fly, fry, bly, bry, sly, sry, bcy
  4220. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for each channel.
  4221. @item win_size
  4222. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  4223. @item win_func
  4224. Set window function.
  4225. It accepts the following values:
  4226. @table @samp
  4227. @item rect
  4228. @item bartlett
  4229. @item hann, hanning
  4230. @item hamming
  4231. @item blackman
  4232. @item welch
  4233. @item flattop
  4234. @item bharris
  4235. @item bnuttall
  4236. @item bhann
  4237. @item sine
  4238. @item nuttall
  4239. @item lanczos
  4240. @item gauss
  4241. @item tukey
  4242. @item dolph
  4243. @item cauchy
  4244. @item parzen
  4245. @item poisson
  4246. @item bohman
  4247. @end table
  4248. Default is @code{hann}.
  4249. @item overlap
  4250. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  4251. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.5}.
  4252. @end table
  4253. @section treble, highshelf
  4254. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  4255. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  4256. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  4257. The filter accepts the following options:
  4258. @table @option
  4259. @item gain, g
  4260. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  4261. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  4262. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  4263. @item frequency, f
  4264. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  4265. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  4266. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  4267. @item width_type, t
  4268. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  4269. @table @option
  4270. @item h
  4271. Hz
  4272. @item q
  4273. Q-Factor
  4274. @item o
  4275. octave
  4276. @item s
  4277. slope
  4278. @item k
  4279. kHz
  4280. @end table
  4281. @item width, w
  4282. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  4283. @item mix, m
  4284. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  4285. Range is between 0 and 1.
  4286. @item channels, c
  4287. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  4288. @item normalize, n
  4289. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  4290. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  4291. @end table
  4292. @subsection Commands
  4293. This filter supports the following commands:
  4294. @table @option
  4295. @item frequency, f
  4296. Change treble frequency.
  4297. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  4298. @item width_type, t
  4299. Change treble width_type.
  4300. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  4301. @item width, w
  4302. Change treble width.
  4303. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  4304. @item gain, g
  4305. Change treble gain.
  4306. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  4307. @item mix, m
  4308. Change treble mix.
  4309. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  4310. @end table
  4311. @section tremolo
  4312. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  4313. The filter accepts the following options:
  4314. @table @option
  4315. @item f
  4316. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  4317. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  4318. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  4319. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  4320. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4321. @item d
  4322. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4323. Default value is 0.5.
  4324. @end table
  4325. @section vibrato
  4326. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  4327. The filter accepts the following options:
  4328. @table @option
  4329. @item f
  4330. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  4331. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4332. @item d
  4333. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4334. Default value is 0.5.
  4335. @end table
  4336. @section volume
  4337. Adjust the input audio volume.
  4338. It accepts the following parameters:
  4339. @table @option
  4340. @item volume
  4341. Set audio volume expression.
  4342. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  4343. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  4344. @example
  4345. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  4346. @end example
  4347. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  4348. @item precision
  4349. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  4350. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  4351. precision of the volume scaling.
  4352. @table @option
  4353. @item fixed
  4354. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  4355. @item float
  4356. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  4357. @item double
  4358. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  4359. @end table
  4360. @item replaygain
  4361. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  4362. @table @option
  4363. @item drop
  4364. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  4365. @item ignore
  4366. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  4367. @item track
  4368. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  4369. @item album
  4370. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  4371. @end table
  4372. @item replaygain_preamp
  4373. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  4374. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  4375. @item replaygain_noclip
  4376. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  4377. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  4378. @item eval
  4379. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  4380. It accepts the following values:
  4381. @table @samp
  4382. @item once
  4383. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  4384. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  4385. @item frame
  4386. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  4387. @end table
  4388. Default value is @samp{once}.
  4389. @end table
  4390. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  4391. @table @option
  4392. @item n
  4393. frame number (starting at zero)
  4394. @item nb_channels
  4395. number of channels
  4396. @item nb_consumed_samples
  4397. number of samples consumed by the filter
  4398. @item nb_samples
  4399. number of samples in the current frame
  4400. @item pos
  4401. original frame position in the file
  4402. @item pts
  4403. frame PTS
  4404. @item sample_rate
  4405. sample rate
  4406. @item startpts
  4407. PTS at start of stream
  4408. @item startt
  4409. time at start of stream
  4410. @item t
  4411. frame time
  4412. @item tb
  4413. timestamp timebase
  4414. @item volume
  4415. last set volume value
  4416. @end table
  4417. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  4418. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  4419. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  4420. @subsection Commands
  4421. This filter supports the following commands:
  4422. @table @option
  4423. @item volume
  4424. Modify the volume expression.
  4425. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4426. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4427. value.
  4428. @end table
  4429. @subsection Examples
  4430. @itemize
  4431. @item
  4432. Halve the input audio volume:
  4433. @example
  4434. volume=volume=0.5
  4435. volume=volume=1/2
  4436. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  4437. @end example
  4438. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  4439. omitted, for example like in:
  4440. @example
  4441. volume=0.5
  4442. @end example
  4443. @item
  4444. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  4445. @example
  4446. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  4447. @end example
  4448. @item
  4449. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  4450. @example
  4451. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  4452. @end example
  4453. @end itemize
  4454. @section volumedetect
  4455. Detect the volume of the input video.
  4456. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  4457. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  4458. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  4459. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  4460. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  4461. the samples).
  4462. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  4463. @subsection Examples
  4464. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  4465. @example
  4466. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  4467. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  4468. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  4469. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  4470. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  4471. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  4472. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  4473. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  4474. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  4475. @end example
  4476. It means that:
  4477. @itemize
  4478. @item
  4479. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  4480. @item
  4481. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  4482. @item
  4483. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  4484. @end itemize
  4485. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  4486. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  4487. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  4488. @chapter Audio Sources
  4489. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  4490. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  4491. @section abuffer
  4492. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  4493. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  4494. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  4495. It accepts the following parameters:
  4496. @table @option
  4497. @item time_base
  4498. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  4499. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  4500. @item sample_rate
  4501. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  4502. @item sample_fmt
  4503. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  4504. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  4505. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  4506. @item channel_layout
  4507. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  4508. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  4509. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  4510. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  4511. @item channels
  4512. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  4513. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  4514. must be consistent.
  4515. @end table
  4516. @subsection Examples
  4517. @example
  4518. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  4519. @end example
  4520. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  4521. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  4522. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  4523. equivalent to:
  4524. @example
  4525. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  4526. @end example
  4527. @section aevalsrc
  4528. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  4529. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  4530. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  4531. audio signal.
  4532. This source accepts the following options:
  4533. @table @option
  4534. @item exprs
  4535. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  4536. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  4537. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  4538. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  4539. @item channel_layout, c
  4540. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  4541. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  4542. @item duration, d
  4543. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  4544. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4545. for the accepted syntax.
  4546. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  4547. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  4548. complete frame.
  4549. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  4550. supposed to be generated forever.
  4551. @item nb_samples, n
  4552. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  4553. default to 1024.
  4554. @item sample_rate, s
  4555. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  4556. @end table
  4557. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  4558. @table @option
  4559. @item n
  4560. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  4561. @item t
  4562. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  4563. @item s
  4564. sample rate
  4565. @end table
  4566. @subsection Examples
  4567. @itemize
  4568. @item
  4569. Generate silence:
  4570. @example
  4571. aevalsrc=0
  4572. @end example
  4573. @item
  4574. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  4575. 8000 Hz:
  4576. @example
  4577. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  4578. @end example
  4579. @item
  4580. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  4581. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  4582. @example
  4583. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  4584. @end example
  4585. @item
  4586. Generate white noise:
  4587. @example
  4588. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  4589. @end example
  4590. @item
  4591. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  4592. @example
  4593. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  4594. @end example
  4595. @item
  4596. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  4597. @example
  4598. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  4599. @end example
  4600. @end itemize
  4601. @section afirsrc
  4602. Generate a FIR coefficients using frequency sampling method.
  4603. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4604. The filter accepts the following options:
  4605. @table @option
  4606. @item taps, t
  4607. Set number of filter coefficents in output audio stream.
  4608. Default value is 1025.
  4609. @item frequency, f
  4610. Set frequency points from where magnitude and phase are set.
  4611. This must be in non decreasing order, and first element must be 0, while last element
  4612. must be 1. Elements are separated by white spaces.
  4613. @item magnitude, m
  4614. Set magnitude value for every frequency point set by @option{frequency}.
  4615. Number of values must be same as number of frequency points.
  4616. Values are separated by white spaces.
  4617. @item phase, p
  4618. Set phase value for every frequency point set by @option{frequency}.
  4619. Number of values must be same as number of frequency points.
  4620. Values are separated by white spaces.
  4621. @item sample_rate, r
  4622. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4623. @item nb_samples, n
  4624. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4625. @item win_func, w
  4626. Set window function. Default is blackman.
  4627. @end table
  4628. @section anullsrc
  4629. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  4630. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  4631. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  4632. synth filter).
  4633. This source accepts the following options:
  4634. @table @option
  4635. @item channel_layout, cl
  4636. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  4637. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  4638. is "stereo".
  4639. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  4640. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  4641. channel layout values.
  4642. @item sample_rate, r
  4643. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  4644. @item nb_samples, n
  4645. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  4646. @end table
  4647. @subsection Examples
  4648. @itemize
  4649. @item
  4650. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  4651. @example
  4652. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  4653. @end example
  4654. @item
  4655. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  4656. @example
  4657. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  4658. @end example
  4659. @end itemize
  4660. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  4661. @section flite
  4662. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  4663. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4664. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  4665. Note that versions of the flite library prior to 2.0 are not thread-safe.
  4666. The filter accepts the following options:
  4667. @table @option
  4668. @item list_voices
  4669. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  4670. immediately. Default value is 0.
  4671. @item nb_samples, n
  4672. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  4673. @item textfile
  4674. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  4675. @item text
  4676. Set the text to speak.
  4677. @item voice, v
  4678. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  4679. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  4680. @end table
  4681. @subsection Examples
  4682. @itemize
  4683. @item
  4684. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  4685. standard flite voice:
  4686. @example
  4687. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  4688. @end example
  4689. @item
  4690. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  4691. @example
  4692. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4693. @end example
  4694. @item
  4695. Input text to ffmpeg:
  4696. @example
  4697. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4698. @end example
  4699. @item
  4700. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  4701. the @code{lavfi} device:
  4702. @example
  4703. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  4704. @end example
  4705. @end itemize
  4706. For more information about libflite, check:
  4707. @url{http://www.festvox.org/flite/}
  4708. @section anoisesrc
  4709. Generate a noise audio signal.
  4710. The filter accepts the following options:
  4711. @table @option
  4712. @item sample_rate, r
  4713. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  4714. @item amplitude, a
  4715. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  4716. is 1.0.
  4717. @item duration, d
  4718. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  4719. results in noise with an infinite length.
  4720. @item color, colour, c
  4721. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, brown,
  4722. blue, violet and velvet. Default color is white.
  4723. @item seed, s
  4724. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  4725. @item nb_samples, n
  4726. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  4727. @end table
  4728. @subsection Examples
  4729. @itemize
  4730. @item
  4731. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  4732. @example
  4733. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  4734. @end example
  4735. @end itemize
  4736. @section hilbert
  4737. Generate odd-tap Hilbert transform FIR coefficients.
  4738. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for phase-shifting
  4739. the signal by 90 degrees.
  4740. This is used in many matrix coding schemes and for analytic signal generation.
  4741. The process is often written as a multiplication by i (or j), the imaginary unit.
  4742. The filter accepts the following options:
  4743. @table @option
  4744. @item sample_rate, s
  4745. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4746. @item taps, t
  4747. Set length of FIR filter, default is 22051.
  4748. @item nb_samples, n
  4749. Set number of samples per each frame.
  4750. @item win_func, w
  4751. Set window function to be used when generating FIR coefficients.
  4752. @end table
  4753. @section sinc
  4754. Generate a sinc kaiser-windowed low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, or band-reject FIR coefficients.
  4755. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4756. The filter accepts the following options:
  4757. @table @option
  4758. @item sample_rate, r
  4759. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4760. @item nb_samples, n
  4761. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4762. @item hp
  4763. Set high-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4764. @item lp
  4765. Set low-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4766. If high-pass frequency is lower than low-pass frequency and low-pass frequency
  4767. is higher than 0 then filter will create band-pass filter coefficients,
  4768. otherwise band-reject filter coefficients.
  4769. @item phase
  4770. Set filter phase response. Default is 50. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.
  4771. @item beta
  4772. Set Kaiser window beta.
  4773. @item att
  4774. Set stop-band attenuation. Default is 120dB, allowed range is from 40 to 180 dB.
  4775. @item round
  4776. Enable rounding, by default is disabled.
  4777. @item hptaps
  4778. Set number of taps for high-pass filter.
  4779. @item lptaps
  4780. Set number of taps for low-pass filter.
  4781. @end table
  4782. @section sine
  4783. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  4784. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  4785. The filter accepts the following options:
  4786. @table @option
  4787. @item frequency, f
  4788. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  4789. @item beep_factor, b
  4790. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  4791. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  4792. @item sample_rate, r
  4793. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  4794. @item duration, d
  4795. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  4796. @item samples_per_frame
  4797. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  4798. The expression can contain the following constants:
  4799. @table @option
  4800. @item n
  4801. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  4802. @item pts
  4803. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  4804. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  4805. @item t
  4806. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  4807. @item TB
  4808. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  4809. @end table
  4810. Default is @code{1024}.
  4811. @end table
  4812. @subsection Examples
  4813. @itemize
  4814. @item
  4815. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  4816. @example
  4817. sine
  4818. @end example
  4819. @item
  4820. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  4821. @example
  4822. sine=220:4:d=5
  4823. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  4824. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  4825. @end example
  4826. @item
  4827. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  4828. pattern:
  4829. @example
  4830. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  4831. @end example
  4832. @end itemize
  4833. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  4834. @chapter Audio Sinks
  4835. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  4836. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  4837. @section abuffersink
  4838. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  4839. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  4840. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  4841. or the options system.
  4842. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  4843. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  4844. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  4845. @section anullsink
  4846. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  4847. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  4848. tools.
  4849. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  4850. @chapter Video Filters
  4851. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  4852. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  4853. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  4854. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  4855. build.
  4856. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  4857. @section addroi
  4858. Mark a region of interest in a video frame.
  4859. The frame data is passed through unchanged, but metadata is attached
  4860. to the frame indicating regions of interest which can affect the
  4861. behaviour of later encoding. Multiple regions can be marked by
  4862. applying the filter multiple times.
  4863. @table @option
  4864. @item x
  4865. Region distance in pixels from the left edge of the frame.
  4866. @item y
  4867. Region distance in pixels from the top edge of the frame.
  4868. @item w
  4869. Region width in pixels.
  4870. @item h
  4871. Region height in pixels.
  4872. The parameters @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are expressions,
  4873. and may contain the following variables:
  4874. @table @option
  4875. @item iw
  4876. Width of the input frame.
  4877. @item ih
  4878. Height of the input frame.
  4879. @end table
  4880. @item qoffset
  4881. Quantisation offset to apply within the region.
  4882. This must be a real value in the range -1 to +1. A value of zero
  4883. indicates no quality change. A negative value asks for better quality
  4884. (less quantisation), while a positive value asks for worse quality
  4885. (greater quantisation).
  4886. The range is calibrated so that the extreme values indicate the
  4887. largest possible offset - if the rest of the frame is encoded with the
  4888. worst possible quality, an offset of -1 indicates that this region
  4889. should be encoded with the best possible quality anyway. Intermediate
  4890. values are then interpolated in some codec-dependent way.
  4891. For example, in 10-bit H.264 the quantisation parameter varies between
  4892. -12 and 51. A typical qoffset value of -1/10 therefore indicates that
  4893. this region should be encoded with a QP around one-tenth of the full
  4894. range better than the rest of the frame. So, if most of the frame
  4895. were to be encoded with a QP of around 30, this region would get a QP
  4896. of around 24 (an offset of approximately -1/10 * (51 - -12) = -6.3).
  4897. An extreme value of -1 would indicate that this region should be
  4898. encoded with the best possible quality regardless of the treatment of
  4899. the rest of the frame - that is, should be encoded at a QP of -12.
  4900. @item clear
  4901. If set to true, remove any existing regions of interest marked on the
  4902. frame before adding the new one.
  4903. @end table
  4904. @subsection Examples
  4905. @itemize
  4906. @item
  4907. Mark the centre quarter of the frame as interesting.
  4908. @example
  4909. addroi=iw/4:ih/4:iw/2:ih/2:-1/10
  4910. @end example
  4911. @item
  4912. Mark the 100-pixel-wide region on the left edge of the frame as very
  4913. uninteresting (to be encoded at much lower quality than the rest of
  4914. the frame).
  4915. @example
  4916. addroi=0:0:100:ih:+1/5
  4917. @end example
  4918. @end itemize
  4919. @section alphaextract
  4920. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  4921. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  4922. @section alphamerge
  4923. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  4924. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  4925. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  4926. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  4927. channel.
  4928. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  4929. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  4930. @example
  4931. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  4932. @end example
  4933. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  4934. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  4935. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  4936. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  4937. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  4938. @section amplify
  4939. Amplify differences between current pixel and pixels of adjacent frames in
  4940. same pixel location.
  4941. This filter accepts the following options:
  4942. @table @option
  4943. @item radius
  4944. Set frame radius. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 63.
  4945. For example radius of 3 will instruct filter to calculate average of 7 frames.
  4946. @item factor
  4947. Set factor to amplify difference. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4948. @item threshold
  4949. Set threshold for difference amplification. Any difference greater or equal to
  4950. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 10.
  4951. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4952. @item tolerance
  4953. Set tolerance for difference amplification. Any difference lower to
  4954. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 0.
  4955. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4956. @item low
  4957. Set lower limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4958. This option controls maximum possible value that will decrease source pixel value.
  4959. @item high
  4960. Set high limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4961. This option controls maximum possible value that will increase source pixel value.
  4962. @item planes
  4963. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  4964. @end table
  4965. @subsection Commands
  4966. This filter supports the following @ref{commands} that corresponds to option of same name:
  4967. @table @option
  4968. @item factor
  4969. @item threshold
  4970. @item tolerance
  4971. @item low
  4972. @item high
  4973. @item planes
  4974. @end table
  4975. @section ass
  4976. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  4977. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  4978. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  4979. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  4980. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  4981. @table @option
  4982. @item shaping
  4983. Set the shaping engine
  4984. Available values are:
  4985. @table @samp
  4986. @item auto
  4987. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  4988. @item simple
  4989. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  4990. @item complex
  4991. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  4992. @end table
  4993. The default is @code{auto}.
  4994. @end table
  4995. @section atadenoise
  4996. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  4997. The filter accepts the following options:
  4998. @table @option
  4999. @item 0a
  5000. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  5001. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  5002. @item 0b
  5003. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  5004. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  5005. @item 1a
  5006. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  5007. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  5008. @item 1b
  5009. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  5010. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  5011. @item 2a
  5012. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  5013. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  5014. @item 2b
  5015. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  5016. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  5017. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  5018. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  5019. @item s
  5020. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 9. Must be odd
  5021. number in range [5, 129].
  5022. @item p
  5023. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  5024. @item a
  5025. Set what variant of algorithm filter will use for averaging. Default is @code{p} parallel.
  5026. Alternatively can be set to @code{s} serial.
  5027. Parallel can be faster then serial, while other way around is never true.
  5028. Parallel will abort early on first change being greater then thresholds, while serial
  5029. will continue processing other side of frames if they are equal or bellow thresholds.
  5030. @end table
  5031. @subsection Commands
  5032. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options except option @code{s}.
  5033. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5034. @section avgblur
  5035. Apply average blur filter.
  5036. The filter accepts the following options:
  5037. @table @option
  5038. @item sizeX
  5039. Set horizontal radius size.
  5040. @item planes
  5041. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  5042. @item sizeY
  5043. Set vertical radius size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  5044. Default is @code{0}.
  5045. @end table
  5046. @subsection Commands
  5047. This filter supports same commands as options.
  5048. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5049. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5050. value.
  5051. @section bbox
  5052. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  5053. luminance plane.
  5054. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  5055. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  5056. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  5057. log.
  5058. The filter accepts the following option:
  5059. @table @option
  5060. @item min_val
  5061. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  5062. @end table
  5063. @section bilateral
  5064. Apply bilateral filter, spatial smoothing while preserving edges.
  5065. The filter accepts the following options:
  5066. @table @option
  5067. @item sigmaS
  5068. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate spatial weight.
  5069. Allowed range is 0 to 10. Default is 0.1.
  5070. @item sigmaR
  5071. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate range weight.
  5072. Allowed range is 0 to 1. Default is 0.1.
  5073. @item planes
  5074. Set planes to filter. Default is first only.
  5075. @end table
  5076. @section bitplanenoise
  5077. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  5078. The filter accepts the following options:
  5079. @table @option
  5080. @item bitplane
  5081. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  5082. @item filter
  5083. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  5084. Default is disabled.
  5085. @end table
  5086. @section blackdetect
  5087. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  5088. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  5089. recordings.
  5090. The filter outputs its detection analysis to both the log as well as
  5091. frame metadata. If a black segment of at least the specified minimum
  5092. duration is found, a line with the start and end timestamps as well
  5093. as duration is printed to the log with level @code{info}. In addition,
  5094. a log line with level @code{debug} is printed per frame showing the
  5095. black amount detected for that frame.
  5096. The filter also attaches metadata to the first frame of a black
  5097. segment with key @code{lavfi.black_start} and to the first frame
  5098. after the black segment ends with key @code{lavfi.black_end}. The
  5099. value is the frame's timestamp. This metadata is added regardless
  5100. of the minimum duration specified.
  5101. The filter accepts the following options:
  5102. @table @option
  5103. @item black_min_duration, d
  5104. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  5105. be a non-negative floating point number.
  5106. Default value is 2.0.
  5107. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  5108. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  5109. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  5110. @example
  5111. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  5112. @end example
  5113. for which a picture is considered black.
  5114. Default value is 0.98.
  5115. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  5116. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  5117. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  5118. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  5119. the following equation:
  5120. @example
  5121. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  5122. @end example
  5123. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  5124. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  5125. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  5126. Default value is 0.10.
  5127. @end table
  5128. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  5129. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  5130. @example
  5131. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  5132. @end example
  5133. @section blackframe
  5134. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  5135. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  5136. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  5137. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  5138. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  5139. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  5140. This filter exports frame metadata @code{lavfi.blackframe.pblack}.
  5141. The value represents the percentage of pixels in the picture that
  5142. are below the threshold value.
  5143. It accepts the following parameters:
  5144. @table @option
  5145. @item amount
  5146. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  5147. @code{98}.
  5148. @item threshold, thresh
  5149. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  5150. @code{32}.
  5151. @end table
  5152. @anchor{blend}
  5153. @section blend
  5154. Blend two video frames into each other.
  5155. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  5156. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  5157. "bottom" layer. By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.
  5158. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  5159. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  5160. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  5161. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5162. @table @option
  5163. @item c0_mode
  5164. @item c1_mode
  5165. @item c2_mode
  5166. @item c3_mode
  5167. @item all_mode
  5168. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5169. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  5170. Available values for component modes are:
  5171. @table @samp
  5172. @item addition
  5173. @item grainmerge
  5174. @item and
  5175. @item average
  5176. @item burn
  5177. @item darken
  5178. @item difference
  5179. @item grainextract
  5180. @item divide
  5181. @item dodge
  5182. @item freeze
  5183. @item exclusion
  5184. @item extremity
  5185. @item glow
  5186. @item hardlight
  5187. @item hardmix
  5188. @item heat
  5189. @item lighten
  5190. @item linearlight
  5191. @item multiply
  5192. @item multiply128
  5193. @item negation
  5194. @item normal
  5195. @item or
  5196. @item overlay
  5197. @item phoenix
  5198. @item pinlight
  5199. @item reflect
  5200. @item screen
  5201. @item softlight
  5202. @item subtract
  5203. @item vividlight
  5204. @item xor
  5205. @end table
  5206. @item c0_opacity
  5207. @item c1_opacity
  5208. @item c2_opacity
  5209. @item c3_opacity
  5210. @item all_opacity
  5211. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5212. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  5213. @item c0_expr
  5214. @item c1_expr
  5215. @item c2_expr
  5216. @item c3_expr
  5217. @item all_expr
  5218. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5219. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  5220. The expressions can use the following variables:
  5221. @table @option
  5222. @item N
  5223. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  5224. @item X
  5225. @item Y
  5226. the coordinates of the current sample
  5227. @item W
  5228. @item H
  5229. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  5230. @item SW
  5231. @item SH
  5232. Width and height scale for the plane being filtered. It is the
  5233. ratio between the dimensions of the current plane to the luma plane,
  5234. e.g. for a @code{yuv420p} frame, the values are @code{1,1} for
  5235. the luma plane and @code{0.5,0.5} for the chroma planes.
  5236. @item T
  5237. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  5238. @item TOP, A
  5239. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  5240. @item BOTTOM, B
  5241. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  5242. @end table
  5243. @end table
  5244. The @code{blend} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5245. @subsection Examples
  5246. @itemize
  5247. @item
  5248. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  5249. @example
  5250. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  5251. @end example
  5252. @item
  5253. Apply linear horizontal transition from top layer to bottom layer:
  5254. @example
  5255. blend=all_expr='A*(X/W)+B*(1-X/W)'
  5256. @end example
  5257. @item
  5258. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  5259. @example
  5260. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  5261. @end example
  5262. @item
  5263. Apply uncover left effect:
  5264. @example
  5265. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  5266. @end example
  5267. @item
  5268. Apply uncover down effect:
  5269. @example
  5270. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  5271. @end example
  5272. @item
  5273. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  5274. @example
  5275. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  5276. @end example
  5277. @item
  5278. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  5279. @example
  5280. blend=all_expr='if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)'
  5281. @end example
  5282. @item
  5283. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  5284. @example
  5285. tblend=all_mode=grainextract
  5286. @end example
  5287. @end itemize
  5288. @section bm3d
  5289. Denoise frames using Block-Matching 3D algorithm.
  5290. The filter accepts the following options.
  5291. @table @option
  5292. @item sigma
  5293. Set denoising strength. Default value is 1.
  5294. Allowed range is from 0 to 999.9.
  5295. The denoising algorithm is very sensitive to sigma, so adjust it
  5296. according to the source.
  5297. @item block
  5298. Set local patch size. This sets dimensions in 2D.
  5299. @item bstep
  5300. Set sliding step for processing blocks. Default value is 4.
  5301. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  5302. Smaller values allows processing more reference blocks and is slower.
  5303. @item group
  5304. Set maximal number of similar blocks for 3rd dimension. Default value is 1.
  5305. When set to 1, no block matching is done. Larger values allows more blocks
  5306. in single group.
  5307. Allowed range is from 1 to 256.
  5308. @item range
  5309. Set radius for search block matching. Default is 9.
  5310. Allowed range is from 1 to INT32_MAX.
  5311. @item mstep
  5312. Set step between two search locations for block matching. Default is 1.
  5313. Allowed range is from 1 to 64. Smaller is slower.
  5314. @item thmse
  5315. Set threshold of mean square error for block matching. Valid range is 0 to
  5316. INT32_MAX.
  5317. @item hdthr
  5318. Set thresholding parameter for hard thresholding in 3D transformed domain.
  5319. Larger values results in stronger hard-thresholding filtering in frequency
  5320. domain.
  5321. @item estim
  5322. Set filtering estimation mode. Can be @code{basic} or @code{final}.
  5323. Default is @code{basic}.
  5324. @item ref
  5325. If enabled, filter will use 2nd stream for block matching.
  5326. Default is disabled for @code{basic} value of @var{estim} option,
  5327. and always enabled if value of @var{estim} is @code{final}.
  5328. @item planes
  5329. Set planes to filter. Default is all available except alpha.
  5330. @end table
  5331. @subsection Examples
  5332. @itemize
  5333. @item
  5334. Basic filtering with bm3d:
  5335. @example
  5336. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic
  5337. @end example
  5338. @item
  5339. Same as above, but filtering only luma:
  5340. @example
  5341. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic:planes=1
  5342. @end example
  5343. @item
  5344. Same as above, but with both estimation modes:
  5345. @example
  5346. split[a][b],[a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5347. @end example
  5348. @item
  5349. Same as above, but prefilter with @ref{nlmeans} filter instead:
  5350. @example
  5351. split[a][b],[a]nlmeans=s=3:r=7:p=3[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5352. @end example
  5353. @end itemize
  5354. @section boxblur
  5355. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  5356. It accepts the following parameters:
  5357. @table @option
  5358. @item luma_radius, lr
  5359. @item luma_power, lp
  5360. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5361. @item chroma_power, cp
  5362. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5363. @item alpha_power, ap
  5364. @end table
  5365. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5366. @table @option
  5367. @item luma_radius, lr
  5368. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5369. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5370. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  5371. corresponding input plane.
  5372. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  5373. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  5374. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  5375. planes.
  5376. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  5377. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  5378. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  5379. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  5380. @table @option
  5381. @item w
  5382. @item h
  5383. The input width and height in pixels.
  5384. @item cw
  5385. @item ch
  5386. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  5387. @item hsub
  5388. @item vsub
  5389. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  5390. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5391. @end table
  5392. @item luma_power, lp
  5393. @item chroma_power, cp
  5394. @item alpha_power, ap
  5395. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  5396. corresponding plane.
  5397. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  5398. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  5399. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  5400. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  5401. @end table
  5402. @subsection Examples
  5403. @itemize
  5404. @item
  5405. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  5406. set to 2:
  5407. @example
  5408. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  5409. boxblur=2:1
  5410. @end example
  5411. @item
  5412. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  5413. @example
  5414. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  5415. @end example
  5416. @item
  5417. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  5418. @example
  5419. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  5420. @end example
  5421. @end itemize
  5422. @section bwdif
  5423. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  5424. Deinterlacing Filter").
  5425. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  5426. interpolation algorithms.
  5427. It accepts the following parameters:
  5428. @table @option
  5429. @item mode
  5430. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  5431. @table @option
  5432. @item 0, send_frame
  5433. Output one frame for each frame.
  5434. @item 1, send_field
  5435. Output one frame for each field.
  5436. @end table
  5437. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  5438. @item parity
  5439. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  5440. of the following values:
  5441. @table @option
  5442. @item 0, tff
  5443. Assume the top field is first.
  5444. @item 1, bff
  5445. Assume the bottom field is first.
  5446. @item -1, auto
  5447. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  5448. @end table
  5449. The default value is @code{auto}.
  5450. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  5451. top field first will be assumed.
  5452. @item deint
  5453. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  5454. values:
  5455. @table @option
  5456. @item 0, all
  5457. Deinterlace all frames.
  5458. @item 1, interlaced
  5459. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  5460. @end table
  5461. The default value is @code{all}.
  5462. @end table
  5463. @section cas
  5464. Apply Contrast Adaptive Sharpen filter to video stream.
  5465. The filter accepts the following options:
  5466. @table @option
  5467. @item strength
  5468. Set the sharpening strength. Default value is 0.
  5469. @item planes
  5470. Set planes to filter. Default value is to filter all
  5471. planes except alpha plane.
  5472. @end table
  5473. @section chromahold
  5474. Remove all color information for all colors except for certain one.
  5475. The filter accepts the following options:
  5476. @table @option
  5477. @item color
  5478. The color which will not be replaced with neutral chroma.
  5479. @item similarity
  5480. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5481. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5482. @item blend
  5483. Blend percentage.
  5484. 0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.
  5485. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5486. @item yuv
  5487. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5488. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5489. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5490. @end table
  5491. @subsection Commands
  5492. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5493. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5494. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5495. value.
  5496. @section chromakey
  5497. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  5498. The filter accepts the following options:
  5499. @table @option
  5500. @item color
  5501. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5502. @item similarity
  5503. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5504. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5505. @item blend
  5506. Blend percentage.
  5507. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5508. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5509. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5510. @item yuv
  5511. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5512. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5513. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5514. @end table
  5515. @subsection Commands
  5516. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5517. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5518. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5519. value.
  5520. @subsection Examples
  5521. @itemize
  5522. @item
  5523. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5524. @example
  5525. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  5526. @end example
  5527. @item
  5528. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  5529. @example
  5530. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  5531. @end example
  5532. @end itemize
  5533. @section chromashift
  5534. Shift chroma pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  5535. The filter accepts the following options:
  5536. @table @option
  5537. @item cbh
  5538. Set amount to shift chroma-blue horizontally.
  5539. @item cbv
  5540. Set amount to shift chroma-blue vertically.
  5541. @item crh
  5542. Set amount to shift chroma-red horizontally.
  5543. @item crv
  5544. Set amount to shift chroma-red vertically.
  5545. @item edge
  5546. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  5547. @end table
  5548. @subsection Commands
  5549. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5550. @section ciescope
  5551. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  5552. The filter accepts the following options:
  5553. @table @option
  5554. @item system
  5555. Set color system.
  5556. @table @samp
  5557. @item ntsc, 470m
  5558. @item ebu, 470bg
  5559. @item smpte
  5560. @item 240m
  5561. @item apple
  5562. @item widergb
  5563. @item cie1931
  5564. @item rec709, hdtv
  5565. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  5566. @item dcip3
  5567. @end table
  5568. @item cie
  5569. Set CIE system.
  5570. @table @samp
  5571. @item xyy
  5572. @item ucs
  5573. @item luv
  5574. @end table
  5575. @item gamuts
  5576. Set what gamuts to draw.
  5577. See @code{system} option for available values.
  5578. @item size, s
  5579. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  5580. @item intensity, i
  5581. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  5582. @item contrast
  5583. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  5584. @item corrgamma
  5585. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  5586. @item showwhite
  5587. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  5588. @item gamma
  5589. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  5590. @end table
  5591. @section codecview
  5592. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  5593. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  5594. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  5595. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  5596. The filter accepts the following option:
  5597. @table @option
  5598. @item mv
  5599. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  5600. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  5601. @table @samp
  5602. @item pf
  5603. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  5604. @item bf
  5605. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5606. @item bb
  5607. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5608. @end table
  5609. @item qp
  5610. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  5611. @item mv_type, mvt
  5612. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  5613. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  5614. @table @samp
  5615. @item fp
  5616. forward predicted MVs
  5617. @item bp
  5618. backward predicted MVs
  5619. @end table
  5620. @item frame_type, ft
  5621. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  5622. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  5623. @table @samp
  5624. @item if
  5625. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  5626. @item pf
  5627. predicted frames (P-frames)
  5628. @item bf
  5629. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  5630. @end table
  5631. @end table
  5632. @subsection Examples
  5633. @itemize
  5634. @item
  5635. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5636. @example
  5637. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  5638. @end example
  5639. @item
  5640. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5641. @example
  5642. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  5643. @end example
  5644. @end itemize
  5645. @section colorbalance
  5646. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  5647. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  5648. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  5649. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  5650. value towards the complementary color.
  5651. The filter accepts the following options:
  5652. @table @option
  5653. @item rs
  5654. @item gs
  5655. @item bs
  5656. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  5657. @item rm
  5658. @item gm
  5659. @item bm
  5660. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  5661. @item rh
  5662. @item gh
  5663. @item bh
  5664. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  5665. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5666. @item pl
  5667. Preserve lightness when changing color balance. Default is disabled.
  5668. @end table
  5669. @subsection Examples
  5670. @itemize
  5671. @item
  5672. Add red color cast to shadows:
  5673. @example
  5674. colorbalance=rs=.3
  5675. @end example
  5676. @end itemize
  5677. @subsection Commands
  5678. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5679. @section colorchannelmixer
  5680. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  5681. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  5682. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  5683. modify is red, the output value will be:
  5684. @example
  5685. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  5686. @end example
  5687. The filter accepts the following options:
  5688. @table @option
  5689. @item rr
  5690. @item rg
  5691. @item rb
  5692. @item ra
  5693. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  5694. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  5695. @item gr
  5696. @item gg
  5697. @item gb
  5698. @item ga
  5699. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  5700. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  5701. @item br
  5702. @item bg
  5703. @item bb
  5704. @item ba
  5705. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  5706. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  5707. @item ar
  5708. @item ag
  5709. @item ab
  5710. @item aa
  5711. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  5712. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  5713. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  5714. @end table
  5715. @subsection Examples
  5716. @itemize
  5717. @item
  5718. Convert source to grayscale:
  5719. @example
  5720. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  5721. @end example
  5722. @item
  5723. Simulate sepia tones:
  5724. @example
  5725. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  5726. @end example
  5727. @end itemize
  5728. @subsection Commands
  5729. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5730. @section colorkey
  5731. RGB colorspace color keying.
  5732. The filter accepts the following options:
  5733. @table @option
  5734. @item color
  5735. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5736. @item similarity
  5737. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5738. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5739. @item blend
  5740. Blend percentage.
  5741. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5742. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5743. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5744. @end table
  5745. @subsection Examples
  5746. @itemize
  5747. @item
  5748. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5749. @example
  5750. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  5751. @end example
  5752. @item
  5753. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  5754. @example
  5755. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  5756. @end example
  5757. @end itemize
  5758. @subsection Commands
  5759. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5760. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5761. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5762. value.
  5763. @section colorhold
  5764. Remove all color information for all RGB colors except for certain one.
  5765. The filter accepts the following options:
  5766. @table @option
  5767. @item color
  5768. The color which will not be replaced with neutral gray.
  5769. @item similarity
  5770. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5771. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5772. @item blend
  5773. Blend percentage. 0.0 makes pixels fully gray.
  5774. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5775. @end table
  5776. @subsection Commands
  5777. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5778. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5779. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5780. value.
  5781. @section colorlevels
  5782. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  5783. The filter accepts the following options:
  5784. @table @option
  5785. @item rimin
  5786. @item gimin
  5787. @item bimin
  5788. @item aimin
  5789. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  5790. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5791. @item rimax
  5792. @item gimax
  5793. @item bimax
  5794. @item aimax
  5795. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  5796. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5797. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  5798. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  5799. @item romin
  5800. @item gomin
  5801. @item bomin
  5802. @item aomin
  5803. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  5804. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5805. @item romax
  5806. @item gomax
  5807. @item bomax
  5808. @item aomax
  5809. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  5810. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5811. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  5812. @end table
  5813. @subsection Examples
  5814. @itemize
  5815. @item
  5816. Make video output darker:
  5817. @example
  5818. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  5819. @end example
  5820. @item
  5821. Increase contrast:
  5822. @example
  5823. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  5824. @end example
  5825. @item
  5826. Make video output lighter:
  5827. @example
  5828. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  5829. @end example
  5830. @item
  5831. Increase brightness:
  5832. @example
  5833. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  5834. @end example
  5835. @end itemize
  5836. @subsection Commands
  5837. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5838. @section colormatrix
  5839. Convert color matrix.
  5840. The filter accepts the following options:
  5841. @table @option
  5842. @item src
  5843. @item dst
  5844. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  5845. specified.
  5846. The accepted values are:
  5847. @table @samp
  5848. @item bt709
  5849. BT.709
  5850. @item fcc
  5851. FCC
  5852. @item bt601
  5853. BT.601
  5854. @item bt470
  5855. BT.470
  5856. @item bt470bg
  5857. BT.470BG
  5858. @item smpte170m
  5859. SMPTE-170M
  5860. @item smpte240m
  5861. SMPTE-240M
  5862. @item bt2020
  5863. BT.2020
  5864. @end table
  5865. @end table
  5866. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5867. @example
  5868. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  5869. @end example
  5870. @section colorspace
  5871. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  5872. Input video needs to have an even size.
  5873. The filter accepts the following options:
  5874. @table @option
  5875. @anchor{all}
  5876. @item all
  5877. Specify all color properties at once.
  5878. The accepted values are:
  5879. @table @samp
  5880. @item bt470m
  5881. BT.470M
  5882. @item bt470bg
  5883. BT.470BG
  5884. @item bt601-6-525
  5885. BT.601-6 525
  5886. @item bt601-6-625
  5887. BT.601-6 625
  5888. @item bt709
  5889. BT.709
  5890. @item smpte170m
  5891. SMPTE-170M
  5892. @item smpte240m
  5893. SMPTE-240M
  5894. @item bt2020
  5895. BT.2020
  5896. @end table
  5897. @anchor{space}
  5898. @item space
  5899. Specify output colorspace.
  5900. The accepted values are:
  5901. @table @samp
  5902. @item bt709
  5903. BT.709
  5904. @item fcc
  5905. FCC
  5906. @item bt470bg
  5907. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5908. @item smpte170m
  5909. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5910. @item smpte240m
  5911. SMPTE-240M
  5912. @item ycgco
  5913. YCgCo
  5914. @item bt2020ncl
  5915. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  5916. @end table
  5917. @anchor{trc}
  5918. @item trc
  5919. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  5920. The accepted values are:
  5921. @table @samp
  5922. @item bt709
  5923. BT.709
  5924. @item bt470m
  5925. BT.470M
  5926. @item bt470bg
  5927. BT.470BG
  5928. @item gamma22
  5929. Constant gamma of 2.2
  5930. @item gamma28
  5931. Constant gamma of 2.8
  5932. @item smpte170m
  5933. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  5934. @item smpte240m
  5935. SMPTE-240M
  5936. @item srgb
  5937. SRGB
  5938. @item iec61966-2-1
  5939. iec61966-2-1
  5940. @item iec61966-2-4
  5941. iec61966-2-4
  5942. @item xvycc
  5943. xvycc
  5944. @item bt2020-10
  5945. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  5946. @item bt2020-12
  5947. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  5948. @end table
  5949. @anchor{primaries}
  5950. @item primaries
  5951. Specify output color primaries.
  5952. The accepted values are:
  5953. @table @samp
  5954. @item bt709
  5955. BT.709
  5956. @item bt470m
  5957. BT.470M
  5958. @item bt470bg
  5959. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5960. @item smpte170m
  5961. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5962. @item smpte240m
  5963. SMPTE-240M
  5964. @item film
  5965. film
  5966. @item smpte431
  5967. SMPTE-431
  5968. @item smpte432
  5969. SMPTE-432
  5970. @item bt2020
  5971. BT.2020
  5972. @item jedec-p22
  5973. JEDEC P22 phosphors
  5974. @end table
  5975. @anchor{range}
  5976. @item range
  5977. Specify output color range.
  5978. The accepted values are:
  5979. @table @samp
  5980. @item tv
  5981. TV (restricted) range
  5982. @item mpeg
  5983. MPEG (restricted) range
  5984. @item pc
  5985. PC (full) range
  5986. @item jpeg
  5987. JPEG (full) range
  5988. @end table
  5989. @item format
  5990. Specify output color format.
  5991. The accepted values are:
  5992. @table @samp
  5993. @item yuv420p
  5994. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  5995. @item yuv420p10
  5996. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  5997. @item yuv420p12
  5998. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  5999. @item yuv422p
  6000. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  6001. @item yuv422p10
  6002. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  6003. @item yuv422p12
  6004. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  6005. @item yuv444p
  6006. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  6007. @item yuv444p10
  6008. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  6009. @item yuv444p12
  6010. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  6011. @end table
  6012. @item fast
  6013. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  6014. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  6015. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  6016. @item dither
  6017. Specify dithering mode.
  6018. The accepted values are:
  6019. @table @samp
  6020. @item none
  6021. No dithering
  6022. @item fsb
  6023. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  6024. @end table
  6025. @item wpadapt
  6026. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  6027. The accepted values are:
  6028. @table @samp
  6029. @item bradford
  6030. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  6031. @item vonkries
  6032. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  6033. @item identity
  6034. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  6035. @end table
  6036. @item iall
  6037. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  6038. @item ispace
  6039. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  6040. @item iprimaries
  6041. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  6042. @item itrc
  6043. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  6044. @item irange
  6045. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  6046. @end table
  6047. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  6048. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  6049. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  6050. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  6051. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  6052. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  6053. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  6054. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  6055. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  6056. @example
  6057. colorspace=smpte240m
  6058. @end example
  6059. @section convolution
  6060. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 or horizontal/vertical up to 49 elements.
  6061. The filter accepts the following options:
  6062. @table @option
  6063. @item 0m
  6064. @item 1m
  6065. @item 2m
  6066. @item 3m
  6067. Set matrix for each plane.
  6068. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed integers in @var{square} mode,
  6069. and from 1 to 49 odd number of signed integers in @var{row} mode.
  6070. @item 0rdiv
  6071. @item 1rdiv
  6072. @item 2rdiv
  6073. @item 3rdiv
  6074. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  6075. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  6076. @item 0bias
  6077. @item 1bias
  6078. @item 2bias
  6079. @item 3bias
  6080. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  6081. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  6082. @item 0mode
  6083. @item 1mode
  6084. @item 2mode
  6085. @item 3mode
  6086. Set matrix mode for each plane. Can be @var{square}, @var{row} or @var{column}.
  6087. Default is @var{square}.
  6088. @end table
  6089. @subsection Examples
  6090. @itemize
  6091. @item
  6092. Apply sharpen:
  6093. @example
  6094. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  6095. @end example
  6096. @item
  6097. Apply blur:
  6098. @example
  6099. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  6100. @end example
  6101. @item
  6102. Apply edge enhance:
  6103. @example
  6104. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  6105. @end example
  6106. @item
  6107. Apply edge detect:
  6108. @example
  6109. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  6110. @end example
  6111. @item
  6112. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  6113. @example
  6114. convolution="1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0"
  6115. @end example
  6116. @item
  6117. Apply emboss:
  6118. @example
  6119. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  6120. @end example
  6121. @end itemize
  6122. @section convolve
  6123. Apply 2D convolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6124. as impulse.
  6125. The filter accepts the following options:
  6126. @table @option
  6127. @item planes
  6128. Set which planes to process.
  6129. @item impulse
  6130. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6131. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6132. @end table
  6133. The @code{convolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6134. @section copy
  6135. Copy the input video source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  6136. testing purposes.
  6137. @anchor{coreimage}
  6138. @section coreimage
  6139. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  6140. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  6141. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  6142. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  6143. the respective OSX.
  6144. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  6145. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  6146. with its options.
  6147. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  6148. @table @option
  6149. @item list_filters
  6150. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  6151. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  6152. values.
  6153. @example
  6154. list_filters=true
  6155. @end example
  6156. @item filter
  6157. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  6158. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  6159. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  6160. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  6161. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  6162. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  6163. filter.
  6164. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  6165. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  6166. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  6167. @example
  6168. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  6169. @end example
  6170. @item output_rect
  6171. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  6172. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  6173. @example
  6174. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  6175. @end example
  6176. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  6177. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  6178. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  6179. @example
  6180. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  6181. @end example
  6182. @end table
  6183. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  6184. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  6185. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  6186. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  6187. usable as intended.
  6188. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  6189. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  6190. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  6191. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  6192. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  6193. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  6194. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  6195. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  6196. output image.
  6197. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  6198. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  6199. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  6200. @subsection Examples
  6201. @itemize
  6202. @item
  6203. List all filters available:
  6204. @example
  6205. coreimage=list_filters=true
  6206. @end example
  6207. @item
  6208. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  6209. @example
  6210. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  6211. @end example
  6212. @item
  6213. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  6214. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  6215. @example
  6216. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  6217. @end example
  6218. @item
  6219. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  6220. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  6221. @example
  6222. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  6223. @end example
  6224. @end itemize
  6225. @section cover_rect
  6226. Cover a rectangular object
  6227. It accepts the following options:
  6228. @table @option
  6229. @item cover
  6230. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  6231. @item mode
  6232. Set covering mode.
  6233. It accepts the following values:
  6234. @table @samp
  6235. @item cover
  6236. cover it by the supplied image
  6237. @item blur
  6238. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  6239. @end table
  6240. Default value is @var{blur}.
  6241. @end table
  6242. @subsection Examples
  6243. @itemize
  6244. @item
  6245. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6246. @example
  6247. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6248. @end example
  6249. @end itemize
  6250. @section crop
  6251. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  6252. It accepts the following parameters:
  6253. @table @option
  6254. @item w, out_w
  6255. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  6256. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6257. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  6258. @item h, out_h
  6259. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  6260. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6261. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  6262. @item x
  6263. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  6264. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  6265. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6266. @item y
  6267. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  6268. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  6269. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6270. @item keep_aspect
  6271. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  6272. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  6273. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  6274. @item exact
  6275. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  6276. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  6277. It defaults to 0.
  6278. @end table
  6279. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  6280. expressions containing the following constants:
  6281. @table @option
  6282. @item x
  6283. @item y
  6284. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  6285. each new frame.
  6286. @item in_w
  6287. @item in_h
  6288. The input width and height.
  6289. @item iw
  6290. @item ih
  6291. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  6292. @item out_w
  6293. @item out_h
  6294. The output (cropped) width and height.
  6295. @item ow
  6296. @item oh
  6297. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6298. @item a
  6299. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  6300. @item sar
  6301. input sample aspect ratio
  6302. @item dar
  6303. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  6304. @item hsub
  6305. @item vsub
  6306. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6307. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6308. @item n
  6309. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  6310. @item pos
  6311. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  6312. @item t
  6313. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  6314. @end table
  6315. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  6316. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  6317. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  6318. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6319. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  6320. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  6321. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  6322. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  6323. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  6324. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  6325. @subsection Examples
  6326. @itemize
  6327. @item
  6328. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  6329. @example
  6330. crop=100:100:12:34
  6331. @end example
  6332. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  6333. @example
  6334. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  6335. @end example
  6336. @item
  6337. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  6338. @example
  6339. crop=100:100
  6340. @end example
  6341. @item
  6342. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  6343. @example
  6344. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  6345. @end example
  6346. @item
  6347. Crop the input video central square:
  6348. @example
  6349. crop=out_w=in_h
  6350. crop=in_h
  6351. @end example
  6352. @item
  6353. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  6354. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  6355. corner of the input image.
  6356. @example
  6357. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  6358. @end example
  6359. @item
  6360. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  6361. the top and bottom borders
  6362. @example
  6363. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  6364. @end example
  6365. @item
  6366. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  6367. @example
  6368. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  6369. @end example
  6370. @item
  6371. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  6372. @example
  6373. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  6374. @end example
  6375. @item
  6376. Apply trembling effect:
  6377. @example
  6378. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  6379. @end example
  6380. @item
  6381. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  6382. @example
  6383. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  6384. @end example
  6385. @item
  6386. Set x depending on the value of y:
  6387. @example
  6388. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  6389. @end example
  6390. @end itemize
  6391. @subsection Commands
  6392. This filter supports the following commands:
  6393. @table @option
  6394. @item w, out_w
  6395. @item h, out_h
  6396. @item x
  6397. @item y
  6398. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  6399. in the input video.
  6400. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6401. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6402. value.
  6403. @end table
  6404. @section cropdetect
  6405. Auto-detect the crop size.
  6406. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  6407. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  6408. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  6409. It accepts the following parameters:
  6410. @table @option
  6411. @item limit
  6412. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  6413. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  6414. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  6415. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  6416. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  6417. @item round
  6418. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  6419. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  6420. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  6421. encoding to most video codecs.
  6422. @item reset_count, reset
  6423. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  6424. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  6425. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  6426. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  6427. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  6428. playback.
  6429. @end table
  6430. @anchor{cue}
  6431. @section cue
  6432. Delay video filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. The filter first
  6433. passes on @option{preroll} amount of frames, then it buffers at most
  6434. @option{buffer} amount of frames and waits for the cue. After reaching the cue
  6435. it forwards the buffered frames and also any subsequent frames coming in its
  6436. input.
  6437. The filter can be used synchronize the output of multiple ffmpeg processes for
  6438. realtime output devices like decklink. By putting the delay in the filtering
  6439. chain and pre-buffering frames the process can pass on data to output almost
  6440. immediately after the target wallclock timestamp is reached.
  6441. Perfect frame accuracy cannot be guaranteed, but the result is good enough for
  6442. some use cases.
  6443. @table @option
  6444. @item cue
  6445. The cue timestamp expressed in a UNIX timestamp in microseconds. Default is 0.
  6446. @item preroll
  6447. The duration of content to pass on as preroll expressed in seconds. Default is 0.
  6448. @item buffer
  6449. The maximum duration of content to buffer before waiting for the cue expressed
  6450. in seconds. Default is 0.
  6451. @end table
  6452. @anchor{curves}
  6453. @section curves
  6454. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  6455. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  6456. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  6457. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  6458. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  6459. the output frame.
  6460. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  6461. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  6462. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  6463. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  6464. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  6465. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  6466. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  6467. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  6468. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  6469. The filter accepts the following options:
  6470. @table @option
  6471. @item preset
  6472. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  6473. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  6474. options takes priority on the preset values.
  6475. Available presets are:
  6476. @table @samp
  6477. @item none
  6478. @item color_negative
  6479. @item cross_process
  6480. @item darker
  6481. @item increase_contrast
  6482. @item lighter
  6483. @item linear_contrast
  6484. @item medium_contrast
  6485. @item negative
  6486. @item strong_contrast
  6487. @item vintage
  6488. @end table
  6489. Default is @code{none}.
  6490. @item master, m
  6491. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  6492. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  6493. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  6494. post-processing LUT.
  6495. @item red, r
  6496. Set the key points for the red component.
  6497. @item green, g
  6498. Set the key points for the green component.
  6499. @item blue, b
  6500. Set the key points for the blue component.
  6501. @item all
  6502. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  6503. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  6504. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  6505. @option{all} setting.
  6506. @item psfile
  6507. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  6508. @item plot
  6509. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  6510. @end table
  6511. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  6512. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  6513. @subsection Examples
  6514. @itemize
  6515. @item
  6516. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  6517. @example
  6518. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  6519. @end example
  6520. @item
  6521. Vintage effect:
  6522. @example
  6523. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  6524. @end example
  6525. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  6526. @table @var
  6527. @item red
  6528. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  6529. @item green
  6530. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  6531. @item blue
  6532. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  6533. @end table
  6534. @item
  6535. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  6536. @example
  6537. curves=preset=vintage
  6538. @end example
  6539. @item
  6540. Or simply:
  6541. @example
  6542. curves=vintage
  6543. @end example
  6544. @item
  6545. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  6546. @example
  6547. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  6548. @end example
  6549. @item
  6550. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  6551. and @command{gnuplot}:
  6552. @example
  6553. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  6554. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  6555. @end example
  6556. @end itemize
  6557. @section datascope
  6558. Video data analysis filter.
  6559. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  6560. The filter accepts the following options:
  6561. @table @option
  6562. @item size, s
  6563. Set output video size.
  6564. @item x
  6565. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  6566. @item y
  6567. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  6568. @item mode
  6569. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  6570. @table @samp
  6571. @item mono
  6572. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  6573. @item color
  6574. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  6575. background.
  6576. @item color2
  6577. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  6578. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  6579. @end table
  6580. @item axis
  6581. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  6582. @item opacity
  6583. Set background opacity.
  6584. @item format
  6585. Set display number format. Can be @code{hex}, or @code{dec}. Default is @code{hex}.
  6586. @end table
  6587. @section dblur
  6588. Apply Directional blur filter.
  6589. The filter accepts the following options:
  6590. @table @option
  6591. @item angle
  6592. Set angle of directional blur. Default is @code{45}.
  6593. @item radius
  6594. Set radius of directional blur. Default is @code{5}.
  6595. @item planes
  6596. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  6597. @end table
  6598. @subsection Commands
  6599. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  6600. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6601. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6602. value.
  6603. @section dctdnoiz
  6604. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  6605. This filter is not designed for real time.
  6606. The filter accepts the following options:
  6607. @table @option
  6608. @item sigma, s
  6609. Set the noise sigma constant.
  6610. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  6611. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  6612. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  6613. Default is @code{0}.
  6614. @item overlap
  6615. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  6616. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  6617. risk of various artefacts.
  6618. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  6619. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  6620. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  6621. @item expr, e
  6622. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  6623. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  6624. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  6625. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  6626. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  6627. variable.
  6628. @item n
  6629. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  6630. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  6631. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  6632. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  6633. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  6634. better de-noising.
  6635. @end table
  6636. @subsection Examples
  6637. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  6638. @example
  6639. dctdnoiz=4.5
  6640. @end example
  6641. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  6642. @example
  6643. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  6644. @end example
  6645. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  6646. @example
  6647. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  6648. @end example
  6649. @section deband
  6650. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  6651. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  6652. The filter accepts the following options:
  6653. @table @option
  6654. @item 1thr
  6655. @item 2thr
  6656. @item 3thr
  6657. @item 4thr
  6658. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  6659. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  6660. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  6661. it will be considered as banded.
  6662. @item range, r
  6663. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  6664. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  6665. will be used.
  6666. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  6667. @item direction, d
  6668. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  6669. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  6670. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  6671. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  6672. column.
  6673. @item blur, b
  6674. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  6675. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  6676. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  6677. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  6678. @item coupling, c
  6679. If enabled, current pixel is changed if and only if all pixel components are banded,
  6680. e.g. banding detection threshold is triggered for all color components.
  6681. The default is disabled.
  6682. @end table
  6683. @section deblock
  6684. Remove blocking artifacts from input video.
  6685. The filter accepts the following options:
  6686. @table @option
  6687. @item filter
  6688. Set filter type, can be @var{weak} or @var{strong}. Default is @var{strong}.
  6689. This controls what kind of deblocking is applied.
  6690. @item block
  6691. Set size of block, allowed range is from 4 to 512. Default is @var{8}.
  6692. @item alpha
  6693. @item beta
  6694. @item gamma
  6695. @item delta
  6696. Set blocking detection thresholds. Allowed range is 0 to 1.
  6697. Defaults are: @var{0.098} for @var{alpha} and @var{0.05} for the rest.
  6698. Using higher threshold gives more deblocking strength.
  6699. Setting @var{alpha} controls threshold detection at exact edge of block.
  6700. Remaining options controls threshold detection near the edge. Each one for
  6701. below/above or left/right. Setting any of those to @var{0} disables
  6702. deblocking.
  6703. @item planes
  6704. Set planes to filter. Default is to filter all available planes.
  6705. @end table
  6706. @subsection Examples
  6707. @itemize
  6708. @item
  6709. Deblock using weak filter and block size of 4 pixels.
  6710. @example
  6711. deblock=filter=weak:block=4
  6712. @end example
  6713. @item
  6714. Deblock using strong filter, block size of 4 pixels and custom thresholds for
  6715. deblocking more edges.
  6716. @example
  6717. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05
  6718. @end example
  6719. @item
  6720. Similar as above, but filter only first plane.
  6721. @example
  6722. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=1
  6723. @end example
  6724. @item
  6725. Similar as above, but filter only second and third plane.
  6726. @example
  6727. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=6
  6728. @end example
  6729. @end itemize
  6730. @anchor{decimate}
  6731. @section decimate
  6732. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  6733. The filter accepts the following options:
  6734. @table @option
  6735. @item cycle
  6736. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  6737. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  6738. Default is @code{5}.
  6739. @item dupthresh
  6740. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  6741. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  6742. is @code{1.1}
  6743. @item scthresh
  6744. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  6745. @item blockx
  6746. @item blocky
  6747. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  6748. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  6749. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  6750. @item ppsrc
  6751. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  6752. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  6753. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  6754. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  6755. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  6756. @code{0}.
  6757. @item chroma
  6758. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  6759. @code{1}.
  6760. @end table
  6761. @section deconvolve
  6762. Apply 2D deconvolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6763. as impulse.
  6764. The filter accepts the following options:
  6765. @table @option
  6766. @item planes
  6767. Set which planes to process.
  6768. @item impulse
  6769. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6770. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6771. @item noise
  6772. Set noise when doing divisions. Default is @var{0.0000001}. Useful when width
  6773. and height are not same and not power of 2 or if stream prior to convolving
  6774. had noise.
  6775. @end table
  6776. The @code{deconvolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6777. @section dedot
  6778. Reduce cross-luminance (dot-crawl) and cross-color (rainbows) from video.
  6779. It accepts the following options:
  6780. @table @option
  6781. @item m
  6782. Set mode of operation. Can be combination of @var{dotcrawl} for cross-luminance reduction and/or
  6783. @var{rainbows} for cross-color reduction.
  6784. @item lt
  6785. Set spatial luma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6786. @item tl
  6787. Set tolerance for temporal luma. Higher values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6788. @item tc
  6789. Set tolerance for chroma temporal variation. Higher values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6790. @item ct
  6791. Set temporal chroma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6792. @end table
  6793. @section deflate
  6794. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  6795. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6796. only values lower than the pixel.
  6797. It accepts the following options:
  6798. @table @option
  6799. @item threshold0
  6800. @item threshold1
  6801. @item threshold2
  6802. @item threshold3
  6803. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6804. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6805. @end table
  6806. @subsection Commands
  6807. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  6808. @section deflicker
  6809. Remove temporal frame luminance variations.
  6810. It accepts the following options:
  6811. @table @option
  6812. @item size, s
  6813. Set moving-average filter size in frames. Default is 5. Allowed range is 2 - 129.
  6814. @item mode, m
  6815. Set averaging mode to smooth temporal luminance variations.
  6816. Available values are:
  6817. @table @samp
  6818. @item am
  6819. Arithmetic mean
  6820. @item gm
  6821. Geometric mean
  6822. @item hm
  6823. Harmonic mean
  6824. @item qm
  6825. Quadratic mean
  6826. @item cm
  6827. Cubic mean
  6828. @item pm
  6829. Power mean
  6830. @item median
  6831. Median
  6832. @end table
  6833. @item bypass
  6834. Do not actually modify frame. Useful when one only wants metadata.
  6835. @end table
  6836. @section dejudder
  6837. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  6838. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  6839. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  6840. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  6841. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  6842. rate video.
  6843. The option available in this filter is:
  6844. @table @option
  6845. @item cycle
  6846. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  6847. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  6848. @table @samp
  6849. @item 4
  6850. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  6851. @item 5
  6852. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  6853. @item 20
  6854. If a mixture of the two.
  6855. @end table
  6856. The default is @samp{4}.
  6857. @end table
  6858. @section delogo
  6859. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  6860. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  6861. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  6862. It accepts the following parameters:
  6863. @table @option
  6864. @item x
  6865. @item y
  6866. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  6867. specified.
  6868. @item w
  6869. @item h
  6870. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  6871. specified.
  6872. @item band, t
  6873. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  6874. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  6875. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  6876. is not recommended.
  6877. @item show
  6878. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  6879. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  6880. The default value is 0.
  6881. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  6882. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  6883. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  6884. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  6885. @end table
  6886. @subsection Examples
  6887. @itemize
  6888. @item
  6889. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  6890. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  6891. @example
  6892. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  6893. @end example
  6894. @end itemize
  6895. @anchor{derain}
  6896. @section derain
  6897. Remove the rain in the input image/video by applying the derain methods based on
  6898. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  6899. @itemize
  6900. @item
  6901. Recurrent Squeeze-and-Excitation Context Aggregation Net (RESCAN).
  6902. See @url{http://openaccess.thecvf.com/content_ECCV_2018/papers/Xia_Li_Recurrent_Squeeze-and-Excitation_Context_ECCV_2018_paper.pdf}.
  6903. @end itemize
  6904. Training as well as model generation scripts are provided in
  6905. the repository at @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/derain_filter.git}.
  6906. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  6907. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6908. The filter accepts the following options:
  6909. @table @option
  6910. @item filter_type
  6911. Specify which filter to use. This option accepts the following values:
  6912. @table @samp
  6913. @item derain
  6914. Derain filter. To conduct derain filter, you need to use a derain model.
  6915. @item dehaze
  6916. Dehaze filter. To conduct dehaze filter, you need to use a dehaze model.
  6917. @end table
  6918. Default value is @samp{derain}.
  6919. @item dnn_backend
  6920. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6921. the following values:
  6922. @table @samp
  6923. @item native
  6924. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6925. @item tensorflow
  6926. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6927. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6928. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6929. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6930. @end table
  6931. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6932. @item model
  6933. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6934. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6935. backend can load files for only its format.
  6936. @end table
  6937. It can also be finished with @ref{dnn_processing} filter.
  6938. @section deshake
  6939. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  6940. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  6941. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  6942. The filter accepts the following options:
  6943. @table @option
  6944. @item x
  6945. @item y
  6946. @item w
  6947. @item h
  6948. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  6949. vectors.
  6950. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  6951. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  6952. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  6953. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  6954. box.
  6955. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  6956. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  6957. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  6958. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  6959. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  6960. Default - search the whole frame.
  6961. @item rx
  6962. @item ry
  6963. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  6964. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  6965. @item edge
  6966. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  6967. frame. Available values are:
  6968. @table @samp
  6969. @item blank, 0
  6970. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  6971. @item original, 1
  6972. Original image at blank locations
  6973. @item clamp, 2
  6974. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  6975. @item mirror, 3
  6976. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  6977. @end table
  6978. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  6979. @item blocksize
  6980. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  6981. default 8.
  6982. @item contrast
  6983. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  6984. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  6985. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  6986. @item search
  6987. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  6988. @table @samp
  6989. @item exhaustive, 0
  6990. Set exhaustive search
  6991. @item less, 1
  6992. Set less exhaustive search.
  6993. @end table
  6994. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  6995. @item filename
  6996. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  6997. specified file.
  6998. @end table
  6999. @section despill
  7000. Remove unwanted contamination of foreground colors, caused by reflected color of
  7001. greenscreen or bluescreen.
  7002. This filter accepts the following options:
  7003. @table @option
  7004. @item type
  7005. Set what type of despill to use.
  7006. @item mix
  7007. Set how spillmap will be generated.
  7008. @item expand
  7009. Set how much to get rid of still remaining spill.
  7010. @item red
  7011. Controls amount of red in spill area.
  7012. @item green
  7013. Controls amount of green in spill area.
  7014. Should be -1 for greenscreen.
  7015. @item blue
  7016. Controls amount of blue in spill area.
  7017. Should be -1 for bluescreen.
  7018. @item brightness
  7019. Controls brightness of spill area, preserving colors.
  7020. @item alpha
  7021. Modify alpha from generated spillmap.
  7022. @end table
  7023. @section detelecine
  7024. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  7025. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  7026. to the telecine filter.
  7027. This filter accepts the following options:
  7028. @table @option
  7029. @item first_field
  7030. @table @samp
  7031. @item top, t
  7032. top field first
  7033. @item bottom, b
  7034. bottom field first
  7035. The default value is @code{top}.
  7036. @end table
  7037. @item pattern
  7038. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  7039. The default value is @code{23}.
  7040. @item start_frame
  7041. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  7042. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  7043. @end table
  7044. @section dilation
  7045. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  7046. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  7047. It accepts the following options:
  7048. @table @option
  7049. @item threshold0
  7050. @item threshold1
  7051. @item threshold2
  7052. @item threshold3
  7053. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7054. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7055. @item coordinates
  7056. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7057. pixels are used.
  7058. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7059. 1 2 3
  7060. 4 5
  7061. 6 7 8
  7062. @end table
  7063. @subsection Commands
  7064. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  7065. @section displace
  7066. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  7067. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  7068. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  7069. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  7070. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  7071. along the y-axis.
  7072. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  7073. displacement map will be used.
  7074. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  7075. A description of the accepted options follows.
  7076. @table @option
  7077. @item edge
  7078. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  7079. Available values are:
  7080. @table @samp
  7081. @item blank
  7082. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  7083. @item smear
  7084. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  7085. @item wrap
  7086. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  7087. @item mirror
  7088. Out of range pixels will be replaced with mirrored pixels.
  7089. @end table
  7090. Default is @samp{smear}.
  7091. @end table
  7092. @subsection Examples
  7093. @itemize
  7094. @item
  7095. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  7096. @example
  7097. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  7098. @end example
  7099. @item
  7100. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  7101. @example
  7102. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  7103. @end example
  7104. @end itemize
  7105. @anchor{dnn_processing}
  7106. @section dnn_processing
  7107. Do image processing with deep neural networks. It works together with another filter
  7108. which converts the pixel format of the Frame to what the dnn network requires.
  7109. The filter accepts the following options:
  7110. @table @option
  7111. @item dnn_backend
  7112. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  7113. the following values:
  7114. @table @samp
  7115. @item native
  7116. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  7117. @item tensorflow
  7118. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  7119. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  7120. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  7121. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  7122. @item openvino
  7123. OpenVINO backend. To enable this backend you
  7124. need to build and install the OpenVINO for C library (see
  7125. @url{https://github.com/openvinotoolkit/openvino/blob/master/build-instruction.md}) and configure FFmpeg with
  7126. @code{--enable-libopenvino} (--extra-cflags=-I... --extra-ldflags=-L... might
  7127. be needed if the header files and libraries are not installed into system path)
  7128. @end table
  7129. Default value is @samp{native}.
  7130. @item model
  7131. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  7132. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow, OpenVINO and native
  7133. backend can load files for only its format.
  7134. Native model file (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model file (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  7135. @item input
  7136. Set the input name of the dnn network.
  7137. @item output
  7138. Set the output name of the dnn network.
  7139. @end table
  7140. @subsection Examples
  7141. @itemize
  7142. @item
  7143. Remove rain in rgb24 frame with can.pb (see @ref{derain} filter):
  7144. @example
  7145. ./ffmpeg -i rain.jpg -vf format=rgb24,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=can.pb:input=x:output=y derain.jpg
  7146. @end example
  7147. @item
  7148. Halve the pixel value of the frame with format gray32f:
  7149. @example
  7150. ffmpeg -i input.jpg -vf format=grayf32,dnn_processing=model=halve_gray_float.model:input=dnn_in:output=dnn_out:dnn_backend=native -y out.native.png
  7151. @end example
  7152. @item
  7153. Handle the Y channel with srcnn.pb (see @ref{sr} filter) for frame with yuv420p (planar YUV formats supported):
  7154. @example
  7155. ./ffmpeg -i 480p.jpg -vf format=yuv420p,scale=w=iw*2:h=ih*2,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=srcnn.pb:input=x:output=y -y srcnn.jpg
  7156. @end example
  7157. @item
  7158. Handle the Y channel with espcn.pb (see @ref{sr} filter), which changes frame size, for format yuv420p (planar YUV formats supported):
  7159. @example
  7160. ./ffmpeg -i 480p.jpg -vf format=yuv420p,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=espcn.pb:input=x:output=y -y tmp.espcn.jpg
  7161. @end example
  7162. @end itemize
  7163. @section drawbox
  7164. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  7165. It accepts the following parameters:
  7166. @table @option
  7167. @item x
  7168. @item y
  7169. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  7170. @item width, w
  7171. @item height, h
  7172. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  7173. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  7174. @item color, c
  7175. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  7176. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7177. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  7178. video with inverted luma.
  7179. @item thickness, t
  7180. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge.
  7181. A value of @code{fill} will create a filled box. Default value is @code{3}.
  7182. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7183. @item replace
  7184. Applicable if the input has alpha. With value @code{1}, the pixels of the painted box
  7185. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7186. Default is @code{0}, which composites the box onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7187. @end table
  7188. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7189. following constants:
  7190. @table @option
  7191. @item dar
  7192. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7193. @item hsub
  7194. @item vsub
  7195. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7196. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7197. @item in_h, ih
  7198. @item in_w, iw
  7199. The input width and height.
  7200. @item sar
  7201. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7202. @item x
  7203. @item y
  7204. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  7205. @item w
  7206. @item h
  7207. The width and height of the drawn box.
  7208. @item t
  7209. The thickness of the drawn box.
  7210. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7211. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7212. @end table
  7213. @subsection Examples
  7214. @itemize
  7215. @item
  7216. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  7217. @example
  7218. drawbox
  7219. @end example
  7220. @item
  7221. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7222. @example
  7223. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  7224. @end example
  7225. The previous example can be specified as:
  7226. @example
  7227. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  7228. @end example
  7229. @item
  7230. Fill the box with pink color:
  7231. @example
  7232. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=fill
  7233. @end example
  7234. @item
  7235. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  7236. @example
  7237. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  7238. @end example
  7239. @end itemize
  7240. @subsection Commands
  7241. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7242. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7243. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7244. value.
  7245. @anchor{drawgraph}
  7246. @section drawgraph
  7247. Draw a graph using input video metadata.
  7248. It accepts the following parameters:
  7249. @table @option
  7250. @item m1
  7251. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7252. @item fg1
  7253. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  7254. @item m2
  7255. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7256. @item fg2
  7257. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  7258. @item m3
  7259. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7260. @item fg3
  7261. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  7262. @item m4
  7263. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7264. @item fg4
  7265. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  7266. @item min
  7267. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  7268. @item max
  7269. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  7270. @item bg
  7271. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  7272. @item mode
  7273. Set graph mode.
  7274. Available values for mode is:
  7275. @table @samp
  7276. @item bar
  7277. @item dot
  7278. @item line
  7279. @end table
  7280. Default is @code{line}.
  7281. @item slide
  7282. Set slide mode.
  7283. Available values for slide is:
  7284. @table @samp
  7285. @item frame
  7286. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  7287. @item replace
  7288. Replace old columns with new ones.
  7289. @item scroll
  7290. Scroll from right to left.
  7291. @item rscroll
  7292. Scroll from left to right.
  7293. @item picture
  7294. Draw single picture.
  7295. @end table
  7296. Default is @code{frame}.
  7297. @item size
  7298. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  7299. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7300. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  7301. @item rate, r
  7302. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  7303. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  7304. @table @option
  7305. @item MIN
  7306. Minimal value of metadata value.
  7307. @item MAX
  7308. Maximal value of metadata value.
  7309. @item VAL
  7310. Current metadata key value.
  7311. @end table
  7312. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  7313. @end table
  7314. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  7315. @example
  7316. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  7317. @end example
  7318. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  7319. @example
  7320. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  7321. @end example
  7322. @section drawgrid
  7323. Draw a grid on the input image.
  7324. It accepts the following parameters:
  7325. @table @option
  7326. @item x
  7327. @item y
  7328. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  7329. @item width, w
  7330. @item height, h
  7331. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  7332. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  7333. framed. Default to 0.
  7334. @item color, c
  7335. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  7336. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7337. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  7338. video with inverted luma.
  7339. @item thickness, t
  7340. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  7341. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7342. @item replace
  7343. Applicable if the input has alpha. With @code{1} the pixels of the painted grid
  7344. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7345. Default is @code{0}, which composites the grid onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7346. @end table
  7347. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7348. following constants:
  7349. @table @option
  7350. @item dar
  7351. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7352. @item hsub
  7353. @item vsub
  7354. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7355. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7356. @item in_h, ih
  7357. @item in_w, iw
  7358. The input grid cell width and height.
  7359. @item sar
  7360. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7361. @item x
  7362. @item y
  7363. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  7364. @item w
  7365. @item h
  7366. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  7367. @item t
  7368. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  7369. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7370. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7371. @end table
  7372. @subsection Examples
  7373. @itemize
  7374. @item
  7375. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7376. @example
  7377. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  7378. @end example
  7379. @item
  7380. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  7381. @example
  7382. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  7383. @end example
  7384. @end itemize
  7385. @subsection Commands
  7386. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7387. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7388. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7389. value.
  7390. @anchor{drawtext}
  7391. @section drawtext
  7392. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  7393. libfreetype library.
  7394. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7395. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  7396. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  7397. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  7398. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7399. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  7400. @subsection Syntax
  7401. It accepts the following parameters:
  7402. @table @option
  7403. @item box
  7404. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  7405. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  7406. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  7407. @item boxborderw
  7408. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  7409. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  7410. @item boxcolor
  7411. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  7412. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7413. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  7414. @item line_spacing
  7415. Set the line spacing in pixels of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{box}.
  7416. The default value of @var{line_spacing} is 0.
  7417. @item borderw
  7418. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  7419. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  7420. @item bordercolor
  7421. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  7422. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7423. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  7424. @item expansion
  7425. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  7426. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  7427. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  7428. below for details.
  7429. @item basetime
  7430. Set a start time for the count. Value is in microseconds. Only applied
  7431. in the deprecated strftime expansion mode. To emulate in normal expansion
  7432. mode use the @code{pts} function, supplying the start time (in seconds)
  7433. as the second argument.
  7434. @item fix_bounds
  7435. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  7436. @item fontcolor
  7437. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  7438. the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7439. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  7440. @item fontcolor_expr
  7441. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  7442. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  7443. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  7444. @item font
  7445. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  7446. @item fontfile
  7447. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  7448. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  7449. @item alpha
  7450. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  7451. be a number between 0.0 and 1.0.
  7452. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} as well.
  7453. The default value is 1.
  7454. Please see @var{fontcolor_expr}.
  7455. @item fontsize
  7456. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  7457. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  7458. @item text_shaping
  7459. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  7460. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  7461. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  7462. By default 1 (if supported).
  7463. @item ft_load_flags
  7464. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  7465. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  7466. a combination of the following values:
  7467. @table @var
  7468. @item default
  7469. @item no_scale
  7470. @item no_hinting
  7471. @item render
  7472. @item no_bitmap
  7473. @item vertical_layout
  7474. @item force_autohint
  7475. @item crop_bitmap
  7476. @item pedantic
  7477. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  7478. @item no_recurse
  7479. @item ignore_transform
  7480. @item monochrome
  7481. @item linear_design
  7482. @item no_autohint
  7483. @end table
  7484. Default value is "default".
  7485. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  7486. libfreetype flags.
  7487. @item shadowcolor
  7488. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  7489. syntax of this option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  7490. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7491. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  7492. @item shadowx
  7493. @item shadowy
  7494. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  7495. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  7496. values. The default value for both is "0".
  7497. @item start_number
  7498. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  7499. is "0".
  7500. @item tabsize
  7501. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  7502. Default value is 4.
  7503. @item timecode
  7504. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  7505. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  7506. option must be specified.
  7507. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  7508. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only). Value will be rounded to nearest
  7509. integer. Minimum value is "1".
  7510. Drop-frame timecode is supported for frame rates 30 & 60.
  7511. @item tc24hmax
  7512. If set to 1, the output of the timecode option will wrap around at 24 hours.
  7513. Default is 0 (disabled).
  7514. @item text
  7515. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  7516. encoded characters.
  7517. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  7518. @var{textfile}.
  7519. @item textfile
  7520. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  7521. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  7522. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  7523. parameter @var{text}.
  7524. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  7525. @item reload
  7526. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  7527. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  7528. @item x
  7529. @item y
  7530. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  7531. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  7532. output image.
  7533. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  7534. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  7535. @end table
  7536. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  7537. following constants and functions:
  7538. @table @option
  7539. @item dar
  7540. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  7541. @item hsub
  7542. @item vsub
  7543. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7544. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7545. @item line_h, lh
  7546. the height of each text line
  7547. @item main_h, h, H
  7548. the input height
  7549. @item main_w, w, W
  7550. the input width
  7551. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  7552. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  7553. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  7554. glyphs.
  7555. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  7556. upwards.
  7557. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  7558. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  7559. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  7560. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  7561. upwards.
  7562. @item max_glyph_h
  7563. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  7564. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  7565. @var{descent}.
  7566. @item max_glyph_w
  7567. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  7568. contained in the rendered text
  7569. @item n
  7570. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7571. @item rand(min, max)
  7572. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  7573. @item sar
  7574. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7575. @item t
  7576. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7577. @item text_h, th
  7578. the height of the rendered text
  7579. @item text_w, tw
  7580. the width of the rendered text
  7581. @item x
  7582. @item y
  7583. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  7584. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  7585. to each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  7586. @item pict_type
  7587. A one character description of the current frame's picture type.
  7588. @item pkt_pos
  7589. The current packet's position in the input file or stream
  7590. (in bytes, from the start of the input). A value of -1 indicates
  7591. this info is not available.
  7592. @item pkt_duration
  7593. The current packet's duration, in seconds.
  7594. @item pkt_size
  7595. The current packet's size (in bytes).
  7596. @end table
  7597. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  7598. @subsection Text expansion
  7599. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  7600. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  7601. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  7602. feature is deprecated.
  7603. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  7604. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  7605. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  7606. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  7607. the second character.
  7608. Sequences of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  7609. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  7610. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  7611. they should be escaped.
  7612. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  7613. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  7614. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  7615. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  7616. problems.
  7617. The following functions are available:
  7618. @table @command
  7619. @item expr, e
  7620. The expression evaluation result.
  7621. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  7622. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  7623. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  7624. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  7625. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  7626. value.
  7627. @item expr_int_format, eif
  7628. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  7629. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  7630. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  7631. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  7632. @code{printf} function.
  7633. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  7634. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  7635. @item gmtime
  7636. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  7637. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7638. @item localtime
  7639. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  7640. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7641. @item metadata
  7642. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  7643. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  7644. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  7645. metadata key is not found or empty.
  7646. Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries
  7647. starting with TAG included within each frame section
  7648. printed by running @code{ffprobe -show_frames}.
  7649. String metadata generated in filters leading to
  7650. the drawtext filter are also available.
  7651. @item n, frame_num
  7652. The frame number, starting from 0.
  7653. @item pict_type
  7654. A one character description of the current picture type.
  7655. @item pts
  7656. The timestamp of the current frame.
  7657. It can take up to three arguments.
  7658. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  7659. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  7660. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  7661. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  7662. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  7663. local time zone time.
  7664. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  7665. If the format is set to @code{hms}, a third argument @code{24HH} may be
  7666. supplied to present the hour part of the formatted timestamp in 24h format
  7667. (00-23).
  7668. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  7669. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  7670. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  7671. @end table
  7672. @subsection Commands
  7673. This filter supports altering parameters via commands:
  7674. @table @option
  7675. @item reinit
  7676. Alter existing filter parameters.
  7677. Syntax for the argument is the same as for filter invocation, e.g.
  7678. @example
  7679. fontsize=56:fontcolor=green:text='Hello World'
  7680. @end example
  7681. Full filter invocation with sendcmd would look like this:
  7682. @example
  7683. sendcmd=c='56.0 drawtext reinit fontsize=56\:fontcolor=green\:text=Hello\\ World'
  7684. @end example
  7685. @end table
  7686. If the entire argument can't be parsed or applied as valid values then the filter will
  7687. continue with its existing parameters.
  7688. @subsection Examples
  7689. @itemize
  7690. @item
  7691. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  7692. optional parameters.
  7693. @example
  7694. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  7695. @end example
  7696. @item
  7697. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  7698. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  7699. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  7700. opacity of 20%.
  7701. @example
  7702. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  7703. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  7704. @end example
  7705. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  7706. within the parameter list.
  7707. @item
  7708. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  7709. @example
  7710. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  7711. @end example
  7712. @item
  7713. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  7714. @example
  7715. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  7716. @end example
  7717. @item
  7718. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  7719. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  7720. with no newlines.
  7721. @example
  7722. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  7723. @end example
  7724. @item
  7725. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  7726. @example
  7727. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  7728. @end example
  7729. @item
  7730. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  7731. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  7732. @example
  7733. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  7734. @end example
  7735. @item
  7736. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  7737. @example
  7738. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  7739. @end example
  7740. @item
  7741. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  7742. @example
  7743. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  7744. @end example
  7745. @item
  7746. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  7747. @example
  7748. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  7749. @end example
  7750. @item
  7751. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  7752. @example
  7753. #!/bin/sh
  7754. DS=1.0 # display start
  7755. DE=10.0 # display end
  7756. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  7757. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  7758. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  7759. @end example
  7760. @item
  7761. Horizontally align multiple separate texts. Note that @option{max_glyph_a}
  7762. and the @option{fontsize} value are included in the @option{y} offset.
  7763. @example
  7764. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=DOG:fontsize=24:x=10:y=20+24-max_glyph_a,
  7765. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=cow:fontsize=24:x=80:y=20+24-max_glyph_a
  7766. @end example
  7767. @item
  7768. Plot special @var{lavf.image2dec.source_basename} metadata onto each frame if
  7769. such metadata exists. Otherwise, plot the string "NA". Note that image2 demuxer
  7770. must have option @option{-export_path_metadata 1} for the special metadata fields
  7771. to be available for filters.
  7772. @example
  7773. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontcolor=white:fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text='%@{metadata\:lavf.image2dec.source_basename\:NA@}':x=10:y=10"
  7774. @end example
  7775. @end itemize
  7776. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  7777. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  7778. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  7779. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  7780. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  7781. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  7782. @section edgedetect
  7783. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  7784. The filter accepts the following options:
  7785. @table @option
  7786. @item low
  7787. @item high
  7788. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  7789. algorithm.
  7790. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  7791. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  7792. by the low threshold.
  7793. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  7794. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  7795. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  7796. is @code{50/255}.
  7797. @item mode
  7798. Define the drawing mode.
  7799. @table @samp
  7800. @item wires
  7801. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  7802. @item colormix
  7803. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  7804. @item canny
  7805. Apply Canny edge detector on all selected planes.
  7806. @end table
  7807. Default value is @var{wires}.
  7808. @item planes
  7809. Select planes for filtering. By default all available planes are filtered.
  7810. @end table
  7811. @subsection Examples
  7812. @itemize
  7813. @item
  7814. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  7815. @example
  7816. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  7817. @end example
  7818. @item
  7819. Painting effect without thresholding:
  7820. @example
  7821. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  7822. @end example
  7823. @end itemize
  7824. @section elbg
  7825. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  7826. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  7827. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  7828. of distinct output colors.
  7829. This filter accepts the following options.
  7830. @table @option
  7831. @item codebook_length, l
  7832. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  7833. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  7834. @item nb_steps, n
  7835. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  7836. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  7837. computation time. Default value is 1.
  7838. @item seed, s
  7839. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  7840. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  7841. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  7842. @item pal8
  7843. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  7844. length greater than 256.
  7845. @end table
  7846. @section entropy
  7847. Measure graylevel entropy in histogram of color channels of video frames.
  7848. It accepts the following parameters:
  7849. @table @option
  7850. @item mode
  7851. Can be either @var{normal} or @var{diff}. Default is @var{normal}.
  7852. @var{diff} mode measures entropy of histogram delta values, absolute differences
  7853. between neighbour histogram values.
  7854. @end table
  7855. @section eq
  7856. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  7857. The filter accepts the following options:
  7858. @table @option
  7859. @item contrast
  7860. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  7861. @code{-1000.0} to @code{1000.0}. The default value is "1".
  7862. @item brightness
  7863. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  7864. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  7865. @item saturation
  7866. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  7867. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  7868. @item gamma
  7869. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  7870. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7871. @item gamma_r
  7872. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  7873. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7874. @item gamma_g
  7875. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  7876. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7877. @item gamma_b
  7878. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  7879. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7880. @item gamma_weight
  7881. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  7882. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  7883. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  7884. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  7885. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  7886. full strength. Default is "1".
  7887. @item eval
  7888. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  7889. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  7890. It accepts the following values:
  7891. @table @samp
  7892. @item init
  7893. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7894. when a command is processed
  7895. @item frame
  7896. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7897. @end table
  7898. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7899. @end table
  7900. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  7901. @table @option
  7902. @item n
  7903. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  7904. @item pos
  7905. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  7906. unspecified
  7907. @item r
  7908. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  7909. @item t
  7910. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7911. @end table
  7912. @subsection Commands
  7913. The filter supports the following commands:
  7914. @table @option
  7915. @item contrast
  7916. Set the contrast expression.
  7917. @item brightness
  7918. Set the brightness expression.
  7919. @item saturation
  7920. Set the saturation expression.
  7921. @item gamma
  7922. Set the gamma expression.
  7923. @item gamma_r
  7924. Set the gamma_r expression.
  7925. @item gamma_g
  7926. Set gamma_g expression.
  7927. @item gamma_b
  7928. Set gamma_b expression.
  7929. @item gamma_weight
  7930. Set gamma_weight expression.
  7931. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7932. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7933. value.
  7934. @end table
  7935. @section erosion
  7936. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  7937. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  7938. It accepts the following options:
  7939. @table @option
  7940. @item threshold0
  7941. @item threshold1
  7942. @item threshold2
  7943. @item threshold3
  7944. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7945. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7946. @item coordinates
  7947. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7948. pixels are used.
  7949. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7950. 1 2 3
  7951. 4 5
  7952. 6 7 8
  7953. @end table
  7954. @subsection Commands
  7955. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  7956. @section extractplanes
  7957. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  7958. separate grayscale video streams.
  7959. The filter accepts the following option:
  7960. @table @option
  7961. @item planes
  7962. Set plane(s) to extract.
  7963. Available values for planes are:
  7964. @table @samp
  7965. @item y
  7966. @item u
  7967. @item v
  7968. @item a
  7969. @item r
  7970. @item g
  7971. @item b
  7972. @end table
  7973. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  7974. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  7975. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  7976. @end table
  7977. @subsection Examples
  7978. @itemize
  7979. @item
  7980. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  7981. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  7982. @example
  7983. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  7984. @end example
  7985. @end itemize
  7986. @section fade
  7987. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  7988. It accepts the following parameters:
  7989. @table @option
  7990. @item type, t
  7991. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  7992. effect.
  7993. Default is @code{in}.
  7994. @item start_frame, s
  7995. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  7996. effect at. Default is 0.
  7997. @item nb_frames, n
  7998. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  7999. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  8000. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  8001. selected @option{color}.
  8002. Default is 25.
  8003. @item alpha
  8004. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  8005. Default value is 0.
  8006. @item start_time, st
  8007. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  8008. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  8009. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  8010. @item duration, d
  8011. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  8012. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  8013. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  8014. selected @option{color}.
  8015. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  8016. (nb_frames is used by default).
  8017. @item color, c
  8018. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  8019. @end table
  8020. @subsection Examples
  8021. @itemize
  8022. @item
  8023. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  8024. @example
  8025. fade=in:0:30
  8026. @end example
  8027. The command above is equivalent to:
  8028. @example
  8029. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  8030. @end example
  8031. @item
  8032. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  8033. @example
  8034. fade=out:155:45
  8035. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  8036. @end example
  8037. @item
  8038. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  8039. @example
  8040. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  8041. @end example
  8042. @item
  8043. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  8044. @example
  8045. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  8046. @end example
  8047. @item
  8048. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  8049. @example
  8050. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  8051. @end example
  8052. @item
  8053. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  8054. @example
  8055. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  8056. @end example
  8057. @end itemize
  8058. @section fftdnoiz
  8059. Denoise frames using 3D FFT (frequency domain filtering).
  8060. The filter accepts the following options:
  8061. @table @option
  8062. @item sigma
  8063. Set the noise sigma constant. This sets denoising strength.
  8064. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 30.
  8065. Using very high sigma with low overlap may give blocking artifacts.
  8066. @item amount
  8067. Set amount of denoising. By default all detected noise is reduced.
  8068. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  8069. @item block
  8070. Set size of block, Default is 4, can be 3, 4, 5 or 6.
  8071. Actual size of block in pixels is 2 to power of @var{block}, so by default
  8072. block size in pixels is 2^4 which is 16.
  8073. @item overlap
  8074. Set block overlap. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0.2 to 0.8.
  8075. @item prev
  8076. Set number of previous frames to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  8077. @item next
  8078. Set number of next frames to to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  8079. @item planes
  8080. Set planes which will be filtered, by default are all available filtered
  8081. except alpha.
  8082. @end table
  8083. @section fftfilt
  8084. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  8085. @table @option
  8086. @item dc_Y
  8087. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  8088. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  8089. value is set to @code{0}.
  8090. @item dc_U
  8091. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  8092. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  8093. default value is set to @code{0}.
  8094. @item dc_V
  8095. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  8096. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  8097. default value is set to @code{0}.
  8098. @item weight_Y
  8099. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  8100. @item weight_U
  8101. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  8102. @item weight_V
  8103. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  8104. @item eval
  8105. Set when the expressions are evaluated.
  8106. It accepts the following values:
  8107. @table @samp
  8108. @item init
  8109. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization.
  8110. @item frame
  8111. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  8112. @end table
  8113. Default value is @samp{init}.
  8114. The filter accepts the following variables:
  8115. @item X
  8116. @item Y
  8117. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8118. @item W
  8119. @item H
  8120. The width and height of the image.
  8121. @item N
  8122. The number of input frame, starting from 0.
  8123. @end table
  8124. @subsection Examples
  8125. @itemize
  8126. @item
  8127. High-pass:
  8128. @example
  8129. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  8130. @end example
  8131. @item
  8132. Low-pass:
  8133. @example
  8134. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  8135. @end example
  8136. @item
  8137. Sharpen:
  8138. @example
  8139. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  8140. @end example
  8141. @item
  8142. Blur:
  8143. @example
  8144. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  8145. @end example
  8146. @end itemize
  8147. @section field
  8148. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  8149. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  8150. non-interlaced.
  8151. The filter accepts the following options:
  8152. @table @option
  8153. @item type
  8154. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  8155. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  8156. @code{bottom}).
  8157. @end table
  8158. @section fieldhint
  8159. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  8160. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  8161. @table @option
  8162. @item hint
  8163. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  8164. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  8165. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  8166. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  8167. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  8168. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  8169. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  8170. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  8171. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  8172. it will be marked same as input frame.
  8173. If optionally followed by @code{t} output frame will use only top field, or in
  8174. case of @code{b} it will use only bottom field.
  8175. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  8176. @item mode
  8177. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  8178. @end table
  8179. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  8180. @example
  8181. 0,0 - # first frame
  8182. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  8183. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  8184. 1,0 -
  8185. 0,0 -
  8186. 0,0 -
  8187. 1,0 -
  8188. 1,0 -
  8189. 1,0 -
  8190. 0,0 -
  8191. 0,0 -
  8192. 1,0 -
  8193. 1,0 -
  8194. 1,0 -
  8195. 0,0 -
  8196. @end example
  8197. @section fieldmatch
  8198. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  8199. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  8200. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  8201. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  8202. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  8203. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  8204. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  8205. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  8206. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  8207. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  8208. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  8209. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  8210. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  8211. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  8212. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  8213. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  8214. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  8215. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  8216. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  8217. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  8218. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  8219. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  8220. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  8221. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  8222. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  8223. The filter accepts the following options:
  8224. @table @option
  8225. @item order
  8226. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  8227. @table @samp
  8228. @item auto
  8229. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  8230. @item bff
  8231. Assume bottom field first.
  8232. @item tff
  8233. Assume top field first.
  8234. @end table
  8235. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  8236. stream.
  8237. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8238. @item mode
  8239. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  8240. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  8241. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  8242. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  8243. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  8244. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  8245. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  8246. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  8247. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  8248. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  8249. Available values are:
  8250. @table @samp
  8251. @item pc
  8252. 2-way matching (p/c)
  8253. @item pc_n
  8254. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  8255. @item pc_u
  8256. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  8257. @item pc_n_ub
  8258. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  8259. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  8260. @item pcn
  8261. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  8262. @item pcn_ub
  8263. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  8264. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  8265. @end table
  8266. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  8267. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  8268. @var{top}).
  8269. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  8270. the slowest.
  8271. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  8272. @item ppsrc
  8273. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  8274. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  8275. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  8276. VFM/TFM.
  8277. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  8278. @item field
  8279. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  8280. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  8281. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  8282. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  8283. @table @samp
  8284. @item auto
  8285. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  8286. @item bottom
  8287. Match from the bottom field.
  8288. @item top
  8289. Match from the top field.
  8290. @end table
  8291. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8292. @item mchroma
  8293. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  8294. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  8295. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  8296. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  8297. the cost of some accuracy.
  8298. Default value is @code{1}.
  8299. @item y0
  8300. @item y1
  8301. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  8302. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  8303. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  8304. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  8305. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  8306. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  8307. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  8308. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  8309. @item scthresh
  8310. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  8311. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  8312. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  8313. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  8314. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  8315. @item combmatch
  8316. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  8317. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  8318. final match. Available values are:
  8319. @table @samp
  8320. @item none
  8321. No final matching based on combed scores.
  8322. @item sc
  8323. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  8324. @item full
  8325. Use combed scores all the time.
  8326. @end table
  8327. Default is @var{sc}.
  8328. @item combdbg
  8329. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  8330. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8331. Available values are:
  8332. @table @samp
  8333. @item none
  8334. No forced calculation.
  8335. @item pcn
  8336. Force p/c/n calculations.
  8337. @item pcnub
  8338. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  8339. @end table
  8340. Default value is @var{none}.
  8341. @item cthresh
  8342. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  8343. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  8344. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  8345. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  8346. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  8347. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  8348. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  8349. Default value is @code{9}.
  8350. @item chroma
  8351. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  8352. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  8353. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  8354. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  8355. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  8356. Default value is @code{0}.
  8357. @item blockx
  8358. @item blocky
  8359. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  8360. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  8361. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  8362. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  8363. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  8364. to 512.
  8365. Default value is @code{16}.
  8366. @item combpel
  8367. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  8368. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  8369. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  8370. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  8371. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  8372. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  8373. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  8374. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8375. Default value is @code{80}.
  8376. @end table
  8377. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  8378. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  8379. @subsubsection p/c/n
  8380. We assume the following telecined stream:
  8381. @example
  8382. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  8383. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  8384. @end example
  8385. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  8386. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  8387. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  8388. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  8389. @example
  8390. Input stream:
  8391. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8392. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  8393. Matches: c c n n c
  8394. Output stream:
  8395. T 1 2 3 4 4
  8396. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8397. @end example
  8398. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  8399. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  8400. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  8401. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  8402. looks like this:
  8403. @example
  8404. Input stream:
  8405. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  8406. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8407. Matches: c c p p c
  8408. Output stream:
  8409. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8410. B 1 2 2 3 4
  8411. @end example
  8412. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  8413. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  8414. @itemize
  8415. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  8416. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  8417. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  8418. @end itemize
  8419. @subsubsection u/b
  8420. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  8421. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  8422. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  8423. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  8424. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  8425. @example
  8426. Match: c p n b u
  8427. x x x x x
  8428. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8429. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8430. x x x x x
  8431. Output frames:
  8432. 2 1 2 2 2
  8433. 2 2 2 1 3
  8434. @end example
  8435. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  8436. @example
  8437. Match: c p n b u
  8438. x x x x x
  8439. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8440. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8441. x x x x x
  8442. Output frames:
  8443. 2 2 2 1 2
  8444. 2 1 3 2 2
  8445. @end example
  8446. @subsection Examples
  8447. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  8448. @example
  8449. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  8450. @end example
  8451. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  8452. @example
  8453. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  8454. @end example
  8455. @section fieldorder
  8456. Transform the field order of the input video.
  8457. It accepts the following parameters:
  8458. @table @option
  8459. @item order
  8460. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  8461. for bottom field first.
  8462. @end table
  8463. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  8464. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  8465. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  8466. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  8467. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  8468. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  8469. not alter the incoming video.
  8470. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  8471. which is bottom field first.
  8472. For example:
  8473. @example
  8474. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  8475. @end example
  8476. @section fifo, afifo
  8477. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  8478. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  8479. framework.
  8480. It does not take parameters.
  8481. @section fillborders
  8482. Fill borders of the input video, without changing video stream dimensions.
  8483. Sometimes video can have garbage at the four edges and you may not want to
  8484. crop video input to keep size multiple of some number.
  8485. This filter accepts the following options:
  8486. @table @option
  8487. @item left
  8488. Number of pixels to fill from left border.
  8489. @item right
  8490. Number of pixels to fill from right border.
  8491. @item top
  8492. Number of pixels to fill from top border.
  8493. @item bottom
  8494. Number of pixels to fill from bottom border.
  8495. @item mode
  8496. Set fill mode.
  8497. It accepts the following values:
  8498. @table @samp
  8499. @item smear
  8500. fill pixels using outermost pixels
  8501. @item mirror
  8502. fill pixels using mirroring
  8503. @item fixed
  8504. fill pixels with constant value
  8505. @end table
  8506. Default is @var{smear}.
  8507. @item color
  8508. Set color for pixels in fixed mode. Default is @var{black}.
  8509. @end table
  8510. @subsection Commands
  8511. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  8512. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8513. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8514. value.
  8515. @section find_rect
  8516. Find a rectangular object
  8517. It accepts the following options:
  8518. @table @option
  8519. @item object
  8520. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  8521. @item threshold
  8522. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  8523. @item mipmaps
  8524. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  8525. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  8526. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  8527. @end table
  8528. @subsection Examples
  8529. @itemize
  8530. @item
  8531. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8532. @example
  8533. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  8534. @end example
  8535. @end itemize
  8536. @section floodfill
  8537. Flood area with values of same pixel components with another values.
  8538. It accepts the following options:
  8539. @table @option
  8540. @item x
  8541. Set pixel x coordinate.
  8542. @item y
  8543. Set pixel y coordinate.
  8544. @item s0
  8545. Set source #0 component value.
  8546. @item s1
  8547. Set source #1 component value.
  8548. @item s2
  8549. Set source #2 component value.
  8550. @item s3
  8551. Set source #3 component value.
  8552. @item d0
  8553. Set destination #0 component value.
  8554. @item d1
  8555. Set destination #1 component value.
  8556. @item d2
  8557. Set destination #2 component value.
  8558. @item d3
  8559. Set destination #3 component value.
  8560. @end table
  8561. @anchor{format}
  8562. @section format
  8563. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  8564. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  8565. the next filter.
  8566. It accepts the following parameters:
  8567. @table @option
  8568. @item pix_fmts
  8569. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  8570. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  8571. @end table
  8572. @subsection Examples
  8573. @itemize
  8574. @item
  8575. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  8576. @example
  8577. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  8578. @end example
  8579. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  8580. @example
  8581. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  8582. @end example
  8583. @end itemize
  8584. @anchor{fps}
  8585. @section fps
  8586. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  8587. frames as necessary.
  8588. It accepts the following parameters:
  8589. @table @option
  8590. @item fps
  8591. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  8592. @item start_time
  8593. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  8594. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  8595. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  8596. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  8597. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  8598. frames with a negative PTS.
  8599. @item round
  8600. Timestamp (PTS) rounding method.
  8601. Possible values are:
  8602. @table @option
  8603. @item zero
  8604. round towards 0
  8605. @item inf
  8606. round away from 0
  8607. @item down
  8608. round towards -infinity
  8609. @item up
  8610. round towards +infinity
  8611. @item near
  8612. round to nearest
  8613. @end table
  8614. The default is @code{near}.
  8615. @item eof_action
  8616. Action performed when reading the last frame.
  8617. Possible values are:
  8618. @table @option
  8619. @item round
  8620. Use same timestamp rounding method as used for other frames.
  8621. @item pass
  8622. Pass through last frame if input duration has not been reached yet.
  8623. @end table
  8624. The default is @code{round}.
  8625. @end table
  8626. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8627. @var{fps}[:@var{start_time}[:@var{round}]].
  8628. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  8629. @subsection Examples
  8630. @itemize
  8631. @item
  8632. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  8633. @example
  8634. fps=fps=25
  8635. @end example
  8636. @item
  8637. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  8638. @example
  8639. fps=fps=film:round=near
  8640. @end example
  8641. @end itemize
  8642. @section framepack
  8643. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  8644. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  8645. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  8646. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  8647. @ref{fps} filters.
  8648. It accepts the following parameters:
  8649. @table @option
  8650. @item format
  8651. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  8652. @table @option
  8653. @item sbs
  8654. The views are next to each other (default).
  8655. @item tab
  8656. The views are on top of each other.
  8657. @item lines
  8658. The views are packed by line.
  8659. @item columns
  8660. The views are packed by column.
  8661. @item frameseq
  8662. The views are temporally interleaved.
  8663. @end table
  8664. @end table
  8665. Some examples:
  8666. @example
  8667. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  8668. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  8669. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  8670. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  8671. @end example
  8672. @section framerate
  8673. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  8674. frames.
  8675. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  8676. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  8677. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  8678. A description of the accepted options follows.
  8679. @table @option
  8680. @item fps
  8681. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  8682. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  8683. @item interp_start
  8684. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8685. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8686. the default is @code{15}.
  8687. @item interp_end
  8688. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8689. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8690. the default is @code{240}.
  8691. @item scene
  8692. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  8693. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  8694. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  8695. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  8696. The default is @code{8.2}.
  8697. @item flags
  8698. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  8699. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  8700. @table @option
  8701. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  8702. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  8703. This flag is enabled by default.
  8704. @end table
  8705. @end table
  8706. @section framestep
  8707. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  8708. This filter accepts the following option:
  8709. @table @option
  8710. @item step
  8711. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  8712. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  8713. @end table
  8714. @section freezedetect
  8715. Detect frozen video.
  8716. This filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects that the
  8717. input video has no significant change in content during a specified duration.
  8718. Video freeze detection calculates the mean average absolute difference of all
  8719. the components of video frames and compares it to a noise floor.
  8720. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  8721. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_start} metadata key is set on the first frame
  8722. whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection duration and it contains the
  8723. timestamp of the first frame of the freeze. The
  8724. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_duration} and
  8725. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_end} metadata keys are set on the first frame
  8726. after the freeze.
  8727. The filter accepts the following options:
  8728. @table @option
  8729. @item noise, n
  8730. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  8731. specified value) or as a difference ratio between 0 and 1. Default is -60dB, or
  8732. 0.001.
  8733. @item duration, d
  8734. Set freeze duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  8735. @end table
  8736. @section freezeframes
  8737. Freeze video frames.
  8738. This filter freezes video frames using frame from 2nd input.
  8739. The filter accepts the following options:
  8740. @table @option
  8741. @item first
  8742. Set number of first frame from which to start freeze.
  8743. @item last
  8744. Set number of last frame from which to end freeze.
  8745. @item replace
  8746. Set number of frame from 2nd input which will be used instead of replaced frames.
  8747. @end table
  8748. @anchor{frei0r}
  8749. @section frei0r
  8750. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  8751. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  8752. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  8753. It accepts the following parameters:
  8754. @table @option
  8755. @item filter_name
  8756. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  8757. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  8758. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREI0R_PATH}.
  8759. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  8760. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  8761. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  8762. @item filter_params
  8763. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  8764. @end table
  8765. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  8766. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  8767. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  8768. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or a color description as specified in the
  8769. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils},
  8770. a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  8771. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  8772. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  8773. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  8774. @subsection Examples
  8775. @itemize
  8776. @item
  8777. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  8778. @example
  8779. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  8780. @end example
  8781. @item
  8782. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  8783. @example
  8784. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  8785. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  8786. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  8787. @end example
  8788. @item
  8789. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  8790. positions:
  8791. @example
  8792. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  8793. @end example
  8794. @end itemize
  8795. For more information, see
  8796. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  8797. @section fspp
  8798. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  8799. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  8800. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  8801. This allows for much higher speed.
  8802. The filter accepts the following options:
  8803. @table @option
  8804. @item quality
  8805. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  8806. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  8807. @item qp
  8808. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  8809. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  8810. @item strength
  8811. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  8812. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  8813. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  8814. @item use_bframe_qp
  8815. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  8816. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  8817. @code{0} (not enabled).
  8818. @end table
  8819. @section gblur
  8820. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  8821. The filter accepts the following options:
  8822. @table @option
  8823. @item sigma
  8824. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8825. @item steps
  8826. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Default is @code{1}.
  8827. @item planes
  8828. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  8829. @item sigmaV
  8830. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  8831. Default is @code{-1}.
  8832. @end table
  8833. @subsection Commands
  8834. This filter supports same commands as options.
  8835. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8836. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8837. value.
  8838. @section geq
  8839. Apply generic equation to each pixel.
  8840. The filter accepts the following options:
  8841. @table @option
  8842. @item lum_expr, lum
  8843. Set the luminance expression.
  8844. @item cb_expr, cb
  8845. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  8846. @item cr_expr, cr
  8847. Set the chrominance red expression.
  8848. @item alpha_expr, a
  8849. Set the alpha expression.
  8850. @item red_expr, r
  8851. Set the red expression.
  8852. @item green_expr, g
  8853. Set the green expression.
  8854. @item blue_expr, b
  8855. Set the blue expression.
  8856. @end table
  8857. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  8858. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  8859. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  8860. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  8861. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  8862. colorspace.
  8863. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  8864. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  8865. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  8866. to the luminance expression.
  8867. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  8868. @table @option
  8869. @item N
  8870. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  8871. @item X
  8872. @item Y
  8873. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8874. @item W
  8875. @item H
  8876. The width and height of the image.
  8877. @item SW
  8878. @item SH
  8879. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  8880. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  8881. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  8882. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  8883. @item T
  8884. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  8885. @item p(x, y)
  8886. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  8887. plane.
  8888. @item lum(x, y)
  8889. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  8890. plane.
  8891. @item cb(x, y)
  8892. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8893. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8894. @item cr(x, y)
  8895. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8896. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8897. @item r(x, y)
  8898. @item g(x, y)
  8899. @item b(x, y)
  8900. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8901. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  8902. @item alpha(x, y)
  8903. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  8904. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8905. @item psum(x,y), lumsum(x, y), cbsum(x,y), crsum(x,y), rsum(x,y), gsum(x,y), bsum(x,y), alphasum(x,y)
  8906. Sum of sample values in the rectangle from (0,0) to (x,y), this allows obtaining
  8907. sums of samples within a rectangle. See the functions without the sum postfix.
  8908. @item interpolation
  8909. Set one of interpolation methods:
  8910. @table @option
  8911. @item nearest, n
  8912. @item bilinear, b
  8913. @end table
  8914. Default is bilinear.
  8915. @end table
  8916. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  8917. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  8918. Please note that this filter can use multiple threads in which case each slice
  8919. will have its own expression state. If you want to use only a single expression
  8920. state because your expressions depend on previous state then you should limit
  8921. the number of filter threads to 1.
  8922. @subsection Examples
  8923. @itemize
  8924. @item
  8925. Flip the image horizontally:
  8926. @example
  8927. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  8928. @end example
  8929. @item
  8930. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  8931. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  8932. @example
  8933. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  8934. @end example
  8935. @item
  8936. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  8937. @example
  8938. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  8939. @end example
  8940. @item
  8941. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  8942. @example
  8943. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  8944. @end example
  8945. @item
  8946. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  8947. @example
  8948. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  8949. @end example
  8950. @item
  8951. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  8952. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  8953. @example
  8954. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  8955. @end example
  8956. @end itemize
  8957. @section gradfun
  8958. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  8959. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  8960. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  8961. dither them.
  8962. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  8963. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  8964. bring back the bands.
  8965. It accepts the following parameters:
  8966. @table @option
  8967. @item strength
  8968. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  8969. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  8970. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  8971. valid range.
  8972. @item radius
  8973. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  8974. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  8975. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  8976. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  8977. @end table
  8978. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8979. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  8980. @subsection Examples
  8981. @itemize
  8982. @item
  8983. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  8984. @example
  8985. gradfun=3.5:8
  8986. @end example
  8987. @item
  8988. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  8989. value):
  8990. @example
  8991. gradfun=radius=8
  8992. @end example
  8993. @end itemize
  8994. @anchor{graphmonitor}
  8995. @section graphmonitor
  8996. Show various filtergraph stats.
  8997. With this filter one can debug complete filtergraph.
  8998. Especially issues with links filling with queued frames.
  8999. The filter accepts the following options:
  9000. @table @option
  9001. @item size, s
  9002. Set video output size. Default is @var{hd720}.
  9003. @item opacity, o
  9004. Set video opacity. Default is @var{0.9}. Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{1}.
  9005. @item mode, m
  9006. Set output mode, can be @var{fulll} or @var{compact}.
  9007. In @var{compact} mode only filters with some queued frames have displayed stats.
  9008. @item flags, f
  9009. Set flags which enable which stats are shown in video.
  9010. Available values for flags are:
  9011. @table @samp
  9012. @item queue
  9013. Display number of queued frames in each link.
  9014. @item frame_count_in
  9015. Display number of frames taken from filter.
  9016. @item frame_count_out
  9017. Display number of frames given out from filter.
  9018. @item pts
  9019. Display current filtered frame pts.
  9020. @item time
  9021. Display current filtered frame time.
  9022. @item timebase
  9023. Display time base for filter link.
  9024. @item format
  9025. Display used format for filter link.
  9026. @item size
  9027. Display video size or number of audio channels in case of audio used by filter link.
  9028. @item rate
  9029. Display video frame rate or sample rate in case of audio used by filter link.
  9030. @end table
  9031. @item rate, r
  9032. Set upper limit for video rate of output stream, Default value is @var{25}.
  9033. This guarantee that output video frame rate will not be higher than this value.
  9034. @end table
  9035. @section greyedge
  9036. A color constancy variation filter which estimates scene illumination via grey edge algorithm
  9037. and corrects the scene colors accordingly.
  9038. See: @url{https://staff.science.uva.nl/th.gevers/pub/GeversTIP07.pdf}
  9039. The filter accepts the following options:
  9040. @table @option
  9041. @item difford
  9042. The order of differentiation to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range
  9043. [0,2] and default value is 1.
  9044. @item minknorm
  9045. The Minkowski parameter to be used for calculating the Minkowski distance. Must
  9046. be chosen in the range [0,20] and default value is 1. Set to 0 for getting
  9047. max value instead of calculating Minkowski distance.
  9048. @item sigma
  9049. The standard deviation of Gaussian blur to be applied on the scene. Must be
  9050. chosen in the range [0,1024.0] and default value = 1. floor( @var{sigma} * break_off_sigma(3) )
  9051. can't be equal to 0 if @var{difford} is greater than 0.
  9052. @end table
  9053. @subsection Examples
  9054. @itemize
  9055. @item
  9056. Grey Edge:
  9057. @example
  9058. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=5:sigma=2
  9059. @end example
  9060. @item
  9061. Max Edge:
  9062. @example
  9063. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=0:sigma=2
  9064. @end example
  9065. @end itemize
  9066. @anchor{haldclut}
  9067. @section haldclut
  9068. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  9069. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  9070. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  9071. The filter accepts the following options:
  9072. @table @option
  9073. @item shortest
  9074. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  9075. @item repeatlast
  9076. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  9077. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  9078. Default is @code{1}.
  9079. @end table
  9080. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  9081. filters share the same internals).
  9082. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9083. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  9084. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  9085. @subsection Workflow examples
  9086. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  9087. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  9088. @example
  9089. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  9090. @end example
  9091. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  9092. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  9093. @example
  9094. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  9095. @end example
  9096. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  9097. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  9098. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  9099. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  9100. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  9101. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  9102. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  9103. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  9104. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  9105. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  9106. @code{haldclut} filter:
  9107. @example
  9108. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  9109. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  9110. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  9111. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  9112. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  9113. @end example
  9114. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  9115. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  9116. the color changes.
  9117. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  9118. @example
  9119. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  9120. @end example
  9121. @section hflip
  9122. Flip the input video horizontally.
  9123. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  9124. @example
  9125. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  9126. @end example
  9127. @section histeq
  9128. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  9129. per-frame basis.
  9130. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  9131. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  9132. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  9133. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  9134. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  9135. video.
  9136. The filter accepts the following options:
  9137. @table @option
  9138. @item strength
  9139. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  9140. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  9141. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  9142. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  9143. @item intensity
  9144. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  9145. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  9146. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  9147. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  9148. @item antibanding
  9149. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  9150. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  9151. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  9152. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  9153. @end table
  9154. @anchor{histogram}
  9155. @section histogram
  9156. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  9157. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  9158. distribution in an image.
  9159. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  9160. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  9161. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  9162. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  9163. The filter accepts the following options:
  9164. @table @option
  9165. @item level_height
  9166. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  9167. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  9168. @item scale_height
  9169. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  9170. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  9171. @item display_mode
  9172. Set display mode.
  9173. It accepts the following values:
  9174. @table @samp
  9175. @item stack
  9176. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  9177. @item parade
  9178. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  9179. @item overlay
  9180. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  9181. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  9182. over one another.
  9183. @end table
  9184. Default is @code{stack}.
  9185. @item levels_mode
  9186. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  9187. Default is @code{linear}.
  9188. @item components
  9189. Set what color components to display.
  9190. Default is @code{7}.
  9191. @item fgopacity
  9192. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  9193. @item bgopacity
  9194. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  9195. @end table
  9196. @subsection Examples
  9197. @itemize
  9198. @item
  9199. Calculate and draw histogram:
  9200. @example
  9201. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  9202. @end example
  9203. @end itemize
  9204. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  9205. @section hqdn3d
  9206. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  9207. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  9208. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  9209. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9210. @table @option
  9211. @item luma_spatial
  9212. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  9213. It defaults to 4.0.
  9214. @item chroma_spatial
  9215. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  9216. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9217. @item luma_tmp
  9218. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9219. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9220. @item chroma_tmp
  9221. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9222. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  9223. @end table
  9224. @subsection Commands
  9225. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9226. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9227. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9228. value.
  9229. @anchor{hwdownload}
  9230. @section hwdownload
  9231. Download hardware frames to system memory.
  9232. The input must be in hardware frames, and the output a non-hardware format.
  9233. Not all formats will be supported on the output - it may be necessary to insert
  9234. an additional @option{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get
  9235. the output in a supported format.
  9236. @section hwmap
  9237. Map hardware frames to system memory or to another device.
  9238. This filter has several different modes of operation; which one is used depends
  9239. on the input and output formats:
  9240. @itemize
  9241. @item
  9242. Hardware frame input, normal frame output
  9243. Map the input frames to system memory and pass them to the output. If the
  9244. original hardware frame is later required (for example, after overlaying
  9245. something else on part of it), the @option{hwmap} filter can be used again
  9246. in the next mode to retrieve it.
  9247. @item
  9248. Normal frame input, hardware frame output
  9249. If the input is actually a software-mapped hardware frame, then unmap it -
  9250. that is, return the original hardware frame.
  9251. Otherwise, a device must be provided. Create new hardware surfaces on that
  9252. device for the output, then map them back to the software format at the input
  9253. and give those frames to the preceding filter. This will then act like the
  9254. @option{hwupload} filter, but may be able to avoid an additional copy when
  9255. the input is already in a compatible format.
  9256. @item
  9257. Hardware frame input and output
  9258. A device must be supplied for the output, either directly or with the
  9259. @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices must be of
  9260. different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9261. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9262. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9263. If the input frames were originally created on the output device, then unmap
  9264. to retrieve the original frames.
  9265. Otherwise, map the frames to the output device - create new hardware frames
  9266. on the output corresponding to the frames on the input.
  9267. @end itemize
  9268. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9269. @table @option
  9270. @item mode
  9271. Set the frame mapping mode. Some combination of:
  9272. @table @var
  9273. @item read
  9274. The mapped frame should be readable.
  9275. @item write
  9276. The mapped frame should be writeable.
  9277. @item overwrite
  9278. The mapping will always overwrite the entire frame.
  9279. This may improve performance in some cases, as the original contents of the
  9280. frame need not be loaded.
  9281. @item direct
  9282. The mapping must not involve any copying.
  9283. Indirect mappings to copies of frames are created in some cases where either
  9284. direct mapping is not possible or it would have unexpected properties.
  9285. Setting this flag ensures that the mapping is direct and will fail if that is
  9286. not possible.
  9287. @end table
  9288. Defaults to @var{read+write} if not specified.
  9289. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9290. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9291. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9292. @item reverse
  9293. In a hardware to hardware mapping, map in reverse - create frames in the sink
  9294. and map them back to the source. This may be necessary in some cases where
  9295. a mapping in one direction is required but only the opposite direction is
  9296. supported by the devices being used.
  9297. This option is dangerous - it may break the preceding filter in undefined
  9298. ways if there are any additional constraints on that filter's output.
  9299. Do not use it without fully understanding the implications of its use.
  9300. @end table
  9301. @anchor{hwupload}
  9302. @section hwupload
  9303. Upload system memory frames to hardware surfaces.
  9304. The device to upload to must be supplied when the filter is initialised. If
  9305. using ffmpeg, select the appropriate device with the @option{-filter_hw_device}
  9306. option or with the @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices
  9307. must be of different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9308. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9309. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9310. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9311. @table @option
  9312. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9313. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9314. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9315. @end table
  9316. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  9317. @section hwupload_cuda
  9318. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  9319. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9320. @table @option
  9321. @item device
  9322. The number of the CUDA device to use
  9323. @end table
  9324. @section hqx
  9325. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  9326. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  9327. It accepts the following option:
  9328. @table @option
  9329. @item n
  9330. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  9331. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  9332. Default is @code{3}.
  9333. @end table
  9334. @section hstack
  9335. Stack input videos horizontally.
  9336. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  9337. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  9338. to create same output.
  9339. The filter accepts the following option:
  9340. @table @option
  9341. @item inputs
  9342. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  9343. @item shortest
  9344. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  9345. terminates. Default value is 0.
  9346. @end table
  9347. @section hue
  9348. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  9349. It accepts the following parameters:
  9350. @table @option
  9351. @item h
  9352. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  9353. and defaults to "0".
  9354. @item s
  9355. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9356. defaults to "1".
  9357. @item H
  9358. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  9359. expression, and defaults to "0".
  9360. @item b
  9361. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9362. defaults to "0".
  9363. @end table
  9364. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  9365. specified at the same time.
  9366. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  9367. expressions containing the following constants:
  9368. @table @option
  9369. @item n
  9370. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  9371. @item pts
  9372. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  9373. @item r
  9374. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  9375. @item t
  9376. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  9377. @item tb
  9378. time base of the input video
  9379. @end table
  9380. @subsection Examples
  9381. @itemize
  9382. @item
  9383. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  9384. @example
  9385. hue=h=90:s=1
  9386. @end example
  9387. @item
  9388. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  9389. @example
  9390. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  9391. @end example
  9392. @item
  9393. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  9394. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  9395. @example
  9396. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  9397. @end example
  9398. @item
  9399. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  9400. @example
  9401. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  9402. @end example
  9403. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  9404. @example
  9405. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  9406. @end example
  9407. @item
  9408. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  9409. @example
  9410. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  9411. @end example
  9412. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  9413. @example
  9414. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  9415. @end example
  9416. @end itemize
  9417. @subsection Commands
  9418. This filter supports the following commands:
  9419. @table @option
  9420. @item b
  9421. @item s
  9422. @item h
  9423. @item H
  9424. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  9425. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9426. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9427. value.
  9428. @end table
  9429. @section hysteresis
  9430. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  9431. This makes it possible to build more robust edge masks.
  9432. This filter accepts the following options:
  9433. @table @option
  9434. @item planes
  9435. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9436. copied from first stream.
  9437. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9438. @item threshold
  9439. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  9440. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  9441. By default value is 0.
  9442. @end table
  9443. The @code{hysteresis} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9444. @section idet
  9445. Detect video interlacing type.
  9446. This filter tries to detect if the input frames are interlaced, progressive,
  9447. top or bottom field first. It will also try to detect fields that are
  9448. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  9449. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  9450. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  9451. The filter will log these metadata values:
  9452. @table @option
  9453. @item single.current_frame
  9454. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  9455. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9456. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9457. @item single.tff
  9458. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  9459. @item multiple.tff
  9460. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9461. @item single.bff
  9462. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  9463. @item multiple.current_frame
  9464. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  9465. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9466. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9467. @item multiple.bff
  9468. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9469. @item single.progressive
  9470. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  9471. @item multiple.progressive
  9472. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  9473. @item single.undetermined
  9474. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  9475. @item multiple.undetermined
  9476. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  9477. @item repeated.current_frame
  9478. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  9479. @item repeated.neither
  9480. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  9481. @item repeated.top
  9482. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  9483. @item repeated.bottom
  9484. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  9485. @end table
  9486. The filter accepts the following options:
  9487. @table @option
  9488. @item intl_thres
  9489. Set interlacing threshold.
  9490. @item prog_thres
  9491. Set progressive threshold.
  9492. @item rep_thres
  9493. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  9494. @item half_life
  9495. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  9496. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to its
  9497. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  9498. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  9499. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  9500. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  9501. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  9502. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  9503. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  9504. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  9505. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  9506. @end table
  9507. @section il
  9508. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  9509. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  9510. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  9511. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  9512. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  9513. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  9514. The filter accepts the following options:
  9515. @table @option
  9516. @item luma_mode, l
  9517. @item chroma_mode, c
  9518. @item alpha_mode, a
  9519. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  9520. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  9521. @table @samp
  9522. @item none
  9523. Do nothing.
  9524. @item deinterleave, d
  9525. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  9526. @item interleave, i
  9527. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  9528. @end table
  9529. Default value is @code{none}.
  9530. @item luma_swap, ls
  9531. @item chroma_swap, cs
  9532. @item alpha_swap, as
  9533. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  9534. @end table
  9535. @subsection Commands
  9536. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9537. @section inflate
  9538. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  9539. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  9540. only values higher than the pixel.
  9541. It accepts the following options:
  9542. @table @option
  9543. @item threshold0
  9544. @item threshold1
  9545. @item threshold2
  9546. @item threshold3
  9547. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  9548. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  9549. @end table
  9550. @subsection Commands
  9551. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9552. @section interlace
  9553. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  9554. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  9555. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  9556. @example
  9557. Original Original New Frame
  9558. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  9559. ========== =========== ==================
  9560. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  9561. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  9562. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  9563. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  9564. ... ... ...
  9565. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  9566. @end example
  9567. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9568. @table @option
  9569. @item scan
  9570. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  9571. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  9572. @item lowpass
  9573. Vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter interlacing and
  9574. reduce moire patterns.
  9575. @table @samp
  9576. @item 0, off
  9577. Disable vertical lowpass filter
  9578. @item 1, linear
  9579. Enable linear filter (default)
  9580. @item 2, complex
  9581. Enable complex filter. This will slightly less reduce twitter and moire
  9582. but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  9583. @end table
  9584. @end table
  9585. @section kerndeint
  9586. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  9587. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  9588. progressive frames.
  9589. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9590. @table @option
  9591. @item thresh
  9592. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  9593. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  9594. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  9595. applying the process on every pixels.
  9596. @item map
  9597. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  9598. Default is 0.
  9599. @item order
  9600. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  9601. 0. Default is 0.
  9602. @item sharp
  9603. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9604. @item twoway
  9605. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9606. @end table
  9607. @subsection Examples
  9608. @itemize
  9609. @item
  9610. Apply default values:
  9611. @example
  9612. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  9613. @end example
  9614. @item
  9615. Enable additional sharpening:
  9616. @example
  9617. kerndeint=sharp=1
  9618. @end example
  9619. @item
  9620. Paint processed pixels in white:
  9621. @example
  9622. kerndeint=map=1
  9623. @end example
  9624. @end itemize
  9625. @section lagfun
  9626. Slowly update darker pixels.
  9627. This filter makes short flashes of light appear longer.
  9628. This filter accepts the following options:
  9629. @table @option
  9630. @item decay
  9631. Set factor for decaying. Default is .95. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  9632. @item planes
  9633. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  9634. @end table
  9635. @section lenscorrection
  9636. Correct radial lens distortion
  9637. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  9638. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  9639. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  9640. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  9641. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  9642. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  9643. Digikam from the KDE project.
  9644. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  9645. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  9646. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  9647. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  9648. be applied before or after lens correction.
  9649. @subsection Options
  9650. The filter accepts the following options:
  9651. @table @option
  9652. @item cx
  9653. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9654. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9655. width. Default is 0.5.
  9656. @item cy
  9657. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9658. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9659. height. Default is 0.5.
  9660. @item k1
  9661. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1]. 0 means
  9662. no correction. Default is 0.
  9663. @item k2
  9664. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1].
  9665. 0 means no correction. Default is 0.
  9666. @end table
  9667. The formula that generates the correction is:
  9668. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  9669. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  9670. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  9671. @section lensfun
  9672. Apply lens correction via the lensfun library (@url{http://lensfun.sourceforge.net/}).
  9673. The @code{lensfun} filter requires the camera make, camera model, and lens model
  9674. to apply the lens correction. The filter will load the lensfun database and
  9675. query it to find the corresponding camera and lens entries in the database. As
  9676. long as these entries can be found with the given options, the filter can
  9677. perform corrections on frames. Note that incomplete strings will result in the
  9678. filter choosing the best match with the given options, and the filter will
  9679. output the chosen camera and lens models (logged with level "info"). You must
  9680. provide the make, camera model, and lens model as they are required.
  9681. The filter accepts the following options:
  9682. @table @option
  9683. @item make
  9684. The make of the camera (for example, "Canon"). This option is required.
  9685. @item model
  9686. The model of the camera (for example, "Canon EOS 100D"). This option is
  9687. required.
  9688. @item lens_model
  9689. The model of the lens (for example, "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM"). This
  9690. option is required.
  9691. @item mode
  9692. The type of correction to apply. The following values are valid options:
  9693. @table @samp
  9694. @item vignetting
  9695. Enables fixing lens vignetting.
  9696. @item geometry
  9697. Enables fixing lens geometry. This is the default.
  9698. @item subpixel
  9699. Enables fixing chromatic aberrations.
  9700. @item vig_geo
  9701. Enables fixing lens vignetting and lens geometry.
  9702. @item vig_subpixel
  9703. Enables fixing lens vignetting and chromatic aberrations.
  9704. @item distortion
  9705. Enables fixing both lens geometry and chromatic aberrations.
  9706. @item all
  9707. Enables all possible corrections.
  9708. @end table
  9709. @item focal_length
  9710. The focal length of the image/video (zoom; expected constant for video). For
  9711. example, a 18--55mm lens has focal length range of [18--55], so a value in that
  9712. range should be chosen when using that lens. Default 18.
  9713. @item aperture
  9714. The aperture of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9715. aperture is only used for vignetting correction. Default 3.5.
  9716. @item focus_distance
  9717. The focus distance of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9718. focus distance is only used for vignetting and only slightly affects the
  9719. vignetting correction process. If unknown, leave it at the default value (which
  9720. is 1000).
  9721. @item scale
  9722. The scale factor which is applied after transformation. After correction the
  9723. video is no longer necessarily rectangular. This parameter controls how much of
  9724. the resulting image is visible. The value 0 means that a value will be chosen
  9725. automatically such that there is little or no unmapped area in the output
  9726. image. 1.0 means that no additional scaling is done. Lower values may result
  9727. in more of the corrected image being visible, while higher values may avoid
  9728. unmapped areas in the output.
  9729. @item target_geometry
  9730. The target geometry of the output image/video. The following values are valid
  9731. options:
  9732. @table @samp
  9733. @item rectilinear (default)
  9734. @item fisheye
  9735. @item panoramic
  9736. @item equirectangular
  9737. @item fisheye_orthographic
  9738. @item fisheye_stereographic
  9739. @item fisheye_equisolid
  9740. @item fisheye_thoby
  9741. @end table
  9742. @item reverse
  9743. Apply the reverse of image correction (instead of correcting distortion, apply
  9744. it).
  9745. @item interpolation
  9746. The type of interpolation used when correcting distortion. The following values
  9747. are valid options:
  9748. @table @samp
  9749. @item nearest
  9750. @item linear (default)
  9751. @item lanczos
  9752. @end table
  9753. @end table
  9754. @subsection Examples
  9755. @itemize
  9756. @item
  9757. Apply lens correction with make "Canon", camera model "Canon EOS 100D", and lens
  9758. model "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM" with focal length of "18" and
  9759. aperture of "8.0".
  9760. @example
  9761. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8 -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9762. @end example
  9763. @item
  9764. Apply the same as before, but only for the first 5 seconds of video.
  9765. @example
  9766. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8:enable='lte(t\,5)' -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9767. @end example
  9768. @end itemize
  9769. @section libvmaf
  9770. Obtain the VMAF (Video Multi-Method Assessment Fusion)
  9771. score between two input videos.
  9772. The obtained VMAF score is printed through the logging system.
  9773. It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.
  9774. After installing the library it can be enabled using:
  9775. @code{./configure --enable-libvmaf --enable-version3}.
  9776. If no model path is specified it uses the default model: @code{vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl}.
  9777. The filter has following options:
  9778. @table @option
  9779. @item model_path
  9780. Set the model path which is to be used for SVM.
  9781. Default value: @code{"/usr/local/share/model/vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl"}
  9782. @item log_path
  9783. Set the file path to be used to store logs.
  9784. @item log_fmt
  9785. Set the format of the log file (xml or json).
  9786. @item enable_transform
  9787. This option can enable/disable the @code{score_transform} applied to the final predicted VMAF score,
  9788. if you have specified score_transform option in the input parameter file passed to @code{run_vmaf_training.py}
  9789. Default value: @code{false}
  9790. @item phone_model
  9791. Invokes the phone model which will generate VMAF scores higher than in the
  9792. regular model, which is more suitable for laptop, TV, etc. viewing conditions.
  9793. Default value: @code{false}
  9794. @item psnr
  9795. Enables computing psnr along with vmaf.
  9796. Default value: @code{false}
  9797. @item ssim
  9798. Enables computing ssim along with vmaf.
  9799. Default value: @code{false}
  9800. @item ms_ssim
  9801. Enables computing ms_ssim along with vmaf.
  9802. Default value: @code{false}
  9803. @item pool
  9804. Set the pool method to be used for computing vmaf.
  9805. Options are @code{min}, @code{harmonic_mean} or @code{mean} (default).
  9806. @item n_threads
  9807. Set number of threads to be used when computing vmaf.
  9808. Default value: @code{0}, which makes use of all available logical processors.
  9809. @item n_subsample
  9810. Set interval for frame subsampling used when computing vmaf.
  9811. Default value: @code{1}
  9812. @item enable_conf_interval
  9813. Enables confidence interval.
  9814. Default value: @code{false}
  9815. @end table
  9816. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9817. @subsection Examples
  9818. @itemize
  9819. @item
  9820. On the below examples the input file @file{main.mpg} being processed is
  9821. compared with the reference file @file{ref.mpg}.
  9822. @example
  9823. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf -f null -
  9824. @end example
  9825. @item
  9826. Example with options:
  9827. @example
  9828. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf="psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9829. @end example
  9830. @item
  9831. Example with options and different containers:
  9832. @example
  9833. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]libvmaf=psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9834. @end example
  9835. @end itemize
  9836. @section limiter
  9837. Limits the pixel components values to the specified range [min, max].
  9838. The filter accepts the following options:
  9839. @table @option
  9840. @item min
  9841. Lower bound. Defaults to the lowest allowed value for the input.
  9842. @item max
  9843. Upper bound. Defaults to the highest allowed value for the input.
  9844. @item planes
  9845. Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.
  9846. @end table
  9847. @section loop
  9848. Loop video frames.
  9849. The filter accepts the following options:
  9850. @table @option
  9851. @item loop
  9852. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  9853. Default is 0.
  9854. @item size
  9855. Set maximal size in number of frames. Default is 0.
  9856. @item start
  9857. Set first frame of loop. Default is 0.
  9858. @end table
  9859. @subsection Examples
  9860. @itemize
  9861. @item
  9862. Loop single first frame infinitely:
  9863. @example
  9864. loop=loop=-1:size=1:start=0
  9865. @end example
  9866. @item
  9867. Loop single first frame 10 times:
  9868. @example
  9869. loop=loop=10:size=1:start=0
  9870. @end example
  9871. @item
  9872. Loop 10 first frames 5 times:
  9873. @example
  9874. loop=loop=5:size=10:start=0
  9875. @end example
  9876. @end itemize
  9877. @section lut1d
  9878. Apply a 1D LUT to an input video.
  9879. The filter accepts the following options:
  9880. @table @option
  9881. @item file
  9882. Set the 1D LUT file name.
  9883. Currently supported formats:
  9884. @table @samp
  9885. @item cube
  9886. Iridas
  9887. @item csp
  9888. cineSpace
  9889. @end table
  9890. @item interp
  9891. Select interpolation mode.
  9892. Available values are:
  9893. @table @samp
  9894. @item nearest
  9895. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9896. @item linear
  9897. Interpolate values using the linear interpolation.
  9898. @item cosine
  9899. Interpolate values using the cosine interpolation.
  9900. @item cubic
  9901. Interpolate values using the cubic interpolation.
  9902. @item spline
  9903. Interpolate values using the spline interpolation.
  9904. @end table
  9905. @end table
  9906. @anchor{lut3d}
  9907. @section lut3d
  9908. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  9909. The filter accepts the following options:
  9910. @table @option
  9911. @item file
  9912. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  9913. Currently supported formats:
  9914. @table @samp
  9915. @item 3dl
  9916. AfterEffects
  9917. @item cube
  9918. Iridas
  9919. @item dat
  9920. DaVinci
  9921. @item m3d
  9922. Pandora
  9923. @item csp
  9924. cineSpace
  9925. @end table
  9926. @item interp
  9927. Select interpolation mode.
  9928. Available values are:
  9929. @table @samp
  9930. @item nearest
  9931. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9932. @item trilinear
  9933. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  9934. @item tetrahedral
  9935. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  9936. @end table
  9937. @end table
  9938. @section lumakey
  9939. Turn certain luma values into transparency.
  9940. The filter accepts the following options:
  9941. @table @option
  9942. @item threshold
  9943. Set the luma which will be used as base for transparency.
  9944. Default value is @code{0}.
  9945. @item tolerance
  9946. Set the range of luma values to be keyed out.
  9947. Default value is @code{0.01}.
  9948. @item softness
  9949. Set the range of softness. Default value is @code{0}.
  9950. Use this to control gradual transition from zero to full transparency.
  9951. @end table
  9952. @subsection Commands
  9953. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9954. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9955. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9956. value.
  9957. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  9958. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  9959. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  9960. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  9961. to an RGB input video.
  9962. These filters accept the following parameters:
  9963. @table @option
  9964. @item c0
  9965. set first pixel component expression
  9966. @item c1
  9967. set second pixel component expression
  9968. @item c2
  9969. set third pixel component expression
  9970. @item c3
  9971. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9972. @item r
  9973. set red component expression
  9974. @item g
  9975. set green component expression
  9976. @item b
  9977. set blue component expression
  9978. @item a
  9979. alpha component expression
  9980. @item y
  9981. set Y/luminance component expression
  9982. @item u
  9983. set U/Cb component expression
  9984. @item v
  9985. set V/Cr component expression
  9986. @end table
  9987. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9988. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9989. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9990. format in input.
  9991. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  9992. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  9993. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  9994. @table @option
  9995. @item w
  9996. @item h
  9997. The input width and height.
  9998. @item val
  9999. The input value for the pixel component.
  10000. @item clipval
  10001. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  10002. @item maxval
  10003. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  10004. @item minval
  10005. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  10006. @item negval
  10007. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  10008. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  10009. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  10010. @item clip(val)
  10011. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  10012. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  10013. @item gammaval(gamma)
  10014. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  10015. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  10016. expression
  10017. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  10018. @end table
  10019. All expressions default to "val".
  10020. @subsection Examples
  10021. @itemize
  10022. @item
  10023. Negate input video:
  10024. @example
  10025. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  10026. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  10027. @end example
  10028. The above is the same as:
  10029. @example
  10030. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  10031. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  10032. @end example
  10033. @item
  10034. Negate luminance:
  10035. @example
  10036. lutyuv=y=negval
  10037. @end example
  10038. @item
  10039. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  10040. @example
  10041. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  10042. @end example
  10043. @item
  10044. Apply a luma burning effect:
  10045. @example
  10046. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  10047. @end example
  10048. @item
  10049. Remove green and blue components:
  10050. @example
  10051. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  10052. @end example
  10053. @item
  10054. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  10055. @example
  10056. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  10057. @end example
  10058. @item
  10059. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  10060. @example
  10061. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  10062. @end example
  10063. @item
  10064. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  10065. @example
  10066. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  10067. @end example
  10068. @item
  10069. Technicolor like effect:
  10070. @example
  10071. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  10072. @end example
  10073. @end itemize
  10074. @section lut2, tlut2
  10075. The @code{lut2} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  10076. stream.
  10077. The @code{tlut2} (time lut2) filter takes two consecutive frames
  10078. from one single stream.
  10079. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  10080. @table @option
  10081. @item c0
  10082. set first pixel component expression
  10083. @item c1
  10084. set second pixel component expression
  10085. @item c2
  10086. set third pixel component expression
  10087. @item c3
  10088. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  10089. @item d
  10090. set output bit depth, only available for @code{lut2} filter. By default is 0,
  10091. which means bit depth is automatically picked from first input format.
  10092. @end table
  10093. The @code{lut2} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10094. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  10095. the corresponding pixel component values.
  10096. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  10097. format in inputs.
  10098. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  10099. @table @option
  10100. @item w
  10101. @item h
  10102. The input width and height.
  10103. @item x
  10104. The first input value for the pixel component.
  10105. @item y
  10106. The second input value for the pixel component.
  10107. @item bdx
  10108. The first input video bit depth.
  10109. @item bdy
  10110. The second input video bit depth.
  10111. @end table
  10112. All expressions default to "x".
  10113. @subsection Examples
  10114. @itemize
  10115. @item
  10116. Highlight differences between two RGB video streams:
  10117. @example
  10118. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  10119. @end example
  10120. @item
  10121. Highlight differences between two YUV video streams:
  10122. @example
  10123. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  10124. @end example
  10125. @item
  10126. Show max difference between two video streams:
  10127. @example
  10128. lut2='if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1)))'
  10129. @end example
  10130. @end itemize
  10131. @section maskedclamp
  10132. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  10133. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  10134. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  10135. This filter accepts the following options:
  10136. @table @option
  10137. @item undershoot
  10138. Default value is @code{0}.
  10139. @item overshoot
  10140. Default value is @code{0}.
  10141. @item planes
  10142. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10143. copied from first stream.
  10144. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10145. @end table
  10146. @section maskedmax
  10147. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10148. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10149. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10150. stream if second absolute difference is greater than first one or from third input stream
  10151. otherwise.
  10152. This filter accepts the following options:
  10153. @table @option
  10154. @item planes
  10155. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10156. copied from first stream.
  10157. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10158. @end table
  10159. @section maskedmerge
  10160. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  10161. weights in the third input stream.
  10162. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  10163. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  10164. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  10165. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  10166. input stream's pixel components.
  10167. This filter accepts the following options:
  10168. @table @option
  10169. @item planes
  10170. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10171. copied from first stream.
  10172. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10173. @end table
  10174. @section maskedmin
  10175. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10176. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10177. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10178. stream if second absolute difference is less than first one or from third input stream
  10179. otherwise.
  10180. This filter accepts the following options:
  10181. @table @option
  10182. @item planes
  10183. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10184. copied from first stream.
  10185. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10186. @end table
  10187. @section maskedthreshold
  10188. Pick pixels comparing absolute difference of two video streams with fixed
  10189. threshold.
  10190. If absolute difference between pixel component of first and second video
  10191. stream is equal or lower than user supplied threshold than pixel component
  10192. from first video stream is picked, otherwise pixel component from second
  10193. video stream is picked.
  10194. This filter accepts the following options:
  10195. @table @option
  10196. @item threshold
  10197. Set threshold used when picking pixels from absolute difference from two input
  10198. video streams.
  10199. @item planes
  10200. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10201. copied from second stream.
  10202. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10203. @end table
  10204. @section maskfun
  10205. Create mask from input video.
  10206. For example it is useful to create motion masks after @code{tblend} filter.
  10207. This filter accepts the following options:
  10208. @table @option
  10209. @item low
  10210. Set low threshold. Any pixel component lower or exact than this value will be set to 0.
  10211. @item high
  10212. Set high threshold. Any pixel component higher than this value will be set to max value
  10213. allowed for current pixel format.
  10214. @item planes
  10215. Set planes to filter, by default all available planes are filtered.
  10216. @item fill
  10217. Fill all frame pixels with this value.
  10218. @item sum
  10219. Set max average pixel value for frame. If sum of all pixel components is higher that this
  10220. average, output frame will be completely filled with value set by @var{fill} option.
  10221. Typically useful for scene changes when used in combination with @code{tblend} filter.
  10222. @end table
  10223. @section mcdeint
  10224. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  10225. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  10226. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  10227. This filter accepts the following options:
  10228. @table @option
  10229. @item mode
  10230. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  10231. It accepts one of the following values:
  10232. @table @samp
  10233. @item fast
  10234. @item medium
  10235. @item slow
  10236. use iterative motion estimation
  10237. @item extra_slow
  10238. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  10239. @end table
  10240. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  10241. @item parity
  10242. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  10243. one of the following values:
  10244. @table @samp
  10245. @item 0, tff
  10246. assume top field first
  10247. @item 1, bff
  10248. assume bottom field first
  10249. @end table
  10250. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  10251. @item qp
  10252. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  10253. encoder.
  10254. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  10255. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  10256. @end table
  10257. @section median
  10258. Pick median pixel from certain rectangle defined by radius.
  10259. This filter accepts the following options:
  10260. @table @option
  10261. @item radius
  10262. Set horizontal radius size. Default value is @code{1}.
  10263. Allowed range is integer from 1 to 127.
  10264. @item planes
  10265. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10266. @item radiusV
  10267. Set vertical radius size. Default value is @code{0}.
  10268. Allowed range is integer from 0 to 127.
  10269. If it is 0, value will be picked from horizontal @code{radius} option.
  10270. @item percentile
  10271. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  10272. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  10273. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  10274. @end table
  10275. @subsection Commands
  10276. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10277. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10278. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10279. value.
  10280. @section mergeplanes
  10281. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  10282. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  10283. planes to the output video.
  10284. This filter accepts the following options:
  10285. @table @option
  10286. @item mapping
  10287. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  10288. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  10289. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  10290. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  10291. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  10292. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  10293. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  10294. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  10295. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  10296. @item format
  10297. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  10298. @end table
  10299. @subsection Examples
  10300. @itemize
  10301. @item
  10302. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  10303. @example
  10304. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  10305. @end example
  10306. @item
  10307. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  10308. @example
  10309. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  10310. @end example
  10311. @item
  10312. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  10313. @example
  10314. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  10315. @end example
  10316. @item
  10317. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  10318. @example
  10319. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  10320. @end example
  10321. @item
  10322. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  10323. @example
  10324. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  10325. @end example
  10326. @end itemize
  10327. @section mestimate
  10328. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  10329. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  10330. This filter accepts the following options:
  10331. @table @option
  10332. @item method
  10333. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  10334. @table @samp
  10335. @item esa
  10336. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10337. @item tss
  10338. Three step search algorithm.
  10339. @item tdls
  10340. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10341. @item ntss
  10342. New three step search algorithm.
  10343. @item fss
  10344. Four step search algorithm.
  10345. @item ds
  10346. Diamond search algorithm.
  10347. @item hexbs
  10348. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10349. @item epzs
  10350. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10351. @item umh
  10352. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10353. @end table
  10354. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  10355. @item mb_size
  10356. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10357. @item search_param
  10358. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  10359. @end table
  10360. @section midequalizer
  10361. Apply Midway Image Equalization effect using two video streams.
  10362. Midway Image Equalization adjusts a pair of images to have the same
  10363. histogram, while maintaining their dynamics as much as possible. It's
  10364. useful for e.g. matching exposures from a pair of stereo cameras.
  10365. This filter has two inputs and one output, which must be of same pixel format, but
  10366. may be of different sizes. The output of filter is first input adjusted with
  10367. midway histogram of both inputs.
  10368. This filter accepts the following option:
  10369. @table @option
  10370. @item planes
  10371. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10372. @end table
  10373. @section minterpolate
  10374. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  10375. This filter accepts the following options:
  10376. @table @option
  10377. @item fps
  10378. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  10379. @item mi_mode
  10380. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10381. @table @samp
  10382. @item dup
  10383. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  10384. @item blend
  10385. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  10386. @item mci
  10387. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  10388. @table @samp
  10389. @item mc_mode
  10390. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10391. @table @samp
  10392. @item obmc
  10393. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  10394. @item aobmc
  10395. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  10396. @end table
  10397. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  10398. @item me_mode
  10399. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10400. @table @samp
  10401. @item bidir
  10402. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  10403. @item bilat
  10404. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  10405. @end table
  10406. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  10407. @item me
  10408. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  10409. @table @samp
  10410. @item esa
  10411. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10412. @item tss
  10413. Three step search algorithm.
  10414. @item tdls
  10415. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10416. @item ntss
  10417. New three step search algorithm.
  10418. @item fss
  10419. Four step search algorithm.
  10420. @item ds
  10421. Diamond search algorithm.
  10422. @item hexbs
  10423. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10424. @item epzs
  10425. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10426. @item umh
  10427. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10428. @end table
  10429. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  10430. @item mb_size
  10431. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10432. @item search_param
  10433. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  10434. @item vsbmc
  10435. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  10436. @end table
  10437. @end table
  10438. @item scd
  10439. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  10440. @table @samp
  10441. @item none
  10442. Disable scene change detection.
  10443. @item fdiff
  10444. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it satisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  10445. @end table
  10446. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  10447. @item scd_threshold
  10448. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{10.}.
  10449. @end table
  10450. @section mix
  10451. Mix several video input streams into one video stream.
  10452. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10453. @table @option
  10454. @item nb_inputs
  10455. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  10456. @item weights
  10457. Specify weight of each input video stream as sequence.
  10458. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights
  10459. is smaller than number of @var{frames} last specified
  10460. weight will be used for all remaining unset weights.
  10461. @item scale
  10462. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  10463. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  10464. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  10465. @item duration
  10466. Specify how end of stream is determined.
  10467. @table @samp
  10468. @item longest
  10469. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  10470. @item shortest
  10471. The duration of the shortest input.
  10472. @item first
  10473. The duration of the first input.
  10474. @end table
  10475. @end table
  10476. @section mpdecimate
  10477. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  10478. order to reduce frame rate.
  10479. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  10480. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  10481. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  10482. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10483. @table @option
  10484. @item max
  10485. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  10486. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  10487. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding the
  10488. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  10489. Default value is 0.
  10490. @item hi
  10491. @item lo
  10492. @item frac
  10493. Set the dropping threshold values.
  10494. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  10495. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  10496. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  10497. out differently over the block.
  10498. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  10499. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  10500. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  10501. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  10502. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  10503. @end table
  10504. @section negate
  10505. Negate (invert) the input video.
  10506. It accepts the following option:
  10507. @table @option
  10508. @item negate_alpha
  10509. With value 1, it negates the alpha component, if present. Default value is 0.
  10510. @end table
  10511. @anchor{nlmeans}
  10512. @section nlmeans
  10513. Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  10514. Each pixel is adjusted by looking for other pixels with similar contexts. This
  10515. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  10516. @option{p}x@option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r}x@option{r}
  10517. around the pixel.
  10518. Note that the research area defines centers for patches, which means some
  10519. patches will be made of pixels outside that research area.
  10520. The filter accepts the following options.
  10521. @table @option
  10522. @item s
  10523. Set denoising strength. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 30.0].
  10524. @item p
  10525. Set patch size. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10526. @item pc
  10527. Same as @option{p} but for chroma planes.
  10528. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10529. @item r
  10530. Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10531. @item rc
  10532. Same as @option{r} but for chroma planes.
  10533. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10534. @end table
  10535. @section nnedi
  10536. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  10537. This filter accepts the following options:
  10538. @table @option
  10539. @item weights
  10540. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  10541. Currently file can be found here:
  10542. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  10543. @item deint
  10544. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  10545. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  10546. @item field
  10547. Set mode of operation.
  10548. Can be one of the following:
  10549. @table @samp
  10550. @item af
  10551. Use frame flags, both fields.
  10552. @item a
  10553. Use frame flags, single field.
  10554. @item t
  10555. Use top field only.
  10556. @item b
  10557. Use bottom field only.
  10558. @item tf
  10559. Use both fields, top first.
  10560. @item bf
  10561. Use both fields, bottom first.
  10562. @end table
  10563. @item planes
  10564. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  10565. @item nsize
  10566. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  10567. network.
  10568. Can be one of the following:
  10569. @table @samp
  10570. @item s8x6
  10571. @item s16x6
  10572. @item s32x6
  10573. @item s48x6
  10574. @item s8x4
  10575. @item s16x4
  10576. @item s32x4
  10577. @end table
  10578. @item nns
  10579. Set the number of neurons in predictor neural network.
  10580. Can be one of the following:
  10581. @table @samp
  10582. @item n16
  10583. @item n32
  10584. @item n64
  10585. @item n128
  10586. @item n256
  10587. @end table
  10588. @item qual
  10589. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  10590. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  10591. @code{slow}.
  10592. @item etype
  10593. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  10594. Can be one of the following:
  10595. @table @samp
  10596. @item a
  10597. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  10598. @item s
  10599. weights trained to minimize squared error
  10600. @end table
  10601. @item pscrn
  10602. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  10603. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  10604. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  10605. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  10606. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  10607. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  10608. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  10609. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  10610. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  10611. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  10612. Can be one of the following:
  10613. @table @samp
  10614. @item none
  10615. @item original
  10616. @item new
  10617. @end table
  10618. Default is @code{new}.
  10619. @item fapprox
  10620. Set various debugging flags.
  10621. @end table
  10622. @section noformat
  10623. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  10624. input to the next filter.
  10625. It accepts the following parameters:
  10626. @table @option
  10627. @item pix_fmts
  10628. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  10629. pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  10630. @end table
  10631. @subsection Examples
  10632. @itemize
  10633. @item
  10634. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  10635. input to the vflip filter:
  10636. @example
  10637. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  10638. @end example
  10639. @item
  10640. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  10641. @example
  10642. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  10643. @end example
  10644. @end itemize
  10645. @section noise
  10646. Add noise on video input frame.
  10647. The filter accepts the following options:
  10648. @table @option
  10649. @item all_seed
  10650. @item c0_seed
  10651. @item c1_seed
  10652. @item c2_seed
  10653. @item c3_seed
  10654. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10655. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  10656. @item all_strength, alls
  10657. @item c0_strength, c0s
  10658. @item c1_strength, c1s
  10659. @item c2_strength, c2s
  10660. @item c3_strength, c3s
  10661. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10662. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  10663. @item all_flags, allf
  10664. @item c0_flags, c0f
  10665. @item c1_flags, c1f
  10666. @item c2_flags, c2f
  10667. @item c3_flags, c3f
  10668. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  10669. Available values for component flags are:
  10670. @table @samp
  10671. @item a
  10672. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  10673. @item p
  10674. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  10675. @item t
  10676. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  10677. @item u
  10678. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  10679. @end table
  10680. @end table
  10681. @subsection Examples
  10682. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  10683. @example
  10684. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  10685. @end example
  10686. @section normalize
  10687. Normalize RGB video (aka histogram stretching, contrast stretching).
  10688. See: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normalization_(image_processing)
  10689. For each channel of each frame, the filter computes the input range and maps
  10690. it linearly to the user-specified output range. The output range defaults
  10691. to the full dynamic range from pure black to pure white.
  10692. Temporal smoothing can be used on the input range to reduce flickering (rapid
  10693. changes in brightness) caused when small dark or bright objects enter or leave
  10694. the scene. This is similar to the auto-exposure (automatic gain control) on a
  10695. video camera, and, like a video camera, it may cause a period of over- or
  10696. under-exposure of the video.
  10697. The R,G,B channels can be normalized independently, which may cause some
  10698. color shifting, or linked together as a single channel, which prevents
  10699. color shifting. Linked normalization preserves hue. Independent normalization
  10700. does not, so it can be used to remove some color casts. Independent and linked
  10701. normalization can be combined in any ratio.
  10702. The normalize filter accepts the following options:
  10703. @table @option
  10704. @item blackpt
  10705. @item whitept
  10706. Colors which define the output range. The minimum input value is mapped to
  10707. the @var{blackpt}. The maximum input value is mapped to the @var{whitept}.
  10708. The defaults are black and white respectively. Specifying white for
  10709. @var{blackpt} and black for @var{whitept} will give color-inverted,
  10710. normalized video. Shades of grey can be used to reduce the dynamic range
  10711. (contrast). Specifying saturated colors here can create some interesting
  10712. effects.
  10713. @item smoothing
  10714. The number of previous frames to use for temporal smoothing. The input range
  10715. of each channel is smoothed using a rolling average over the current frame
  10716. and the @var{smoothing} previous frames. The default is 0 (no temporal
  10717. smoothing).
  10718. @item independence
  10719. Controls the ratio of independent (color shifting) channel normalization to
  10720. linked (color preserving) normalization. 0.0 is fully linked, 1.0 is fully
  10721. independent. Defaults to 1.0 (fully independent).
  10722. @item strength
  10723. Overall strength of the filter. 1.0 is full strength. 0.0 is a rather
  10724. expensive no-op. Defaults to 1.0 (full strength).
  10725. @end table
  10726. @subsection Commands
  10727. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options, excluding @var{smoothing} option.
  10728. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10729. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10730. value.
  10731. @subsection Examples
  10732. Stretch video contrast to use the full dynamic range, with no temporal
  10733. smoothing; may flicker depending on the source content:
  10734. @example
  10735. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=0
  10736. @end example
  10737. As above, but with 50 frames of temporal smoothing; flicker should be
  10738. reduced, depending on the source content:
  10739. @example
  10740. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50
  10741. @end example
  10742. As above, but with hue-preserving linked channel normalization:
  10743. @example
  10744. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0
  10745. @end example
  10746. As above, but with half strength:
  10747. @example
  10748. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0:strength=0.5
  10749. @end example
  10750. Map the darkest input color to red, the brightest input color to cyan:
  10751. @example
  10752. normalize=blackpt=red:whitept=cyan
  10753. @end example
  10754. @section null
  10755. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  10756. @section ocr
  10757. Optical Character Recognition
  10758. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition. To enable
  10759. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10760. @code{--enable-libtesseract}.
  10761. It accepts the following options:
  10762. @table @option
  10763. @item datapath
  10764. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  10765. set at installation.
  10766. @item language
  10767. Set language, default is "eng".
  10768. @item whitelist
  10769. Set character whitelist.
  10770. @item blacklist
  10771. Set character blacklist.
  10772. @end table
  10773. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  10774. The filter exports confidence of recognized words as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.confidence}.
  10775. @section ocv
  10776. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  10777. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  10778. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  10779. It accepts the following parameters:
  10780. @table @option
  10781. @item filter_name
  10782. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  10783. @item filter_params
  10784. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  10785. values are assumed.
  10786. @end table
  10787. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  10788. information:
  10789. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  10790. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  10791. @anchor{dilate}
  10792. @subsection dilate
  10793. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10794. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  10795. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  10796. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  10797. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  10798. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  10799. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  10800. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  10801. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  10802. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  10803. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  10804. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  10805. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  10806. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  10807. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  10808. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  10809. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  10810. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  10811. Some examples:
  10812. @example
  10813. # Use the default values
  10814. ocv=dilate
  10815. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  10816. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  10817. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  10818. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  10819. # *
  10820. # ***
  10821. # *****
  10822. # ***
  10823. # *
  10824. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  10825. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  10826. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  10827. @end example
  10828. @subsection erode
  10829. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10830. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  10831. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  10832. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  10833. @subsection smooth
  10834. Smooth the input video.
  10835. The filter takes the following parameters:
  10836. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  10837. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  10838. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  10839. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  10840. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  10841. depends on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  10842. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  10843. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  10844. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  10845. other parameters is 0.
  10846. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  10847. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  10848. @section oscilloscope
  10849. 2D Video Oscilloscope.
  10850. Useful to measure spatial impulse, step responses, chroma delays, etc.
  10851. It accepts the following parameters:
  10852. @table @option
  10853. @item x
  10854. Set scope center x position.
  10855. @item y
  10856. Set scope center y position.
  10857. @item s
  10858. Set scope size, relative to frame diagonal.
  10859. @item t
  10860. Set scope tilt/rotation.
  10861. @item o
  10862. Set trace opacity.
  10863. @item tx
  10864. Set trace center x position.
  10865. @item ty
  10866. Set trace center y position.
  10867. @item tw
  10868. Set trace width, relative to width of frame.
  10869. @item th
  10870. Set trace height, relative to height of frame.
  10871. @item c
  10872. Set which components to trace. By default it traces first three components.
  10873. @item g
  10874. Draw trace grid. By default is enabled.
  10875. @item st
  10876. Draw some statistics. By default is enabled.
  10877. @item sc
  10878. Draw scope. By default is enabled.
  10879. @end table
  10880. @subsection Commands
  10881. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10882. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10883. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10884. value.
  10885. @subsection Examples
  10886. @itemize
  10887. @item
  10888. Inspect full first row of video frame.
  10889. @example
  10890. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=0:s=1
  10891. @end example
  10892. @item
  10893. Inspect full last row of video frame.
  10894. @example
  10895. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=1:s=1
  10896. @end example
  10897. @item
  10898. Inspect full 5th line of video frame of height 1080.
  10899. @example
  10900. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=5/1080:s=1
  10901. @end example
  10902. @item
  10903. Inspect full last column of video frame.
  10904. @example
  10905. oscilloscope=x=1:y=0.5:s=1:t=1
  10906. @end example
  10907. @end itemize
  10908. @anchor{overlay}
  10909. @section overlay
  10910. Overlay one video on top of another.
  10911. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  10912. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  10913. It accepts the following parameters:
  10914. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10915. @table @option
  10916. @item x
  10917. @item y
  10918. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  10919. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  10920. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  10921. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  10922. @item eof_action
  10923. See @ref{framesync}.
  10924. @item eval
  10925. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  10926. It accepts the following values:
  10927. @table @samp
  10928. @item init
  10929. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10930. when a command is processed
  10931. @item frame
  10932. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10933. @end table
  10934. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  10935. @item shortest
  10936. See @ref{framesync}.
  10937. @item format
  10938. Set the format for the output video.
  10939. It accepts the following values:
  10940. @table @samp
  10941. @item yuv420
  10942. force YUV420 output
  10943. @item yuv420p10
  10944. force YUV420p10 output
  10945. @item yuv422
  10946. force YUV422 output
  10947. @item yuv422p10
  10948. force YUV422p10 output
  10949. @item yuv444
  10950. force YUV444 output
  10951. @item rgb
  10952. force packed RGB output
  10953. @item gbrp
  10954. force planar RGB output
  10955. @item auto
  10956. automatically pick format
  10957. @end table
  10958. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  10959. @item repeatlast
  10960. See @ref{framesync}.
  10961. @item alpha
  10962. Set format of alpha of the overlaid video, it can be @var{straight} or
  10963. @var{premultiplied}. Default is @var{straight}.
  10964. @end table
  10965. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  10966. parameters.
  10967. @table @option
  10968. @item main_w, W
  10969. @item main_h, H
  10970. The main input width and height.
  10971. @item overlay_w, w
  10972. @item overlay_h, h
  10973. The overlay input width and height.
  10974. @item x
  10975. @item y
  10976. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  10977. each new frame.
  10978. @item hsub
  10979. @item vsub
  10980. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  10981. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  10982. @var{vsub} is 1.
  10983. @item n
  10984. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10985. @item pos
  10986. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  10987. @item t
  10988. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  10989. @end table
  10990. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10991. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  10992. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  10993. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  10994. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  10995. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  10996. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  10997. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  10998. the @var{movie} filter does.
  10999. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  11000. efficiency of such approach.
  11001. @subsection Commands
  11002. This filter supports the following commands:
  11003. @table @option
  11004. @item x
  11005. @item y
  11006. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  11007. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  11008. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  11009. value.
  11010. @end table
  11011. @subsection Examples
  11012. @itemize
  11013. @item
  11014. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  11015. video:
  11016. @example
  11017. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  11018. @end example
  11019. Using named options the example above becomes:
  11020. @example
  11021. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  11022. @end example
  11023. @item
  11024. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  11025. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  11026. @example
  11027. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  11028. @end example
  11029. @item
  11030. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  11031. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  11032. @example
  11033. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  11034. @end example
  11035. @item
  11036. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  11037. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  11038. @example
  11039. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  11040. @end example
  11041. @item
  11042. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  11043. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  11044. @example
  11045. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  11046. @end example
  11047. The above command is the same as:
  11048. @example
  11049. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  11050. @end example
  11051. @item
  11052. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  11053. screen starting since time 2:
  11054. @example
  11055. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  11056. @end example
  11057. @item
  11058. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  11059. @example
  11060. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  11061. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  11062. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  11063. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  11064. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  11065. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  11066. "
  11067. @end example
  11068. @item
  11069. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  11070. @example
  11071. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  11072. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  11073. masked.avi
  11074. @end example
  11075. @item
  11076. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  11077. @example
  11078. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  11079. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  11080. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  11081. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  11082. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  11083. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  11084. @end example
  11085. @end itemize
  11086. @anchor{overlay_cuda}
  11087. @section overlay_cuda
  11088. Overlay one video on top of another.
  11089. This is the CUDA cariant of the @ref{overlay} filter.
  11090. It only accepts CUDA frames. The underlying input pixel formats have to match.
  11091. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  11092. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  11093. It accepts the following parameters:
  11094. @table @option
  11095. @item x
  11096. @item y
  11097. Set the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video on the main video.
  11098. Default value is "0" for both expressions.
  11099. @item eof_action
  11100. See @ref{framesync}.
  11101. @item shortest
  11102. See @ref{framesync}.
  11103. @item repeatlast
  11104. See @ref{framesync}.
  11105. @end table
  11106. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11107. @section owdenoise
  11108. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  11109. The filter accepts the following options:
  11110. @table @option
  11111. @item depth
  11112. Set depth.
  11113. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  11114. slow down filtering.
  11115. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  11116. @item luma_strength, ls
  11117. Set luma strength.
  11118. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  11119. @item chroma_strength, cs
  11120. Set chroma strength.
  11121. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  11122. @end table
  11123. @anchor{pad}
  11124. @section pad
  11125. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  11126. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  11127. It accepts the following parameters:
  11128. @table @option
  11129. @item width, w
  11130. @item height, h
  11131. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  11132. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  11133. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  11134. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  11135. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  11136. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  11137. @item x
  11138. @item y
  11139. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  11140. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  11141. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  11142. expression, and vice versa.
  11143. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  11144. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  11145. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  11146. @item color
  11147. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  11148. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  11149. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11150. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  11151. @item eval
  11152. Specify when to evaluate @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x} and @var{y} expression.
  11153. It accepts the following values:
  11154. @table @samp
  11155. @item init
  11156. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when
  11157. a command is processed.
  11158. @item frame
  11159. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  11160. @end table
  11161. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11162. @item aspect
  11163. Pad to aspect instead to a resolution.
  11164. @end table
  11165. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  11166. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  11167. @table @option
  11168. @item in_w
  11169. @item in_h
  11170. The input video width and height.
  11171. @item iw
  11172. @item ih
  11173. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  11174. @item out_w
  11175. @item out_h
  11176. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  11177. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  11178. @item ow
  11179. @item oh
  11180. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  11181. @item x
  11182. @item y
  11183. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  11184. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  11185. @item a
  11186. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  11187. @item sar
  11188. input sample aspect ratio
  11189. @item dar
  11190. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  11191. @item hsub
  11192. @item vsub
  11193. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11194. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11195. @end table
  11196. @subsection Examples
  11197. @itemize
  11198. @item
  11199. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  11200. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  11201. column 0, row 40
  11202. @example
  11203. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  11204. @end example
  11205. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  11206. @example
  11207. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  11208. @end example
  11209. @item
  11210. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  11211. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  11212. @example
  11213. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11214. @end example
  11215. @item
  11216. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  11217. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  11218. the center of the padded area:
  11219. @example
  11220. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11221. @end example
  11222. @item
  11223. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  11224. @example
  11225. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11226. @end example
  11227. @item
  11228. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  11229. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  11230. according to the relation:
  11231. @example
  11232. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  11233. X = output_dar / sar
  11234. @end example
  11235. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  11236. @example
  11237. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11238. @end example
  11239. @item
  11240. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  11241. corner of the output padded area:
  11242. @example
  11243. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  11244. @end example
  11245. @end itemize
  11246. @anchor{palettegen}
  11247. @section palettegen
  11248. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  11249. It accepts the following options:
  11250. @table @option
  11251. @item max_colors
  11252. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  11253. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  11254. will be black.
  11255. @item reserve_transparent
  11256. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  11257. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  11258. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  11259. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  11260. Set by default.
  11261. @item transparency_color
  11262. Set the color that will be used as background for transparency.
  11263. @item stats_mode
  11264. Set statistics mode.
  11265. It accepts the following values:
  11266. @table @samp
  11267. @item full
  11268. Compute full frame histograms.
  11269. @item diff
  11270. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  11271. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  11272. the background is static.
  11273. @item single
  11274. Compute new histogram for each frame.
  11275. @end table
  11276. Default value is @var{full}.
  11277. @end table
  11278. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  11279. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  11280. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  11281. @var{info} logging level.
  11282. @subsection Examples
  11283. @itemize
  11284. @item
  11285. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11286. @example
  11287. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  11288. @end example
  11289. @end itemize
  11290. @section paletteuse
  11291. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  11292. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  11293. be a 256 pixels image.
  11294. It accepts the following options:
  11295. @table @option
  11296. @item dither
  11297. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  11298. @table @samp
  11299. @item bayer
  11300. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  11301. @item heckbert
  11302. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  11303. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  11304. reference.
  11305. @item floyd_steinberg
  11306. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  11307. @item sierra2
  11308. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  11309. @item sierra2_4a
  11310. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  11311. @end table
  11312. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  11313. @item bayer_scale
  11314. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  11315. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  11316. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  11317. at the cost of more banding.
  11318. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  11319. @item diff_mode
  11320. If set, define the zone to process
  11321. @table @samp
  11322. @item rectangle
  11323. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  11324. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  11325. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  11326. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  11327. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  11328. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  11329. @end table
  11330. Default is @var{none}.
  11331. @item new
  11332. Take new palette for each output frame.
  11333. @item alpha_threshold
  11334. Sets the alpha threshold for transparency. Alpha values above this threshold
  11335. will be treated as completely opaque, and values below this threshold will be
  11336. treated as completely transparent.
  11337. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,255]. Default is @var{128}.
  11338. @end table
  11339. @subsection Examples
  11340. @itemize
  11341. @item
  11342. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  11343. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11344. @example
  11345. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  11346. @end example
  11347. @end itemize
  11348. @section perspective
  11349. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  11350. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11351. @table @option
  11352. @item x0
  11353. @item y0
  11354. @item x1
  11355. @item y1
  11356. @item x2
  11357. @item y2
  11358. @item x3
  11359. @item y3
  11360. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  11361. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  11362. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  11363. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  11364. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  11365. The expressions can use the following variables:
  11366. @table @option
  11367. @item W
  11368. @item H
  11369. the width and height of video frame.
  11370. @item in
  11371. Input frame count.
  11372. @item on
  11373. Output frame count.
  11374. @end table
  11375. @item interpolation
  11376. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  11377. It accepts the following values:
  11378. @table @samp
  11379. @item linear
  11380. @item cubic
  11381. @end table
  11382. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  11383. @item sense
  11384. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  11385. It accepts the following values:
  11386. @table @samp
  11387. @item 0, source
  11388. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  11389. the corners of the destination.
  11390. @item 1, destination
  11391. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  11392. by the given coordinates.
  11393. Default value is @samp{source}.
  11394. @end table
  11395. @item eval
  11396. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  11397. It accepts the following values:
  11398. @table @samp
  11399. @item init
  11400. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  11401. when a command is processed
  11402. @item frame
  11403. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  11404. @end table
  11405. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11406. @end table
  11407. @section phase
  11408. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  11409. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  11410. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  11411. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11412. @table @option
  11413. @item mode
  11414. Set phase mode.
  11415. It accepts the following values:
  11416. @table @samp
  11417. @item t
  11418. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  11419. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  11420. @item b
  11421. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  11422. Filter will delay the top field.
  11423. @item p
  11424. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  11425. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  11426. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  11427. @item a
  11428. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  11429. opposite.
  11430. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  11431. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  11432. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  11433. @item u
  11434. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  11435. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  11436. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  11437. match between the fields.
  11438. @item T
  11439. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11440. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11441. @item B
  11442. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11443. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11444. @item A
  11445. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  11446. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  11447. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  11448. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  11449. @item U
  11450. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  11451. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  11452. @end table
  11453. @end table
  11454. @section photosensitivity
  11455. Reduce various flashes in video, so to help users with epilepsy.
  11456. It accepts the following options:
  11457. @table @option
  11458. @item frames, f
  11459. Set how many frames to use when filtering. Default is 30.
  11460. @item threshold, t
  11461. Set detection threshold factor. Default is 1.
  11462. Lower is stricter.
  11463. @item skip
  11464. Set how many pixels to skip when sampling frames. Default is 1.
  11465. Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.
  11466. @item bypass
  11467. Leave frames unchanged. Default is disabled.
  11468. @end table
  11469. @section pixdesctest
  11470. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  11471. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  11472. For example:
  11473. @example
  11474. format=monow, pixdesctest
  11475. @end example
  11476. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  11477. @section pixscope
  11478. Display sample values of color channels. Mainly useful for checking color
  11479. and levels. Minimum supported resolution is 640x480.
  11480. The filters accept the following options:
  11481. @table @option
  11482. @item x
  11483. Set scope X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11484. @item y
  11485. Set scope Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11486. @item w
  11487. Set scope width.
  11488. @item h
  11489. Set scope height.
  11490. @item o
  11491. Set window opacity. This window also holds statistics about pixel area.
  11492. @item wx
  11493. Set window X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11494. @item wy
  11495. Set window Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11496. @end table
  11497. @section pp
  11498. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  11499. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  11500. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  11501. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  11502. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  11503. The filters accept the following options:
  11504. @table @option
  11505. @item subfilters
  11506. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  11507. @end table
  11508. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  11509. @table @option
  11510. @item a/autoq
  11511. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  11512. @item c/chrom
  11513. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  11514. @item y/nochrom
  11515. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  11516. @item n/noluma
  11517. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  11518. @end table
  11519. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  11520. Available subfilters are:
  11521. @table @option
  11522. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11523. Horizontal deblocking filter
  11524. @table @option
  11525. @item difference
  11526. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11527. @item flatness
  11528. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11529. @end table
  11530. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11531. Vertical deblocking filter
  11532. @table @option
  11533. @item difference
  11534. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11535. @item flatness
  11536. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11537. @end table
  11538. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11539. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  11540. @table @option
  11541. @item difference
  11542. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11543. @item flatness
  11544. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11545. @end table
  11546. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11547. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  11548. @table @option
  11549. @item difference
  11550. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11551. @item flatness
  11552. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11553. @end table
  11554. @end table
  11555. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  11556. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  11557. thresholds.
  11558. @table @option
  11559. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  11560. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  11561. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  11562. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  11563. @item dr/dering
  11564. Deringing filter
  11565. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  11566. @table @option
  11567. @item threshold1
  11568. larger -> stronger filtering
  11569. @item threshold2
  11570. larger -> stronger filtering
  11571. @item threshold3
  11572. larger -> stronger filtering
  11573. @end table
  11574. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  11575. @table @option
  11576. @item f/fullyrange
  11577. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  11578. @end table
  11579. @item lb/linblenddeint
  11580. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11581. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  11582. @item li/linipoldeint
  11583. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11584. linearly interpolating every second line.
  11585. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  11586. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  11587. cubically interpolating every second line.
  11588. @item md/mediandeint
  11589. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  11590. median filter to every second line.
  11591. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  11592. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  11593. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  11594. @item l5/lowpass5
  11595. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  11596. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  11597. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  11598. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  11599. specify.
  11600. @table @option
  11601. @item quantizer
  11602. Quantizer to use
  11603. @end table
  11604. @item de/default
  11605. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  11606. @item fa/fast
  11607. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  11608. @item ac
  11609. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  11610. @end table
  11611. @subsection Examples
  11612. @itemize
  11613. @item
  11614. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  11615. brightness/contrast:
  11616. @example
  11617. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  11618. @end example
  11619. @item
  11620. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  11621. @example
  11622. pp=de/-al
  11623. @end example
  11624. @item
  11625. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  11626. @example
  11627. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  11628. @end example
  11629. @item
  11630. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  11631. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  11632. @example
  11633. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  11634. @end example
  11635. @end itemize
  11636. @section pp7
  11637. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  11638. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  11639. used after IDCT.
  11640. The filter accepts the following options:
  11641. @table @option
  11642. @item qp
  11643. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  11644. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  11645. (if available).
  11646. @item mode
  11647. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  11648. @table @samp
  11649. @item hard
  11650. Set hard thresholding.
  11651. @item soft
  11652. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  11653. @item medium
  11654. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  11655. @end table
  11656. @end table
  11657. @section premultiply
  11658. Apply alpha premultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  11659. of second stream as alpha.
  11660. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  11661. The filter accepts the following option:
  11662. @table @option
  11663. @item planes
  11664. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11665. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11666. @item inplace
  11667. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  11668. @end table
  11669. @section prewitt
  11670. Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.
  11671. The filter accepts the following option:
  11672. @table @option
  11673. @item planes
  11674. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11675. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11676. @item scale
  11677. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11678. @item delta
  11679. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11680. @end table
  11681. @section pseudocolor
  11682. Alter frame colors in video with pseudocolors.
  11683. This filter accepts the following options:
  11684. @table @option
  11685. @item c0
  11686. set pixel first component expression
  11687. @item c1
  11688. set pixel second component expression
  11689. @item c2
  11690. set pixel third component expression
  11691. @item c3
  11692. set pixel fourth component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  11693. @item i
  11694. set component to use as base for altering colors
  11695. @end table
  11696. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  11697. the corresponding pixel component values.
  11698. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  11699. @table @option
  11700. @item w
  11701. @item h
  11702. The input width and height.
  11703. @item val
  11704. The input value for the pixel component.
  11705. @item ymin, umin, vmin, amin
  11706. The minimum allowed component value.
  11707. @item ymax, umax, vmax, amax
  11708. The maximum allowed component value.
  11709. @end table
  11710. All expressions default to "val".
  11711. @subsection Examples
  11712. @itemize
  11713. @item
  11714. Change too high luma values to gradient:
  11715. @example
  11716. pseudocolor="'if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(ymin,ymax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(umax,umin,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(vmin,vmax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):-1'"
  11717. @end example
  11718. @end itemize
  11719. @section psnr
  11720. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  11721. Ratio) between two input videos.
  11722. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  11723. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  11724. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  11725. the PSNR.
  11726. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  11727. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  11728. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  11729. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  11730. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  11731. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  11732. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  11733. @example
  11734. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  11735. @end example
  11736. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  11737. image.
  11738. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11739. @table @option
  11740. @item stats_file, f
  11741. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  11742. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  11743. standard output.
  11744. @item stats_version
  11745. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  11746. each format are written below.
  11747. Default value is 1.
  11748. @item stats_add_max
  11749. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  11750. Default value is 0.
  11751. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  11752. the filter will return an error.
  11753. @end table
  11754. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11755. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  11756. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  11757. couple of frames.
  11758. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  11759. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  11760. format with the following parameters:
  11761. @table @option
  11762. @item psnr_log_version
  11763. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  11764. @item fields
  11765. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  11766. the log.
  11767. @end table
  11768. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  11769. @table @option
  11770. @item n
  11771. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  11772. @item mse_avg
  11773. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11774. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  11775. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_b, mse_a
  11776. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11777. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  11778. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  11779. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  11780. specified by the suffix.
  11781. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  11782. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  11783. channels.
  11784. @end table
  11785. @subsection Examples
  11786. @itemize
  11787. @item
  11788. For example:
  11789. @example
  11790. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  11791. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  11792. @end example
  11793. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  11794. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  11795. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  11796. @item
  11797. Another example with different containers:
  11798. @example
  11799. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]psnr" -f null -
  11800. @end example
  11801. @end itemize
  11802. @anchor{pullup}
  11803. @section pullup
  11804. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  11805. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  11806. content.
  11807. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  11808. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  11809. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  11810. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  11811. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  11812. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  11813. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  11814. The filter accepts the following options:
  11815. @table @option
  11816. @item jl
  11817. @item jr
  11818. @item jt
  11819. @item jb
  11820. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  11821. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  11822. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  11823. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  11824. @item sb
  11825. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  11826. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  11827. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  11828. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  11829. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  11830. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  11831. Default value is @code{0}.
  11832. @item mp
  11833. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  11834. @table @samp
  11835. @item l
  11836. Use luma plane.
  11837. @item u
  11838. Use chroma blue plane.
  11839. @item v
  11840. Use chroma red plane.
  11841. @end table
  11842. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  11843. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  11844. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  11845. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  11846. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  11847. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  11848. @end table
  11849. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  11850. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  11851. telecine NTSC input:
  11852. @example
  11853. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  11854. @end example
  11855. @section qp
  11856. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  11857. The filter accepts the following option:
  11858. @table @option
  11859. @item qp
  11860. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  11861. @end table
  11862. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  11863. the following constants:
  11864. @table @var
  11865. @item known
  11866. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  11867. @item qp
  11868. Sequential index starting from -129 to 128.
  11869. @end table
  11870. @subsection Examples
  11871. @itemize
  11872. @item
  11873. Some equation like:
  11874. @example
  11875. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  11876. @end example
  11877. @end itemize
  11878. @section random
  11879. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  11880. No frame is discarded.
  11881. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  11882. @table @option
  11883. @item frames
  11884. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  11885. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  11886. @item seed
  11887. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  11888. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  11889. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  11890. best effort basis.
  11891. @end table
  11892. @section readeia608
  11893. Read closed captioning (EIA-608) information from the top lines of a video frame.
  11894. This filter adds frame metadata for @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.cc} and
  11895. @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.line}, where @code{X} is the number of the identified line
  11896. with EIA-608 data (starting from 0). A description of each metadata value follows:
  11897. @table @option
  11898. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.cc
  11899. The two bytes stored as EIA-608 data (printed in hexadecimal).
  11900. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.line
  11901. The number of the line on which the EIA-608 data was identified and read.
  11902. @end table
  11903. This filter accepts the following options:
  11904. @table @option
  11905. @item scan_min
  11906. Set the line to start scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{0}.
  11907. @item scan_max
  11908. Set the line to end scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{29}.
  11909. @item spw
  11910. Set the ratio of width reserved for sync code detection.
  11911. Default is @code{0.27}. Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 0.7]}.
  11912. @item chp
  11913. Enable checking the parity bit. In the event of a parity error, the filter will output
  11914. @code{0x00} for that character. Default is false.
  11915. @item lp
  11916. Lowpass lines prior to further processing. Default is enabled.
  11917. @end table
  11918. @subsection Examples
  11919. @itemize
  11920. @item
  11921. Output a csv with presentation time and the first two lines of identified EIA-608 captioning data.
  11922. @example
  11923. ffprobe -f lavfi -i movie=captioned_video.mov,readeia608 -show_entries frame=pkt_pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.readeia608.0.cc,lavfi.readeia608.1.cc -of csv
  11924. @end example
  11925. @end itemize
  11926. @section readvitc
  11927. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  11928. video frame.
  11929. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  11930. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  11931. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  11932. timecode data has been found or not.
  11933. This filter accepts the following options:
  11934. @table @option
  11935. @item scan_max
  11936. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  11937. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  11938. @item thr_b
  11939. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11940. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  11941. @item thr_w
  11942. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11943. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  11944. @end table
  11945. @subsection Examples
  11946. @itemize
  11947. @item
  11948. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  11949. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  11950. @example
  11951. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  11952. @end example
  11953. @end itemize
  11954. @section remap
  11955. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  11956. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  11957. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  11958. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  11959. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  11960. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  11961. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  11962. @table @option
  11963. @item format
  11964. Specify pixel format of output from this filter. Can be @code{color} or @code{gray}.
  11965. Default is @code{color}.
  11966. @item fill
  11967. Specify the color of the unmapped pixels. For the syntax of this option,
  11968. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  11969. manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default color is @code{black}.
  11970. @end table
  11971. @section removegrain
  11972. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  11973. @table @option
  11974. @item m0
  11975. Set mode for the first plane.
  11976. @item m1
  11977. Set mode for the second plane.
  11978. @item m2
  11979. Set mode for the third plane.
  11980. @item m3
  11981. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  11982. @end table
  11983. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  11984. @table @var
  11985. @item 0
  11986. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  11987. @item 1
  11988. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11989. @item 2
  11990. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11991. @item 3
  11992. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11993. @item 4
  11994. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11995. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  11996. @item 5
  11997. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  11998. @item 6
  11999. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  12000. @item 7
  12001. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  12002. @item 8
  12003. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  12004. @item 9
  12005. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  12006. @item 10
  12007. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  12008. @item 11
  12009. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  12010. @item 12
  12011. Same as mode 11.
  12012. @item 13
  12013. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  12014. pixels are the closest.
  12015. @item 14
  12016. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  12017. pixels are the closest.
  12018. @item 15
  12019. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  12020. interpolation formula.
  12021. @item 16
  12022. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  12023. interpolation formula.
  12024. @item 17
  12025. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  12026. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  12027. @item 18
  12028. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  12029. the current pixel is minimal.
  12030. @item 19
  12031. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  12032. @item 20
  12033. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  12034. @item 21
  12035. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  12036. @item 22
  12037. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  12038. @item 23
  12039. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  12040. @item 24
  12041. Similar as 23.
  12042. @end table
  12043. @section removelogo
  12044. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  12045. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  12046. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  12047. The filter accepts the following options:
  12048. @table @option
  12049. @item filename, f
  12050. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  12051. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  12052. video stream being processed.
  12053. @end table
  12054. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  12055. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  12056. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  12057. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  12058. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  12059. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  12060. filter once or twice.
  12061. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  12062. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  12063. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  12064. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  12065. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  12066. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  12067. @section repeatfields
  12068. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  12069. fields based on its value.
  12070. @section reverse
  12071. Reverse a video clip.
  12072. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  12073. is suggested.
  12074. @subsection Examples
  12075. @itemize
  12076. @item
  12077. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  12078. @example
  12079. trim=end=5,reverse
  12080. @end example
  12081. @end itemize
  12082. @section rgbashift
  12083. Shift R/G/B/A pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  12084. The filter accepts the following options:
  12085. @table @option
  12086. @item rh
  12087. Set amount to shift red horizontally.
  12088. @item rv
  12089. Set amount to shift red vertically.
  12090. @item gh
  12091. Set amount to shift green horizontally.
  12092. @item gv
  12093. Set amount to shift green vertically.
  12094. @item bh
  12095. Set amount to shift blue horizontally.
  12096. @item bv
  12097. Set amount to shift blue vertically.
  12098. @item ah
  12099. Set amount to shift alpha horizontally.
  12100. @item av
  12101. Set amount to shift alpha vertically.
  12102. @item edge
  12103. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  12104. @end table
  12105. @subsection Commands
  12106. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  12107. @section roberts
  12108. Apply roberts cross operator to input video stream.
  12109. The filter accepts the following option:
  12110. @table @option
  12111. @item planes
  12112. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  12113. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  12114. @item scale
  12115. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  12116. @item delta
  12117. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  12118. @end table
  12119. @section rotate
  12120. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  12121. The filter accepts the following options:
  12122. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  12123. @table @option
  12124. @item angle, a
  12125. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  12126. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  12127. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  12128. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  12129. @item out_w, ow
  12130. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  12131. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  12132. @item out_h, oh
  12133. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  12134. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  12135. @item bilinear
  12136. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  12137. it. Default value is 1.
  12138. @item fillcolor, c
  12139. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  12140. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the
  12141. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12142. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  12143. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  12144. Default value is "black".
  12145. @end table
  12146. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  12147. following constants and functions:
  12148. @table @option
  12149. @item n
  12150. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  12151. before the first frame is filtered.
  12152. @item t
  12153. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  12154. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  12155. @item hsub
  12156. @item vsub
  12157. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12158. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12159. @item in_w, iw
  12160. @item in_h, ih
  12161. the input video width and height
  12162. @item out_w, ow
  12163. @item out_h, oh
  12164. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  12165. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  12166. @item rotw(a)
  12167. @item roth(a)
  12168. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  12169. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  12170. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  12171. @option{out_h} expressions.
  12172. @end table
  12173. @subsection Examples
  12174. @itemize
  12175. @item
  12176. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  12177. @example
  12178. rotate=PI/6
  12179. @end example
  12180. @item
  12181. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  12182. @example
  12183. rotate=-PI/6
  12184. @end example
  12185. @item
  12186. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  12187. @example
  12188. rotate=45*PI/180
  12189. @end example
  12190. @item
  12191. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  12192. @example
  12193. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  12194. @end example
  12195. @item
  12196. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  12197. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  12198. @example
  12199. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  12200. @end example
  12201. @item
  12202. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  12203. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  12204. @example
  12205. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  12206. @end example
  12207. @item
  12208. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  12209. shown:
  12210. @example
  12211. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  12212. @end example
  12213. @end itemize
  12214. @subsection Commands
  12215. The filter supports the following commands:
  12216. @table @option
  12217. @item a, angle
  12218. Set the angle expression.
  12219. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12220. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12221. value.
  12222. @end table
  12223. @section sab
  12224. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  12225. The filter accepts the following options:
  12226. @table @option
  12227. @item luma_radius, lr
  12228. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  12229. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  12230. in slower processing.
  12231. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  12232. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  12233. value is 1.0.
  12234. @item luma_strength, ls
  12235. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  12236. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  12237. @item chroma_radius, cr
  12238. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  12239. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  12240. processing.
  12241. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  12242. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  12243. @item chroma_strength, cs
  12244. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  12245. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  12246. @end table
  12247. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  12248. corresponding luma option value.
  12249. @anchor{scale}
  12250. @section scale
  12251. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  12252. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  12253. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  12254. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  12255. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  12256. requested format.
  12257. @subsection Options
  12258. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  12259. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  12260. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  12261. the complete list of scaler options.
  12262. @table @option
  12263. @item width, w
  12264. @item height, h
  12265. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  12266. dimension.
  12267. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  12268. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  12269. is used for the output.
  12270. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the scale filter
  12271. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  12272. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  12273. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  12274. adjust the value if necessary.
  12275. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  12276. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  12277. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  12278. expression.
  12279. @item eval
  12280. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  12281. @table @samp
  12282. @item init
  12283. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  12284. @item frame
  12285. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  12286. @end table
  12287. Default value is @samp{init}.
  12288. @item interl
  12289. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  12290. @table @samp
  12291. @item 1
  12292. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  12293. @item 0
  12294. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  12295. @item -1
  12296. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  12297. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  12298. @end table
  12299. Default value is @samp{0}.
  12300. @item flags
  12301. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  12302. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12303. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12304. the default flags.
  12305. @item param0, param1
  12306. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  12307. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12308. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12309. empty parameters.
  12310. @item size, s
  12311. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12312. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12313. @item in_color_matrix
  12314. @item out_color_matrix
  12315. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  12316. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12317. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  12318. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  12319. Possible values:
  12320. @table @samp
  12321. @item auto
  12322. Choose automatically.
  12323. @item bt709
  12324. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  12325. Recommendation BT.709.
  12326. @item fcc
  12327. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  12328. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  12329. @item bt601
  12330. @item bt470
  12331. @item smpte170m
  12332. Set color space conforming to:
  12333. @itemize
  12334. @item
  12335. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  12336. @item
  12337. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  12338. @item
  12339. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  12340. @end itemize
  12341. @item smpte240m
  12342. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  12343. @item bt2020
  12344. Set color space conforming to ITU-R BT.2020 non-constant luminance system.
  12345. @end table
  12346. @item in_range
  12347. @item out_range
  12348. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  12349. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12350. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  12351. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  12352. @table @samp
  12353. @item auto/unknown
  12354. Choose automatically.
  12355. @item jpeg/full/pc
  12356. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12357. @item mpeg/limited/tv
  12358. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12359. @end table
  12360. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12361. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12362. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12363. @table @samp
  12364. @item disable
  12365. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12366. @item decrease
  12367. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12368. @item increase
  12369. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12370. @end table
  12371. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12372. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12373. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12374. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12375. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12376. 1280x533.
  12377. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12378. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12379. to work.
  12380. @item force_divisible_by
  12381. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12382. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12383. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12384. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12385. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12386. may be slightly modified.
  12387. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12388. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12389. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12390. @end table
  12391. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  12392. containing the following constants:
  12393. @table @var
  12394. @item in_w
  12395. @item in_h
  12396. The input width and height
  12397. @item iw
  12398. @item ih
  12399. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  12400. @item out_w
  12401. @item out_h
  12402. The output (scaled) width and height
  12403. @item ow
  12404. @item oh
  12405. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  12406. @item a
  12407. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  12408. @item sar
  12409. input sample aspect ratio
  12410. @item dar
  12411. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  12412. @item hsub
  12413. @item vsub
  12414. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12415. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12416. @item ohsub
  12417. @item ovsub
  12418. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12419. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12420. @item n
  12421. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12422. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12423. @item t
  12424. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12425. seconds. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12426. @item pos
  12427. The position (byte offset) of the frame in the input stream, or NaN if
  12428. this information is unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12429. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12430. @end table
  12431. @subsection Examples
  12432. @itemize
  12433. @item
  12434. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  12435. @example
  12436. scale=w=200:h=100
  12437. @end example
  12438. This is equivalent to:
  12439. @example
  12440. scale=200:100
  12441. @end example
  12442. or:
  12443. @example
  12444. scale=200x100
  12445. @end example
  12446. @item
  12447. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  12448. @example
  12449. scale=qcif
  12450. @end example
  12451. which can also be written as:
  12452. @example
  12453. scale=size=qcif
  12454. @end example
  12455. @item
  12456. Scale the input to 2x:
  12457. @example
  12458. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  12459. @end example
  12460. @item
  12461. The above is the same as:
  12462. @example
  12463. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  12464. @end example
  12465. @item
  12466. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  12467. @example
  12468. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  12469. @end example
  12470. @item
  12471. Scale the input to half size:
  12472. @example
  12473. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  12474. @end example
  12475. @item
  12476. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  12477. @example
  12478. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  12479. @end example
  12480. @item
  12481. Seek Greek harmony:
  12482. @example
  12483. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  12484. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  12485. @end example
  12486. @item
  12487. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  12488. @example
  12489. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  12490. @end example
  12491. @item
  12492. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  12493. subsample values:
  12494. @example
  12495. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  12496. @end example
  12497. @item
  12498. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  12499. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  12500. @example
  12501. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  12502. @end example
  12503. @item
  12504. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar:
  12505. @example
  12506. scale='trunc(ih*dar):ih',setsar=1/1
  12507. @end example
  12508. @item
  12509. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar,
  12510. making sure the resulting resolution is even (required by some codecs):
  12511. @example
  12512. scale='trunc(ih*dar/2)*2:trunc(ih/2)*2',setsar=1/1
  12513. @end example
  12514. @end itemize
  12515. @subsection Commands
  12516. This filter supports the following commands:
  12517. @table @option
  12518. @item width, w
  12519. @item height, h
  12520. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12521. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12522. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12523. value.
  12524. @end table
  12525. @section scale_npp
  12526. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  12527. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  12528. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  12529. The following additional options are accepted:
  12530. @table @option
  12531. @item format
  12532. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  12533. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  12534. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  12535. @item interp_algo
  12536. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  12537. @table @option
  12538. @item nn
  12539. Nearest neighbour.
  12540. @item linear
  12541. @item cubic
  12542. @item cubic2p_bspline
  12543. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  12544. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  12545. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  12546. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  12547. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  12548. @item super
  12549. Supersampling
  12550. @item lanczos
  12551. @end table
  12552. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12553. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12554. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12555. @table @samp
  12556. @item disable
  12557. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12558. @item decrease
  12559. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12560. @item increase
  12561. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12562. @end table
  12563. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12564. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12565. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12566. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12567. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12568. 1280x533.
  12569. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12570. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12571. to work.
  12572. @item force_divisible_by
  12573. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12574. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12575. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12576. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12577. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12578. may be slightly modified.
  12579. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12580. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12581. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12582. @end table
  12583. @section scale2ref
  12584. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  12585. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  12586. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref also
  12587. supports the following additional constants for the @option{w} and
  12588. @option{h} options:
  12589. @table @var
  12590. @item main_w
  12591. @item main_h
  12592. The main input video's width and height
  12593. @item main_a
  12594. The same as @var{main_w} / @var{main_h}
  12595. @item main_sar
  12596. The main input video's sample aspect ratio
  12597. @item main_dar, mdar
  12598. The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from
  12599. @code{(main_w / main_h) * main_sar}.
  12600. @item main_hsub
  12601. @item main_vsub
  12602. The main input video's horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values.
  12603. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub}
  12604. is 1.
  12605. @item main_n
  12606. The (sequential) number of the main input frame, starting from 0.
  12607. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12608. @item main_t
  12609. The presentation timestamp of the main input frame, expressed as a number of
  12610. seconds. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12611. @item main_pos
  12612. The position (byte offset) of the frame in the main input stream, or NaN if
  12613. this information is unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12614. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12615. @end table
  12616. @subsection Examples
  12617. @itemize
  12618. @item
  12619. Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying
  12620. @example
  12621. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  12622. @end example
  12623. @item
  12624. Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.
  12625. @example
  12626. [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]
  12627. @end example
  12628. @end itemize
  12629. @subsection Commands
  12630. This filter supports the following commands:
  12631. @table @option
  12632. @item width, w
  12633. @item height, h
  12634. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12635. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12636. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12637. value.
  12638. @end table
  12639. @section scroll
  12640. Scroll input video horizontally and/or vertically by constant speed.
  12641. The filter accepts the following options:
  12642. @table @option
  12643. @item horizontal, h
  12644. Set the horizontal scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12645. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12646. @item vertical, v
  12647. Set the vertical scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12648. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12649. @item hpos
  12650. Set the initial horizontal scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12651. @item vpos
  12652. Set the initial vertical scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12653. @end table
  12654. @subsection Commands
  12655. This filter supports the following @ref{commands}:
  12656. @table @option
  12657. @item horizontal, h
  12658. Set the horizontal scrolling speed.
  12659. @item vertical, v
  12660. Set the vertical scrolling speed.
  12661. @end table
  12662. @anchor{scdet}
  12663. @section scdet
  12664. Detect video scene change.
  12665. This filter sets frame metadata with mafd between frame, the scene score, and
  12666. forward the frame to the next filter, so they can use these metadata to detect
  12667. scene change or others.
  12668. In addition, this filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects
  12669. a scene change by @option{threshold}.
  12670. @code{lavfi.scd.mafd} metadata keys are set with mafd for every frame.
  12671. @code{lavfi.scd.score} metadata keys are set with scene change score for every frame
  12672. to detect scene change.
  12673. @code{lavfi.scd.time} metadata keys are set with current filtered frame time which
  12674. detect scene change with @option{threshold}.
  12675. The filter accepts the following options:
  12676. @table @option
  12677. @item threshold, t
  12678. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change. Good
  12679. values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. The range for @option{threshold} is
  12680. @code{[0., 100.]}.
  12681. Default value is @code{10.}.
  12682. @item sc_pass, s
  12683. Set the flag to pass scene change frames to the next filter. Default value is @code{0}
  12684. You can enable it if you want to get snapshot of scene change frames only.
  12685. @end table
  12686. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  12687. @section selectivecolor
  12688. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  12689. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  12690. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  12691. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  12692. The filter accepts the following options:
  12693. @table @option
  12694. @item correction_method
  12695. Select color correction method.
  12696. Available values are:
  12697. @table @samp
  12698. @item absolute
  12699. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  12700. component value).
  12701. @item relative
  12702. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  12703. @end table
  12704. Default is @code{absolute}.
  12705. @item reds
  12706. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  12707. @item yellows
  12708. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  12709. @item greens
  12710. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  12711. @item cyans
  12712. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  12713. @item blues
  12714. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  12715. @item magentas
  12716. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  12717. @item whites
  12718. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  12719. @item neutrals
  12720. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  12721. @item blacks
  12722. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  12723. @item psfile
  12724. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  12725. @end table
  12726. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  12727. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  12728. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  12729. pixels of its range.
  12730. @subsection Examples
  12731. @itemize
  12732. @item
  12733. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  12734. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  12735. @example
  12736. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  12737. @end example
  12738. @item
  12739. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  12740. @example
  12741. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  12742. @end example
  12743. @end itemize
  12744. @anchor{separatefields}
  12745. @section separatefields
  12746. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  12747. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  12748. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  12749. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  12750. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  12751. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  12752. @section setdar, setsar
  12753. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  12754. output video.
  12755. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  12756. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  12757. @example
  12758. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  12759. @end example
  12760. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  12761. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  12762. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  12763. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  12764. applied.
  12765. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  12766. the filter output video.
  12767. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  12768. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  12769. above.
  12770. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  12771. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  12772. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  12773. It accepts the following parameters:
  12774. @table @option
  12775. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  12776. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  12777. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  12778. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  12779. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  12780. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  12781. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  12782. should be escaped.
  12783. @item max
  12784. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  12785. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  12786. Default value is @code{100}.
  12787. @end table
  12788. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  12789. the following constants:
  12790. @table @option
  12791. @item E, PI, PHI
  12792. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  12793. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  12794. @item w, h
  12795. The input width and height.
  12796. @item a
  12797. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  12798. @item sar
  12799. The input sample aspect ratio.
  12800. @item dar
  12801. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  12802. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  12803. @item hsub, vsub
  12804. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  12805. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12806. @end table
  12807. @subsection Examples
  12808. @itemize
  12809. @item
  12810. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  12811. @example
  12812. setdar=dar=1.77777
  12813. setdar=dar=16/9
  12814. @end example
  12815. @item
  12816. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  12817. @example
  12818. setsar=sar=10/11
  12819. @end example
  12820. @item
  12821. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  12822. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  12823. @example
  12824. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  12825. @end example
  12826. @end itemize
  12827. @anchor{setfield}
  12828. @section setfield
  12829. Force field for the output video frame.
  12830. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  12831. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12832. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12833. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  12834. The filter accepts the following options:
  12835. @table @option
  12836. @item mode
  12837. Available values are:
  12838. @table @samp
  12839. @item auto
  12840. Keep the same field property.
  12841. @item bff
  12842. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12843. @item tff
  12844. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12845. @item prog
  12846. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12847. @end table
  12848. @end table
  12849. @anchor{setparams}
  12850. @section setparams
  12851. Force frame parameter for the output video frame.
  12852. The @code{setparams} filter marks interlace and color range for the
  12853. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12854. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12855. filters/encoders.
  12856. @table @option
  12857. @item field_mode
  12858. Available values are:
  12859. @table @samp
  12860. @item auto
  12861. Keep the same field property (default).
  12862. @item bff
  12863. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12864. @item tff
  12865. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12866. @item prog
  12867. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12868. @end table
  12869. @item range
  12870. Available values are:
  12871. @table @samp
  12872. @item auto
  12873. Keep the same color range property (default).
  12874. @item unspecified, unknown
  12875. Mark the frame as unspecified color range.
  12876. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  12877. Mark the frame as limited range.
  12878. @item full, pc, jpeg
  12879. Mark the frame as full range.
  12880. @end table
  12881. @item color_primaries
  12882. Set the color primaries.
  12883. Available values are:
  12884. @table @samp
  12885. @item auto
  12886. Keep the same color primaries property (default).
  12887. @item bt709
  12888. @item unknown
  12889. @item bt470m
  12890. @item bt470bg
  12891. @item smpte170m
  12892. @item smpte240m
  12893. @item film
  12894. @item bt2020
  12895. @item smpte428
  12896. @item smpte431
  12897. @item smpte432
  12898. @item jedec-p22
  12899. @end table
  12900. @item color_trc
  12901. Set the color transfer.
  12902. Available values are:
  12903. @table @samp
  12904. @item auto
  12905. Keep the same color trc property (default).
  12906. @item bt709
  12907. @item unknown
  12908. @item bt470m
  12909. @item bt470bg
  12910. @item smpte170m
  12911. @item smpte240m
  12912. @item linear
  12913. @item log100
  12914. @item log316
  12915. @item iec61966-2-4
  12916. @item bt1361e
  12917. @item iec61966-2-1
  12918. @item bt2020-10
  12919. @item bt2020-12
  12920. @item smpte2084
  12921. @item smpte428
  12922. @item arib-std-b67
  12923. @end table
  12924. @item colorspace
  12925. Set the colorspace.
  12926. Available values are:
  12927. @table @samp
  12928. @item auto
  12929. Keep the same colorspace property (default).
  12930. @item gbr
  12931. @item bt709
  12932. @item unknown
  12933. @item fcc
  12934. @item bt470bg
  12935. @item smpte170m
  12936. @item smpte240m
  12937. @item ycgco
  12938. @item bt2020nc
  12939. @item bt2020c
  12940. @item smpte2085
  12941. @item chroma-derived-nc
  12942. @item chroma-derived-c
  12943. @item ictcp
  12944. @end table
  12945. @end table
  12946. @section showinfo
  12947. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  12948. The input video is not modified.
  12949. This filter supports the following options:
  12950. @table @option
  12951. @item checksum
  12952. Calculate checksums of each plane. By default enabled.
  12953. @end table
  12954. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  12955. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  12956. The following values are shown in the output:
  12957. @table @option
  12958. @item n
  12959. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12960. @item pts
  12961. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12962. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  12963. @item pts_time
  12964. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12965. seconds.
  12966. @item pos
  12967. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  12968. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12969. @item fmt
  12970. The pixel format name.
  12971. @item sar
  12972. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12973. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  12974. @item s
  12975. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12976. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12977. @item i
  12978. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  12979. for bottom field first).
  12980. @item iskey
  12981. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  12982. @item type
  12983. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  12984. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  12985. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  12986. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  12987. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  12988. @item checksum
  12989. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  12990. @item plane_checksum
  12991. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  12992. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  12993. @item mean
  12994. The mean value of pixels in each plane of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12995. "[@var{mean0} @var{mean1} @var{mean2} @var{mean3}]".
  12996. @item stdev
  12997. The standard deviation of pixel values in each plane of the input frame, expressed
  12998. in the form "[@var{stdev0} @var{stdev1} @var{stdev2} @var{stdev3}]".
  12999. @end table
  13000. @section showpalette
  13001. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  13002. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  13003. It accepts the following option:
  13004. @table @option
  13005. @item s
  13006. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  13007. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  13008. @end table
  13009. @section shuffleframes
  13010. Reorder and/or duplicate and/or drop video frames.
  13011. It accepts the following parameters:
  13012. @table @option
  13013. @item mapping
  13014. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  13015. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  13016. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  13017. '-1' index have special meaning and that is to drop frame.
  13018. @end table
  13019. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  13020. @subsection Examples
  13021. @itemize
  13022. @item
  13023. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  13024. @example
  13025. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  13026. @end example
  13027. @item
  13028. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  13029. @example
  13030. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  13031. @end example
  13032. @end itemize
  13033. @section shuffleplanes
  13034. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  13035. It accepts the following parameters:
  13036. @table @option
  13037. @item map0
  13038. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  13039. @item map1
  13040. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  13041. @item map2
  13042. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  13043. @item map3
  13044. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  13045. @end table
  13046. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  13047. @subsection Examples
  13048. @itemize
  13049. @item
  13050. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  13051. @example
  13052. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  13053. @end example
  13054. @end itemize
  13055. @anchor{signalstats}
  13056. @section signalstats
  13057. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  13058. with the digitization of analog video media.
  13059. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  13060. @table @option
  13061. @item YMIN
  13062. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13063. range of [0-255].
  13064. @item YLOW
  13065. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13066. range of [0-255].
  13067. @item YAVG
  13068. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  13069. [0-255].
  13070. @item YHIGH
  13071. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13072. range of [0-255].
  13073. @item YMAX
  13074. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13075. range of [0-255].
  13076. @item UMIN
  13077. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13078. range of [0-255].
  13079. @item ULOW
  13080. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13081. range of [0-255].
  13082. @item UAVG
  13083. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  13084. [0-255].
  13085. @item UHIGH
  13086. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13087. range of [0-255].
  13088. @item UMAX
  13089. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13090. range of [0-255].
  13091. @item VMIN
  13092. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13093. range of [0-255].
  13094. @item VLOW
  13095. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13096. range of [0-255].
  13097. @item VAVG
  13098. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  13099. [0-255].
  13100. @item VHIGH
  13101. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13102. range of [0-255].
  13103. @item VMAX
  13104. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13105. range of [0-255].
  13106. @item SATMIN
  13107. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  13108. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  13109. @item SATLOW
  13110. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  13111. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  13112. @item SATAVG
  13113. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  13114. of [0-~181.02].
  13115. @item SATHIGH
  13116. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  13117. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  13118. @item SATMAX
  13119. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  13120. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  13121. @item HUEMED
  13122. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  13123. [0-360].
  13124. @item HUEAVG
  13125. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  13126. [0-360].
  13127. @item YDIF
  13128. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  13129. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  13130. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  13131. @item UDIF
  13132. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  13133. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  13134. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  13135. @item VDIF
  13136. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  13137. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  13138. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  13139. @item YBITDEPTH
  13140. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  13141. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  13142. @item UBITDEPTH
  13143. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  13144. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  13145. @item VBITDEPTH
  13146. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  13147. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  13148. @end table
  13149. The filter accepts the following options:
  13150. @table @option
  13151. @item stat
  13152. @item out
  13153. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  13154. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  13155. Both options accept the following values:
  13156. @table @samp
  13157. @item tout
  13158. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  13159. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  13160. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  13161. @item vrep
  13162. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  13163. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  13164. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  13165. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  13166. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  13167. @item brng
  13168. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  13169. @end table
  13170. @item color, c
  13171. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  13172. yellow.
  13173. @end table
  13174. @subsection Examples
  13175. @itemize
  13176. @item
  13177. Output data of various video metrics:
  13178. @example
  13179. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  13180. @end example
  13181. @item
  13182. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  13183. @example
  13184. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  13185. @end example
  13186. @item
  13187. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  13188. @example
  13189. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  13190. @end example
  13191. @item
  13192. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  13193. @example
  13194. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  13195. @end example
  13196. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  13197. @example
  13198. time %@{pts:hms@}
  13199. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  13200. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  13201. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  13202. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  13203. @end example
  13204. @end itemize
  13205. @anchor{signature}
  13206. @section signature
  13207. Calculates the MPEG-7 Video Signature. The filter can handle more than one
  13208. input. In this case the matching between the inputs can be calculated additionally.
  13209. The filter always passes through the first input. The signature of each stream can
  13210. be written into a file.
  13211. It accepts the following options:
  13212. @table @option
  13213. @item detectmode
  13214. Enable or disable the matching process.
  13215. Available values are:
  13216. @table @samp
  13217. @item off
  13218. Disable the calculation of a matching (default).
  13219. @item full
  13220. Calculate the matching for the whole video and output whether the whole video
  13221. matches or only parts.
  13222. @item fast
  13223. Calculate only until a matching is found or the video ends. Should be faster in
  13224. some cases.
  13225. @end table
  13226. @item nb_inputs
  13227. Set the number of inputs. The option value must be a non negative integer.
  13228. Default value is 1.
  13229. @item filename
  13230. Set the path to which the output is written. If there is more than one input,
  13231. the path must be a prototype, i.e. must contain %d or %0nd (where n is a positive
  13232. integer), that will be replaced with the input number. If no filename is
  13233. specified, no output will be written. This is the default.
  13234. @item format
  13235. Choose the output format.
  13236. Available values are:
  13237. @table @samp
  13238. @item binary
  13239. Use the specified binary representation (default).
  13240. @item xml
  13241. Use the specified xml representation.
  13242. @end table
  13243. @item th_d
  13244. Set threshold to detect one word as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13245. greater than zero. The default value is 9000.
  13246. @item th_dc
  13247. Set threshold to detect all words as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13248. greater than zero. The default value is 60000.
  13249. @item th_xh
  13250. Set threshold to detect frames as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13251. greater than zero. The default value is 116.
  13252. @item th_di
  13253. Set the minimum length of a sequence in frames to recognize it as matching
  13254. sequence. The option value must be a non negative integer value.
  13255. The default value is 0.
  13256. @item th_it
  13257. Set the minimum relation, that matching frames to all frames must have.
  13258. The option value must be a double value between 0 and 1. The default value is 0.5.
  13259. @end table
  13260. @subsection Examples
  13261. @itemize
  13262. @item
  13263. To calculate the signature of an input video and store it in signature.bin:
  13264. @example
  13265. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf signature=filename=signature.bin -map 0:v -f null -
  13266. @end example
  13267. @item
  13268. To detect whether two videos match and store the signatures in XML format in
  13269. signature0.xml and signature1.xml:
  13270. @example
  13271. ffmpeg -i input1.mkv -i input2.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] signature=nb_inputs=2:detectmode=full:format=xml:filename=signature%d.xml" -map :v -f null -
  13272. @end example
  13273. @end itemize
  13274. @anchor{smartblur}
  13275. @section smartblur
  13276. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  13277. It accepts the following options:
  13278. @table @option
  13279. @item luma_radius, lr
  13280. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13281. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13282. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  13283. @item luma_strength, ls
  13284. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13285. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13286. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13287. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  13288. @item luma_threshold, lt
  13289. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13290. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13291. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13292. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13293. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  13294. @item chroma_radius, cr
  13295. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13296. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13297. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is @option{luma_radius}.
  13298. @item chroma_strength, cs
  13299. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13300. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13301. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13302. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is @option{luma_strength}.
  13303. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  13304. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13305. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13306. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13307. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13308. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is @option{luma_threshold}.
  13309. @end table
  13310. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  13311. is set.
  13312. @section sobel
  13313. Apply sobel operator to input video stream.
  13314. The filter accepts the following option:
  13315. @table @option
  13316. @item planes
  13317. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13318. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13319. @item scale
  13320. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  13321. @item delta
  13322. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  13323. @end table
  13324. @anchor{spp}
  13325. @section spp
  13326. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  13327. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  13328. and average the results.
  13329. The filter accepts the following options:
  13330. @table @option
  13331. @item quality
  13332. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  13333. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  13334. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  13335. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  13336. @code{3}.
  13337. @item qp
  13338. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  13339. from the video stream (if available).
  13340. @item mode
  13341. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  13342. @table @samp
  13343. @item hard
  13344. Set hard thresholding (default).
  13345. @item soft
  13346. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  13347. @end table
  13348. @item use_bframe_qp
  13349. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  13350. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  13351. @code{0} (not enabled).
  13352. @end table
  13353. @subsection Commands
  13354. This filter supports the following commands:
  13355. @table @option
  13356. @item quality, level
  13357. Set quality level. The value @code{max} can be used to set the maximum level,
  13358. currently @code{6}.
  13359. @end table
  13360. @anchor{sr}
  13361. @section sr
  13362. Scale the input by applying one of the super-resolution methods based on
  13363. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  13364. @itemize
  13365. @item
  13366. Super-Resolution Convolutional Neural Network model (SRCNN).
  13367. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1501.00092}.
  13368. @item
  13369. Efficient Sub-Pixel Convolutional Neural Network model (ESPCN).
  13370. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1609.05158}.
  13371. @end itemize
  13372. Training scripts as well as scripts for model file (.pb) saving can be found at
  13373. @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/sr/tree/sr_dnn_native}. Original repository
  13374. is at @url{https://github.com/HighVoltageRocknRoll/sr.git}.
  13375. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  13376. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  13377. The filter accepts the following options:
  13378. @table @option
  13379. @item dnn_backend
  13380. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  13381. the following values:
  13382. @table @samp
  13383. @item native
  13384. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  13385. @item tensorflow
  13386. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  13387. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  13388. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  13389. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  13390. @end table
  13391. Default value is @samp{native}.
  13392. @item model
  13393. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  13394. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow backend
  13395. can load files for both formats, while native backend can load files for only
  13396. its format.
  13397. @item scale_factor
  13398. Set scale factor for SRCNN model. Allowed values are @code{2}, @code{3} and @code{4}.
  13399. Default value is @code{2}. Scale factor is necessary for SRCNN model, because it accepts
  13400. input upscaled using bicubic upscaling with proper scale factor.
  13401. @end table
  13402. This feature can also be finished with @ref{dnn_processing} filter.
  13403. @section ssim
  13404. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  13405. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  13406. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  13407. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  13408. the SSIM.
  13409. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  13410. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  13411. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  13412. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  13413. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  13414. @table @option
  13415. @item stats_file, f
  13416. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  13417. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  13418. standard output.
  13419. @end table
  13420. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  13421. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  13422. couple of frames.
  13423. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  13424. @table @option
  13425. @item n
  13426. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  13427. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  13428. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  13429. @item All
  13430. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  13431. @item dB
  13432. Same as above but in dB representation.
  13433. @end table
  13434. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  13435. @subsection Examples
  13436. @itemize
  13437. @item
  13438. For example:
  13439. @example
  13440. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13441. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  13442. @end example
  13443. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  13444. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  13445. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  13446. @item
  13447. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  13448. @example
  13449. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  13450. @end example
  13451. @item
  13452. Another example with different containers:
  13453. @example
  13454. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]ssim" -f null -
  13455. @end example
  13456. @end itemize
  13457. @section stereo3d
  13458. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  13459. The filters accept the following options:
  13460. @table @option
  13461. @item in
  13462. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  13463. Available values for input image formats are:
  13464. @table @samp
  13465. @item sbsl
  13466. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13467. @item sbsr
  13468. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13469. @item sbs2l
  13470. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13471. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13472. @item sbs2r
  13473. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13474. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13475. @item abl
  13476. @item tbl
  13477. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13478. @item abr
  13479. @item tbr
  13480. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13481. @item ab2l
  13482. @item tb2l
  13483. above-below with half height resolution
  13484. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13485. @item ab2r
  13486. @item tb2r
  13487. above-below with half height resolution
  13488. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13489. @item al
  13490. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13491. @item ar
  13492. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13493. @item irl
  13494. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13495. @item irr
  13496. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13497. @item icl
  13498. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13499. @item icr
  13500. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13501. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  13502. @end table
  13503. @item out
  13504. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  13505. @table @samp
  13506. @item sbsl
  13507. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13508. @item sbsr
  13509. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13510. @item sbs2l
  13511. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13512. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13513. @item sbs2r
  13514. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13515. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13516. @item abl
  13517. @item tbl
  13518. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13519. @item abr
  13520. @item tbr
  13521. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13522. @item ab2l
  13523. @item tb2l
  13524. above-below with half height resolution
  13525. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13526. @item ab2r
  13527. @item tb2r
  13528. above-below with half height resolution
  13529. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13530. @item al
  13531. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13532. @item ar
  13533. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13534. @item irl
  13535. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13536. @item irr
  13537. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13538. @item arbg
  13539. anaglyph red/blue gray
  13540. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13541. @item argg
  13542. anaglyph red/green gray
  13543. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  13544. @item arcg
  13545. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  13546. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13547. @item arch
  13548. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  13549. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13550. @item arcc
  13551. anaglyph red/cyan color
  13552. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13553. @item arcd
  13554. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13555. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13556. @item agmg
  13557. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  13558. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13559. @item agmh
  13560. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  13561. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13562. @item agmc
  13563. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  13564. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13565. @item agmd
  13566. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13567. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13568. @item aybg
  13569. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  13570. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13571. @item aybh
  13572. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  13573. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13574. @item aybc
  13575. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  13576. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13577. @item aybd
  13578. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13579. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13580. @item ml
  13581. mono output (left eye only)
  13582. @item mr
  13583. mono output (right eye only)
  13584. @item chl
  13585. checkerboard, left eye first
  13586. @item chr
  13587. checkerboard, right eye first
  13588. @item icl
  13589. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13590. @item icr
  13591. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13592. @item hdmi
  13593. HDMI frame pack
  13594. @end table
  13595. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  13596. @end table
  13597. @subsection Examples
  13598. @itemize
  13599. @item
  13600. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  13601. @example
  13602. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  13603. @end example
  13604. @item
  13605. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  13606. @example
  13607. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  13608. @end example
  13609. @end itemize
  13610. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  13611. Select video or audio streams.
  13612. The filter accepts the following options:
  13613. @table @option
  13614. @item inputs
  13615. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  13616. @item map
  13617. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13618. @end table
  13619. @subsection Commands
  13620. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  13621. commands:
  13622. @table @option
  13623. @item map
  13624. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13625. @end table
  13626. @subsection Examples
  13627. @itemize
  13628. @item
  13629. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  13630. @example
  13631. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13632. @end example
  13633. @item
  13634. Same as above, but for audio:
  13635. @example
  13636. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13637. @end example
  13638. @end itemize
  13639. @anchor{subtitles}
  13640. @section subtitles
  13641. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  13642. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  13643. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  13644. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  13645. Alpha) subtitles format.
  13646. The filter accepts the following options:
  13647. @table @option
  13648. @item filename, f
  13649. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  13650. @item original_size
  13651. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  13652. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13653. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13654. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  13655. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  13656. @item fontsdir
  13657. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  13658. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  13659. @item alpha
  13660. Process alpha channel, by default alpha channel is untouched.
  13661. @item charenc
  13662. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  13663. useful if not UTF-8.
  13664. @item stream_index, si
  13665. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  13666. @item force_style
  13667. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  13668. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  13669. @end table
  13670. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  13671. specifies the @option{filename}.
  13672. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  13673. video, use the command:
  13674. @example
  13675. subtitles=sub.srt
  13676. @end example
  13677. which is equivalent to:
  13678. @example
  13679. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  13680. @end example
  13681. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  13682. @example
  13683. subtitles=video.mkv
  13684. @end example
  13685. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  13686. @example
  13687. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  13688. @end example
  13689. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in 80% transparent blue
  13690. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  13691. @example
  13692. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='Fontname=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HCCFF0000'
  13693. @end example
  13694. @section super2xsai
  13695. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  13696. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  13697. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  13698. @section swaprect
  13699. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  13700. This filter accepts the following options:
  13701. @table @option
  13702. @item w
  13703. Set object width.
  13704. @item h
  13705. Set object height.
  13706. @item x1
  13707. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  13708. @item y1
  13709. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  13710. @item x2
  13711. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  13712. @item y2
  13713. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  13714. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  13715. @end table
  13716. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  13717. @table @option
  13718. @item w
  13719. @item h
  13720. The input width and height.
  13721. @item a
  13722. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  13723. @item sar
  13724. input sample aspect ratio
  13725. @item dar
  13726. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  13727. @item n
  13728. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  13729. @item t
  13730. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  13731. @item pos
  13732. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  13733. @end table
  13734. @section swapuv
  13735. Swap U & V plane.
  13736. @section tblend
  13737. Blend successive video frames.
  13738. See @ref{blend}
  13739. @section telecine
  13740. Apply telecine process to the video.
  13741. This filter accepts the following options:
  13742. @table @option
  13743. @item first_field
  13744. @table @samp
  13745. @item top, t
  13746. top field first
  13747. @item bottom, b
  13748. bottom field first
  13749. The default value is @code{top}.
  13750. @end table
  13751. @item pattern
  13752. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  13753. The default value is @code{23}.
  13754. @end table
  13755. @example
  13756. Some typical patterns:
  13757. NTSC output (30i):
  13758. 27.5p: 32222
  13759. 24p: 23 (classic)
  13760. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  13761. 20p: 33
  13762. 18p: 334
  13763. 16p: 3444
  13764. PAL output (25i):
  13765. 27.5p: 12222
  13766. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  13767. 16.67p: 33
  13768. 16p: 33333334
  13769. @end example
  13770. @section thistogram
  13771. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video across time.
  13772. Unlike @ref{histogram} video filter which only shows histogram of single input frame
  13773. at certain time, this filter shows also past histograms of number of frames defined
  13774. by @code{width} option.
  13775. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  13776. distribution in an image.
  13777. The filter accepts the following options:
  13778. @table @option
  13779. @item width, w
  13780. Set width of single color component output. Default value is @code{0}.
  13781. Value of @code{0} means width will be picked from input video.
  13782. This also set number of passed histograms to keep.
  13783. Allowed range is [0, 8192].
  13784. @item display_mode, d
  13785. Set display mode.
  13786. It accepts the following values:
  13787. @table @samp
  13788. @item stack
  13789. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  13790. @item parade
  13791. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  13792. @item overlay
  13793. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  13794. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  13795. over one another.
  13796. @end table
  13797. Default is @code{stack}.
  13798. @item levels_mode, m
  13799. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  13800. Default is @code{linear}.
  13801. @item components, c
  13802. Set what color components to display.
  13803. Default is @code{7}.
  13804. @item bgopacity, b
  13805. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.9}.
  13806. @item envelope, e
  13807. Show envelope. Default is disabled.
  13808. @item ecolor, ec
  13809. Set envelope color. Default is @code{gold}.
  13810. @end table
  13811. @section threshold
  13812. Apply threshold effect to video stream.
  13813. This filter needs four video streams to perform thresholding.
  13814. First stream is stream we are filtering.
  13815. Second stream is holding threshold values, third stream is holding min values,
  13816. and last, fourth stream is holding max values.
  13817. The filter accepts the following option:
  13818. @table @option
  13819. @item planes
  13820. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13821. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13822. @end table
  13823. For example if first stream pixel's component value is less then threshold value
  13824. of pixel component from 2nd threshold stream, third stream value will picked,
  13825. otherwise fourth stream pixel component value will be picked.
  13826. Using color source filter one can perform various types of thresholding:
  13827. @subsection Examples
  13828. @itemize
  13829. @item
  13830. Binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13831. @example
  13832. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=black -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13833. @end example
  13834. @item
  13835. Inverted binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13836. @example
  13837. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -f lavfi -i color=black -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13838. @end example
  13839. @item
  13840. Truncate binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13841. @example
  13842. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13843. @end example
  13844. @item
  13845. Threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13846. @example
  13847. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -i 320x240.avi -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13848. @end example
  13849. @item
  13850. Inverted threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13851. @example
  13852. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13853. @end example
  13854. @end itemize
  13855. @section thumbnail
  13856. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  13857. The filter accepts the following options:
  13858. @table @option
  13859. @item n
  13860. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  13861. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  13862. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  13863. @end table
  13864. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  13865. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  13866. @subsection Examples
  13867. @itemize
  13868. @item
  13869. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  13870. @example
  13871. thumbnail=50
  13872. @end example
  13873. @item
  13874. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13875. @example
  13876. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  13877. @end example
  13878. @end itemize
  13879. @anchor{tile}
  13880. @section tile
  13881. Tile several successive frames together.
  13882. The @ref{untile} filter can do the reverse.
  13883. The filter accepts the following options:
  13884. @table @option
  13885. @item layout
  13886. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  13887. this option, check the
  13888. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13889. @item nb_frames
  13890. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  13891. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  13892. the area will be used.
  13893. @item margin
  13894. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  13895. @item padding
  13896. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  13897. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  13898. refer to the pad video filter.
  13899. @item color
  13900. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13901. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13902. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13903. @item overlap
  13904. Set the number of frames to overlap when tiling several successive frames together.
  13905. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13906. @item init_padding
  13907. Set the number of frames to initially be empty before displaying first output frame.
  13908. This controls how soon will one get first output frame.
  13909. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13910. @end table
  13911. @subsection Examples
  13912. @itemize
  13913. @item
  13914. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  13915. @example
  13916. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  13917. @end example
  13918. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  13919. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  13920. rate.
  13921. @item
  13922. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  13923. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  13924. mixed flat and named options:
  13925. @example
  13926. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  13927. @end example
  13928. @end itemize
  13929. @section tinterlace
  13930. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  13931. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  13932. considered odd.
  13933. The filter accepts the following options:
  13934. @table @option
  13935. @item mode
  13936. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  13937. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  13938. Available values are:
  13939. @table @samp
  13940. @item merge, 0
  13941. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13942. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  13943. @example
  13944. ------> time
  13945. Input:
  13946. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13947. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13948. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13949. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13950. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13951. Output:
  13952. 11111 33333
  13953. 22222 44444
  13954. 11111 33333
  13955. 22222 44444
  13956. 11111 33333
  13957. 22222 44444
  13958. 11111 33333
  13959. 22222 44444
  13960. @end example
  13961. @item drop_even, 1
  13962. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13963. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13964. @example
  13965. ------> time
  13966. Input:
  13967. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13968. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13969. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13970. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13971. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13972. Output:
  13973. 11111 33333
  13974. 11111 33333
  13975. 11111 33333
  13976. 11111 33333
  13977. @end example
  13978. @item drop_odd, 2
  13979. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13980. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13981. @example
  13982. ------> time
  13983. Input:
  13984. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13985. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13986. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13987. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13988. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13989. Output:
  13990. 22222 44444
  13991. 22222 44444
  13992. 22222 44444
  13993. 22222 44444
  13994. @end example
  13995. @item pad, 3
  13996. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  13997. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  13998. @example
  13999. ------> time
  14000. Input:
  14001. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  14002. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14003. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14004. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14005. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14006. Output:
  14007. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  14008. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  14009. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  14010. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  14011. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  14012. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  14013. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  14014. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  14015. @end example
  14016. @item interleave_top, 4
  14017. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  14018. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  14019. @example
  14020. ------> time
  14021. Input:
  14022. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  14023. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  14024. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  14025. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  14026. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  14027. Output:
  14028. 11111 33333
  14029. 22222 44444
  14030. 11111 33333
  14031. 22222 44444
  14032. @end example
  14033. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  14034. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  14035. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  14036. @example
  14037. ------> time
  14038. Input:
  14039. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  14040. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  14041. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  14042. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  14043. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  14044. Output:
  14045. 22222 44444
  14046. 11111 33333
  14047. 22222 44444
  14048. 11111 33333
  14049. @end example
  14050. @item interlacex2, 6
  14051. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  14052. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  14053. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  14054. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  14055. field synchronisation.
  14056. @example
  14057. ------> time
  14058. Input:
  14059. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  14060. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14061. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14062. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14063. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14064. Output:
  14065. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  14066. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  14067. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  14068. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  14069. @end example
  14070. @item mergex2, 7
  14071. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  14072. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  14073. @example
  14074. ------> time
  14075. Input:
  14076. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  14077. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14078. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14079. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14080. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14081. Output:
  14082. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  14083. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  14084. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  14085. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  14086. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  14087. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  14088. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  14089. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  14090. @end example
  14091. @end table
  14092. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  14093. compatibility reasons.
  14094. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  14095. @item flags
  14096. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  14097. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  14098. @table @option
  14099. @item low_pass_filter, vlpf
  14100. Enable linear vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  14101. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  14102. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  14103. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  14104. patterning.
  14105. @item complex_filter, cvlpf
  14106. Enable complex vertical low-pass filtering.
  14107. This will slightly less reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  14108. patterning but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  14109. @item bypass_il
  14110. Bypass already interlaced frames, only adjust the frame rate.
  14111. @end table
  14112. Vertical low-pass filtering and bypassing already interlaced frames can only be
  14113. enabled for @option{mode} @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  14114. @end table
  14115. @section tmedian
  14116. Pick median pixels from several successive input video frames.
  14117. The filter accepts the following options:
  14118. @table @option
  14119. @item radius
  14120. Set radius of median filter.
  14121. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 127.
  14122. @item planes
  14123. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  14124. @item percentile
  14125. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  14126. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  14127. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  14128. @end table
  14129. @section tmix
  14130. Mix successive video frames.
  14131. A description of the accepted options follows.
  14132. @table @option
  14133. @item frames
  14134. The number of successive frames to mix. If unspecified, it defaults to 3.
  14135. @item weights
  14136. Specify weight of each input video frame.
  14137. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights is smaller than
  14138. number of @var{frames} last specified weight will be used for all remaining
  14139. unset weights.
  14140. @item scale
  14141. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  14142. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  14143. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  14144. @end table
  14145. @subsection Examples
  14146. @itemize
  14147. @item
  14148. Average 7 successive frames:
  14149. @example
  14150. tmix=frames=7:weights="1 1 1 1 1 1 1"
  14151. @end example
  14152. @item
  14153. Apply simple temporal convolution:
  14154. @example
  14155. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 3 -1"
  14156. @end example
  14157. @item
  14158. Similar as above but only showing temporal differences:
  14159. @example
  14160. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 2 -1":scale=1
  14161. @end example
  14162. @end itemize
  14163. @anchor{tonemap}
  14164. @section tonemap
  14165. Tone map colors from different dynamic ranges.
  14166. This filter expects data in single precision floating point, as it needs to
  14167. operate on (and can output) out-of-range values. Another filter, such as
  14168. @ref{zscale}, is needed to convert the resulting frame to a usable format.
  14169. The tonemapping algorithms implemented only work on linear light, so input
  14170. data should be linearized beforehand (and possibly correctly tagged).
  14171. @example
  14172. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,tonemap=clip,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT
  14173. @end example
  14174. @subsection Options
  14175. The filter accepts the following options.
  14176. @table @option
  14177. @item tonemap
  14178. Set the tone map algorithm to use.
  14179. Possible values are:
  14180. @table @var
  14181. @item none
  14182. Do not apply any tone map, only desaturate overbright pixels.
  14183. @item clip
  14184. Hard-clip any out-of-range values. Use it for perfect color accuracy for
  14185. in-range values, while distorting out-of-range values.
  14186. @item linear
  14187. Stretch the entire reference gamut to a linear multiple of the display.
  14188. @item gamma
  14189. Fit a logarithmic transfer between the tone curves.
  14190. @item reinhard
  14191. Preserve overall image brightness with a simple curve, using nonlinear
  14192. contrast, which results in flattening details and degrading color accuracy.
  14193. @item hable
  14194. Preserve both dark and bright details better than @var{reinhard}, at the cost
  14195. of slightly darkening everything. Use it when detail preservation is more
  14196. important than color and brightness accuracy.
  14197. @item mobius
  14198. Smoothly map out-of-range values, while retaining contrast and colors for
  14199. in-range material as much as possible. Use it when color accuracy is more
  14200. important than detail preservation.
  14201. @end table
  14202. Default is none.
  14203. @item param
  14204. Tune the tone mapping algorithm.
  14205. This affects the following algorithms:
  14206. @table @var
  14207. @item none
  14208. Ignored.
  14209. @item linear
  14210. Specifies the scale factor to use while stretching.
  14211. Default to 1.0.
  14212. @item gamma
  14213. Specifies the exponent of the function.
  14214. Default to 1.8.
  14215. @item clip
  14216. Specify an extra linear coefficient to multiply into the signal before clipping.
  14217. Default to 1.0.
  14218. @item reinhard
  14219. Specify the local contrast coefficient at the display peak.
  14220. Default to 0.5, which means that in-gamut values will be about half as bright
  14221. as when clipping.
  14222. @item hable
  14223. Ignored.
  14224. @item mobius
  14225. Specify the transition point from linear to mobius transform. Every value
  14226. below this point is guaranteed to be mapped 1:1. The higher the value, the
  14227. more accurate the result will be, at the cost of losing bright details.
  14228. Default to 0.3, which due to the steep initial slope still preserves in-range
  14229. colors fairly accurately.
  14230. @end table
  14231. @item desat
  14232. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  14233. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  14234. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  14235. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  14236. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  14237. The default of 2.0 is somewhat conservative and will mostly just apply to
  14238. skies or directly sunlit surfaces. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  14239. This option works only if the input frame has a supported color tag.
  14240. @item peak
  14241. Override signal/nominal/reference peak with this value. Useful when the
  14242. embedded peak information in display metadata is not reliable or when tone
  14243. mapping from a lower range to a higher range.
  14244. @end table
  14245. @section tpad
  14246. Temporarily pad video frames.
  14247. The filter accepts the following options:
  14248. @table @option
  14249. @item start
  14250. Specify number of delay frames before input video stream. Default is 0.
  14251. @item stop
  14252. Specify number of padding frames after input video stream.
  14253. Set to -1 to pad indefinitely. Default is 0.
  14254. @item start_mode
  14255. Set kind of frames added to beginning of stream.
  14256. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14257. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14258. With @var{clone} frames are clones of first frame.
  14259. Default is @var{add}.
  14260. @item stop_mode
  14261. Set kind of frames added to end of stream.
  14262. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14263. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14264. With @var{clone} frames are clones of last frame.
  14265. Default is @var{add}.
  14266. @item start_duration, stop_duration
  14267. Specify the duration of the start/stop delay. See
  14268. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14269. for the accepted syntax.
  14270. These options override @var{start} and @var{stop}. Default is 0.
  14271. @item color
  14272. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  14273. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  14274. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  14275. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  14276. @end table
  14277. @anchor{transpose}
  14278. @section transpose
  14279. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14280. It accepts the following parameters:
  14281. @table @option
  14282. @item dir
  14283. Specify the transposition direction.
  14284. Can assume the following values:
  14285. @table @samp
  14286. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  14287. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  14288. @example
  14289. L.R L.l
  14290. . . -> . .
  14291. l.r R.r
  14292. @end example
  14293. @item 1, 5, clock
  14294. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  14295. @example
  14296. L.R l.L
  14297. . . -> . .
  14298. l.r r.R
  14299. @end example
  14300. @item 2, 6, cclock
  14301. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  14302. @example
  14303. L.R R.r
  14304. . . -> . .
  14305. l.r L.l
  14306. @end example
  14307. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  14308. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  14309. @example
  14310. L.R r.R
  14311. . . -> . .
  14312. l.r l.L
  14313. @end example
  14314. @end table
  14315. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  14316. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  14317. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  14318. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  14319. symbolic constants.
  14320. @item passthrough
  14321. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14322. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14323. @table @samp
  14324. @item none
  14325. Always apply transposition.
  14326. @item portrait
  14327. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14328. @item landscape
  14329. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14330. @end table
  14331. Default value is @code{none}.
  14332. @end table
  14333. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  14334. layout:
  14335. @example
  14336. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  14337. @end example
  14338. The command above can also be specified as:
  14339. @example
  14340. transpose=1:portrait
  14341. @end example
  14342. @section transpose_npp
  14343. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14344. For more in depth examples see the @ref{transpose} video filter, which shares mostly the same options.
  14345. It accepts the following parameters:
  14346. @table @option
  14347. @item dir
  14348. Specify the transposition direction.
  14349. Can assume the following values:
  14350. @table @samp
  14351. @item cclock_flip
  14352. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)
  14353. @item clock
  14354. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.
  14355. @item cclock
  14356. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.
  14357. @item clock_flip
  14358. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.
  14359. @end table
  14360. @item passthrough
  14361. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14362. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14363. @table @samp
  14364. @item none
  14365. Always apply transposition. (default)
  14366. @item portrait
  14367. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14368. @item landscape
  14369. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14370. @end table
  14371. @end table
  14372. @section trim
  14373. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  14374. It accepts the following parameters:
  14375. @table @option
  14376. @item start
  14377. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  14378. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  14379. @item end
  14380. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  14381. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  14382. frame in the output.
  14383. @item start_pts
  14384. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  14385. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14386. @item end_pts
  14387. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  14388. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14389. @item duration
  14390. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  14391. @item start_frame
  14392. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  14393. @item end_frame
  14394. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  14395. @end table
  14396. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  14397. duration specifications; see
  14398. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14399. for the accepted syntax.
  14400. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  14401. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  14402. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  14403. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  14404. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  14405. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  14406. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  14407. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  14408. filters.
  14409. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  14410. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  14411. Examples:
  14412. @itemize
  14413. @item
  14414. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  14415. @example
  14416. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  14417. @end example
  14418. @item
  14419. Keep only the first second:
  14420. @example
  14421. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  14422. @end example
  14423. @end itemize
  14424. @section unpremultiply
  14425. Apply alpha unpremultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  14426. of second stream as alpha.
  14427. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  14428. The filter accepts the following option:
  14429. @table @option
  14430. @item planes
  14431. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  14432. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  14433. If the format has 1 or 2 components, then luma is bit 0.
  14434. If the format has 3 or 4 components:
  14435. for RGB formats bit 0 is green, bit 1 is blue and bit 2 is red;
  14436. for YUV formats bit 0 is luma, bit 1 is chroma-U and bit 2 is chroma-V.
  14437. If present, the alpha channel is always the last bit.
  14438. @item inplace
  14439. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  14440. @end table
  14441. @anchor{unsharp}
  14442. @section unsharp
  14443. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  14444. It accepts the following parameters:
  14445. @table @option
  14446. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  14447. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  14448. 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14449. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  14450. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  14451. and 23. The default value is 5.
  14452. @item luma_amount, la
  14453. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14454. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14455. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14456. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14457. Default value is 1.0.
  14458. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  14459. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  14460. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14461. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  14462. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  14463. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14464. @item chroma_amount, ca
  14465. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14466. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14467. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14468. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14469. Default value is 0.0.
  14470. @end table
  14471. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  14472. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  14473. @subsection Examples
  14474. @itemize
  14475. @item
  14476. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  14477. @example
  14478. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  14479. @end example
  14480. @item
  14481. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  14482. @example
  14483. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  14484. @end example
  14485. @end itemize
  14486. @anchor{untile}
  14487. @section untile
  14488. Decompose a video made of tiled images into the individual images.
  14489. The frame rate of the output video is the frame rate of the input video
  14490. multiplied by the number of tiles.
  14491. This filter does the reverse of @ref{tile}.
  14492. The filter accepts the following options:
  14493. @table @option
  14494. @item layout
  14495. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  14496. this option, check the
  14497. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  14498. @end table
  14499. @subsection Examples
  14500. @itemize
  14501. @item
  14502. Produce a 1-second video from a still image file made of 25 frames stacked
  14503. vertically, like an analogic film reel:
  14504. @example
  14505. ffmpeg -r 1 -i image.jpg -vf untile=1x25 movie.mkv
  14506. @end example
  14507. @end itemize
  14508. @section uspp
  14509. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  14510. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  14511. shifts and average the results.
  14512. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  14513. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  14514. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  14515. The filter accepts the following options:
  14516. @table @option
  14517. @item quality
  14518. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  14519. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  14520. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  14521. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  14522. @code{3}.
  14523. @item qp
  14524. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  14525. from the video stream (if available).
  14526. @end table
  14527. @section v360
  14528. Convert 360 videos between various formats.
  14529. The filter accepts the following options:
  14530. @table @option
  14531. @item input
  14532. @item output
  14533. Set format of the input/output video.
  14534. Available formats:
  14535. @table @samp
  14536. @item e
  14537. @item equirect
  14538. Equirectangular projection.
  14539. @item c3x2
  14540. @item c6x1
  14541. @item c1x6
  14542. Cubemap with 3x2/6x1/1x6 layout.
  14543. Format specific options:
  14544. @table @option
  14545. @item in_pad
  14546. @item out_pad
  14547. Set padding proportion for the input/output cubemap. Values in decimals.
  14548. Example values:
  14549. @table @samp
  14550. @item 0
  14551. No padding.
  14552. @item 0.01
  14553. 1% of face is padding. For example, with 1920x1280 resolution face size would be 640x640 and padding would be 3 pixels from each side. (640 * 0.01 = 6 pixels)
  14554. @end table
  14555. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14556. Maximum value is @b{@samp{0.1}}.
  14557. @item fin_pad
  14558. @item fout_pad
  14559. Set fixed padding for the input/output cubemap. Values in pixels.
  14560. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}. If greater than zero it overrides other padding options.
  14561. @item in_forder
  14562. @item out_forder
  14563. Set order of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one direction for each position.
  14564. Designation of directions:
  14565. @table @samp
  14566. @item r
  14567. right
  14568. @item l
  14569. left
  14570. @item u
  14571. up
  14572. @item d
  14573. down
  14574. @item f
  14575. forward
  14576. @item b
  14577. back
  14578. @end table
  14579. Default value is @b{@samp{rludfb}}.
  14580. @item in_frot
  14581. @item out_frot
  14582. Set rotation of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one angle for each position.
  14583. Designation of angles:
  14584. @table @samp
  14585. @item 0
  14586. 0 degrees clockwise
  14587. @item 1
  14588. 90 degrees clockwise
  14589. @item 2
  14590. 180 degrees clockwise
  14591. @item 3
  14592. 270 degrees clockwise
  14593. @end table
  14594. Default value is @b{@samp{000000}}.
  14595. @end table
  14596. @item eac
  14597. Equi-Angular Cubemap.
  14598. @item flat
  14599. @item gnomonic
  14600. @item rectilinear
  14601. Regular video.
  14602. Format specific options:
  14603. @table @option
  14604. @item h_fov
  14605. @item v_fov
  14606. @item d_fov
  14607. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14608. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14609. @item ih_fov
  14610. @item iv_fov
  14611. @item id_fov
  14612. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14613. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14614. @end table
  14615. @item dfisheye
  14616. Dual fisheye.
  14617. Format specific options:
  14618. @table @option
  14619. @item h_fov
  14620. @item v_fov
  14621. @item d_fov
  14622. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14623. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14624. @item ih_fov
  14625. @item iv_fov
  14626. @item id_fov
  14627. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14628. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14629. @end table
  14630. @item barrel
  14631. @item fb
  14632. @item barrelsplit
  14633. Facebook's 360 formats.
  14634. @item sg
  14635. Stereographic format.
  14636. Format specific options:
  14637. @table @option
  14638. @item h_fov
  14639. @item v_fov
  14640. @item d_fov
  14641. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14642. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14643. @item ih_fov
  14644. @item iv_fov
  14645. @item id_fov
  14646. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14647. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14648. @end table
  14649. @item mercator
  14650. Mercator format.
  14651. @item ball
  14652. Ball format, gives significant distortion toward the back.
  14653. @item hammer
  14654. Hammer-Aitoff map projection format.
  14655. @item sinusoidal
  14656. Sinusoidal map projection format.
  14657. @item fisheye
  14658. Fisheye projection.
  14659. Format specific options:
  14660. @table @option
  14661. @item h_fov
  14662. @item v_fov
  14663. @item d_fov
  14664. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14665. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14666. @item ih_fov
  14667. @item iv_fov
  14668. @item id_fov
  14669. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14670. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14671. @end table
  14672. @item pannini
  14673. Pannini projection.
  14674. Format specific options:
  14675. @table @option
  14676. @item h_fov
  14677. Set output pannini parameter.
  14678. @item ih_fov
  14679. Set input pannini parameter.
  14680. @end table
  14681. @item cylindrical
  14682. Cylindrical projection.
  14683. Format specific options:
  14684. @table @option
  14685. @item h_fov
  14686. @item v_fov
  14687. @item d_fov
  14688. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14689. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14690. @item ih_fov
  14691. @item iv_fov
  14692. @item id_fov
  14693. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14694. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14695. @end table
  14696. @item perspective
  14697. Perspective projection. @i{(output only)}
  14698. Format specific options:
  14699. @table @option
  14700. @item v_fov
  14701. Set perspective parameter.
  14702. @end table
  14703. @item tetrahedron
  14704. Tetrahedron projection.
  14705. @item tsp
  14706. Truncated square pyramid projection.
  14707. @item he
  14708. @item hequirect
  14709. Half equirectangular projection.
  14710. @item equisolid
  14711. Equisolid format.
  14712. Format specific options:
  14713. @table @option
  14714. @item h_fov
  14715. @item v_fov
  14716. @item d_fov
  14717. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14718. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14719. @item ih_fov
  14720. @item iv_fov
  14721. @item id_fov
  14722. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14723. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14724. @end table
  14725. @item og
  14726. Orthographic format.
  14727. Format specific options:
  14728. @table @option
  14729. @item h_fov
  14730. @item v_fov
  14731. @item d_fov
  14732. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14733. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14734. @item ih_fov
  14735. @item iv_fov
  14736. @item id_fov
  14737. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14738. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14739. @end table
  14740. @end table
  14741. @item interp
  14742. Set interpolation method.@*
  14743. @i{Note: more complex interpolation methods require much more memory to run.}
  14744. Available methods:
  14745. @table @samp
  14746. @item near
  14747. @item nearest
  14748. Nearest neighbour.
  14749. @item line
  14750. @item linear
  14751. Bilinear interpolation.
  14752. @item lagrange9
  14753. Lagrange9 interpolation.
  14754. @item cube
  14755. @item cubic
  14756. Bicubic interpolation.
  14757. @item lanc
  14758. @item lanczos
  14759. Lanczos interpolation.
  14760. @item sp16
  14761. @item spline16
  14762. Spline16 interpolation.
  14763. @item gauss
  14764. @item gaussian
  14765. Gaussian interpolation.
  14766. @end table
  14767. Default value is @b{@samp{line}}.
  14768. @item w
  14769. @item h
  14770. Set the output video resolution.
  14771. Default resolution depends on formats.
  14772. @item in_stereo
  14773. @item out_stereo
  14774. Set the input/output stereo format.
  14775. @table @samp
  14776. @item 2d
  14777. 2D mono
  14778. @item sbs
  14779. Side by side
  14780. @item tb
  14781. Top bottom
  14782. @end table
  14783. Default value is @b{@samp{2d}} for input and output format.
  14784. @item yaw
  14785. @item pitch
  14786. @item roll
  14787. Set rotation for the output video. Values in degrees.
  14788. @item rorder
  14789. Set rotation order for the output video. Choose one item for each position.
  14790. @table @samp
  14791. @item y, Y
  14792. yaw
  14793. @item p, P
  14794. pitch
  14795. @item r, R
  14796. roll
  14797. @end table
  14798. Default value is @b{@samp{ypr}}.
  14799. @item h_flip
  14800. @item v_flip
  14801. @item d_flip
  14802. Flip the output video horizontally(swaps left-right)/vertically(swaps up-down)/in-depth(swaps back-forward). Boolean values.
  14803. @item ih_flip
  14804. @item iv_flip
  14805. Set if input video is flipped horizontally/vertically. Boolean values.
  14806. @item in_trans
  14807. Set if input video is transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14808. @item out_trans
  14809. Set if output video needs to be transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14810. @item alpha_mask
  14811. Build mask in alpha plane for all unmapped pixels by marking them fully transparent. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14812. @end table
  14813. @subsection Examples
  14814. @itemize
  14815. @item
  14816. Convert equirectangular video to cubemap with 3x2 layout and 1% padding using bicubic interpolation:
  14817. @example
  14818. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=e:c3x2:cubic:out_pad=0.01 output.mkv
  14819. @end example
  14820. @item
  14821. Extract back view of Equi-Angular Cubemap:
  14822. @example
  14823. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=eac:flat:yaw=180 output.mkv
  14824. @end example
  14825. @item
  14826. Convert transposed and horizontally flipped Equi-Angular Cubemap in side-by-side stereo format to equirectangular top-bottom stereo format:
  14827. @example
  14828. v360=eac:equirect:in_stereo=sbs:in_trans=1:ih_flip=1:out_stereo=tb
  14829. @end example
  14830. @end itemize
  14831. @subsection Commands
  14832. This filter supports subset of above options as @ref{commands}.
  14833. @section vaguedenoiser
  14834. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  14835. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  14836. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  14837. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  14838. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  14839. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  14840. This filter accepts the following options:
  14841. @table @option
  14842. @item threshold
  14843. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  14844. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  14845. before the video looks overfiltered. Default value is 2.
  14846. @item method
  14847. The filtering method the filter will use.
  14848. It accepts the following values:
  14849. @table @samp
  14850. @item hard
  14851. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  14852. @item soft
  14853. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  14854. reduced by the threshold.
  14855. @item garrote
  14856. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  14857. (less) hard thresholding.
  14858. @end table
  14859. Default is garrote.
  14860. @item nsteps
  14861. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  14862. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  14863. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480). Valid values are integers between 1 and 32. Default value is 6.
  14864. @item percent
  14865. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100. Default value is 85.
  14866. @item planes
  14867. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  14868. @item type
  14869. The threshold type the filter will use.
  14870. It accepts the following values:
  14871. @table @samp
  14872. @item universal
  14873. Threshold used is same for all decompositions.
  14874. @item bayes
  14875. Threshold used depends also on each decomposition coefficients.
  14876. @end table
  14877. Default is universal.
  14878. @end table
  14879. @section vectorscope
  14880. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  14881. a vectorscope).
  14882. This filter accepts the following options:
  14883. @table @option
  14884. @item mode, m
  14885. Set vectorscope mode.
  14886. It accepts the following values:
  14887. @table @samp
  14888. @item gray
  14889. @item tint
  14890. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  14891. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  14892. @item color
  14893. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  14894. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  14895. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  14896. @item color2
  14897. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  14898. @item color3
  14899. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  14900. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  14901. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  14902. @item color4
  14903. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  14904. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  14905. not present in graph is picked.
  14906. @item color5
  14907. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  14908. component picked from radial gradient.
  14909. @end table
  14910. @item x
  14911. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  14912. @item y
  14913. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  14914. @item intensity, i
  14915. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  14916. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  14917. @item envelope, e
  14918. @table @samp
  14919. @item none
  14920. No envelope, this is default.
  14921. @item instant
  14922. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  14923. @item peak
  14924. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  14925. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  14926. @item peak+instant
  14927. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14928. @end table
  14929. @item graticule, g
  14930. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  14931. @table @samp
  14932. @item none
  14933. @item green
  14934. @item color
  14935. @item invert
  14936. @end table
  14937. @item opacity, o
  14938. Set graticule opacity.
  14939. @item flags, f
  14940. Set graticule flags.
  14941. @table @samp
  14942. @item white
  14943. Draw graticule for white point.
  14944. @item black
  14945. Draw graticule for black point.
  14946. @item name
  14947. Draw color points short names.
  14948. @end table
  14949. @item bgopacity, b
  14950. Set background opacity.
  14951. @item lthreshold, l
  14952. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14953. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  14954. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14955. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  14956. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  14957. @item hthreshold, h
  14958. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14959. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  14960. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14961. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  14962. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  14963. @item colorspace, c
  14964. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  14965. @table @samp
  14966. @item auto
  14967. @item 601
  14968. @item 709
  14969. @end table
  14970. Default is auto.
  14971. @item tint0, t0
  14972. @item tint1, t1
  14973. Set color tint for gray/tint vectorscope mode. By default both options are zero.
  14974. This means no tint, and output will remain gray.
  14975. @end table
  14976. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  14977. @section vidstabdetect
  14978. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  14979. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  14980. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  14981. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  14982. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  14983. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14984. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14985. This filter accepts the following options:
  14986. @table @option
  14987. @item result
  14988. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  14989. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  14990. @item shakiness
  14991. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  14992. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  14993. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  14994. @item accuracy
  14995. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  14996. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  14997. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  14998. @item stepsize
  14999. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  15000. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  15001. @item mincontrast
  15002. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  15003. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  15004. value is 0.3.
  15005. @item tripod
  15006. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  15007. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  15008. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  15009. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  15010. the camera view absolutely still.
  15011. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  15012. @item show
  15013. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  15014. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  15015. visualization.
  15016. @end table
  15017. @subsection Examples
  15018. @itemize
  15019. @item
  15020. Use default values:
  15021. @example
  15022. vidstabdetect
  15023. @end example
  15024. @item
  15025. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  15026. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  15027. @example
  15028. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  15029. @end example
  15030. @item
  15031. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  15032. video:
  15033. @example
  15034. vidstabdetect=show=1
  15035. @end example
  15036. @item
  15037. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  15038. @example
  15039. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  15040. @end example
  15041. @end itemize
  15042. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  15043. @section vidstabtransform
  15044. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  15045. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  15046. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  15047. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  15048. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  15049. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  15050. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  15051. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  15052. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  15053. @subsection Options
  15054. @table @option
  15055. @item input
  15056. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  15057. @file{transforms.trf}.
  15058. @item smoothing
  15059. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  15060. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  15061. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  15062. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  15063. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  15064. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  15065. camera is simulated.
  15066. @item optalgo
  15067. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  15068. Accepted values are:
  15069. @table @samp
  15070. @item gauss
  15071. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  15072. @item avg
  15073. averaging on transformations
  15074. @end table
  15075. @item maxshift
  15076. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  15077. meaning no limit.
  15078. @item maxangle
  15079. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  15080. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  15081. @item crop
  15082. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  15083. compensation.
  15084. Available values are:
  15085. @table @samp
  15086. @item keep
  15087. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  15088. @item black
  15089. fill the border black
  15090. @end table
  15091. @item invert
  15092. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  15093. @item relative
  15094. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  15095. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  15096. @item zoom
  15097. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  15098. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  15099. zoom).
  15100. @item optzoom
  15101. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  15102. Accepted values are:
  15103. @table @samp
  15104. @item 0
  15105. disabled
  15106. @item 1
  15107. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  15108. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  15109. @item 2
  15110. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  15111. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  15112. @end table
  15113. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  15114. @item zoomspeed
  15115. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  15116. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  15117. 0.25.
  15118. @item interpol
  15119. Specify type of interpolation.
  15120. Available values are:
  15121. @table @samp
  15122. @item no
  15123. no interpolation
  15124. @item linear
  15125. linear only horizontal
  15126. @item bilinear
  15127. linear in both directions (default)
  15128. @item bicubic
  15129. cubic in both directions (slow)
  15130. @end table
  15131. @item tripod
  15132. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  15133. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  15134. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  15135. @item debug
  15136. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  15137. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  15138. value is 0.
  15139. @end table
  15140. @subsection Examples
  15141. @itemize
  15142. @item
  15143. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  15144. @example
  15145. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  15146. @end example
  15147. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  15148. @item
  15149. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  15150. @example
  15151. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  15152. @end example
  15153. @item
  15154. Smoothen the video even more:
  15155. @example
  15156. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  15157. @end example
  15158. @end itemize
  15159. @section vflip
  15160. Flip the input video vertically.
  15161. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  15162. @example
  15163. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  15164. @end example
  15165. @section vfrdet
  15166. Detect variable frame rate video.
  15167. This filter tries to detect if the input is variable or constant frame rate.
  15168. At end it will output number of frames detected as having variable delta pts,
  15169. and ones with constant delta pts.
  15170. If there was frames with variable delta, than it will also show min, max and
  15171. average delta encountered.
  15172. @section vibrance
  15173. Boost or alter saturation.
  15174. The filter accepts the following options:
  15175. @table @option
  15176. @item intensity
  15177. Set strength of boost if positive value or strength of alter if negative value.
  15178. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -2 to 2.
  15179. @item rbal
  15180. Set the red balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  15181. @item gbal
  15182. Set the green balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  15183. @item bbal
  15184. Set the blue balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  15185. @item rlum
  15186. Set the red luma coefficient.
  15187. @item glum
  15188. Set the green luma coefficient.
  15189. @item blum
  15190. Set the blue luma coefficient.
  15191. @item alternate
  15192. If @code{intensity} is negative and this is set to 1, colors will change,
  15193. otherwise colors will be less saturated, more towards gray.
  15194. @end table
  15195. @subsection Commands
  15196. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  15197. @anchor{vignette}
  15198. @section vignette
  15199. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  15200. The filter accepts the following options:
  15201. @table @option
  15202. @item angle, a
  15203. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  15204. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  15205. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  15206. @item x0
  15207. @item y0
  15208. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  15209. by default.
  15210. @item mode
  15211. Set forward/backward mode.
  15212. Available modes are:
  15213. @table @samp
  15214. @item forward
  15215. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  15216. @item backward
  15217. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  15218. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  15219. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  15220. also be used to create a burning effect.
  15221. @end table
  15222. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  15223. @item eval
  15224. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  15225. It accepts the following values:
  15226. @table @samp
  15227. @item init
  15228. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  15229. @item frame
  15230. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  15231. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  15232. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  15233. @end table
  15234. Default value is @samp{init}.
  15235. @item dither
  15236. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  15237. (enabled).
  15238. @item aspect
  15239. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  15240. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  15241. following the dimensions of the video.
  15242. Default is @code{1/1}.
  15243. @end table
  15244. @subsection Expressions
  15245. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  15246. following parameters.
  15247. @table @option
  15248. @item w
  15249. @item h
  15250. input width and height
  15251. @item n
  15252. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  15253. @item pts
  15254. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  15255. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  15256. @item r
  15257. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  15258. @item t
  15259. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  15260. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  15261. @item tb
  15262. time base of the input video
  15263. @end table
  15264. @subsection Examples
  15265. @itemize
  15266. @item
  15267. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  15268. @example
  15269. vignette=PI/4
  15270. @end example
  15271. @item
  15272. Make a flickering vignetting:
  15273. @example
  15274. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  15275. @end example
  15276. @end itemize
  15277. @section vmafmotion
  15278. Obtain the average VMAF motion score of a video.
  15279. It is one of the component metrics of VMAF.
  15280. The obtained average motion score is printed through the logging system.
  15281. The filter accepts the following options:
  15282. @table @option
  15283. @item stats_file
  15284. If specified, the filter will use the named file to save the motion score of
  15285. each frame with respect to the previous frame.
  15286. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to standard output.
  15287. @end table
  15288. Example:
  15289. @example
  15290. ffmpeg -i ref.mpg -vf vmafmotion -f null -
  15291. @end example
  15292. @section vstack
  15293. Stack input videos vertically.
  15294. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  15295. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  15296. to create same output.
  15297. The filter accepts the following options:
  15298. @table @option
  15299. @item inputs
  15300. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15301. @item shortest
  15302. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15303. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15304. @end table
  15305. @section w3fdif
  15306. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  15307. Deinterlacing Filter").
  15308. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  15309. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  15310. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  15311. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  15312. This filter uses field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  15313. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  15314. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{w3fdif} filter.
  15315. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple"
  15316. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  15317. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  15318. @table @option
  15319. @item filter
  15320. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  15321. @table @samp
  15322. @item simple
  15323. Simple filter coefficient set.
  15324. @item complex
  15325. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  15326. @end table
  15327. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  15328. @item deint
  15329. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:
  15330. @table @samp
  15331. @item all
  15332. Deinterlace all frames,
  15333. @item interlaced
  15334. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15335. @end table
  15336. Default value is @samp{all}.
  15337. @end table
  15338. @section waveform
  15339. Video waveform monitor.
  15340. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  15341. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  15342. source video.
  15343. It accepts the following options:
  15344. @table @option
  15345. @item mode, m
  15346. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  15347. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  15348. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  15349. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  15350. @item intensity, i
  15351. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  15352. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  15353. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  15354. @item mirror, r
  15355. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  15356. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  15357. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  15358. @code{1} (mirrored).
  15359. @item display, d
  15360. Set display mode.
  15361. It accepts the following values:
  15362. @table @samp
  15363. @item overlay
  15364. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  15365. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  15366. over one another.
  15367. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  15368. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  15369. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  15370. @item stack
  15371. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15372. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  15373. @item parade
  15374. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15375. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  15376. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  15377. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  15378. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  15379. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  15380. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  15381. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  15382. @end table
  15383. Default is @code{stack}.
  15384. @item components, c
  15385. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  15386. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  15387. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  15388. @item envelope, e
  15389. @table @samp
  15390. @item none
  15391. No envelope, this is default.
  15392. @item instant
  15393. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  15394. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  15395. @item peak
  15396. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  15397. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  15398. @item peak+instant
  15399. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  15400. @end table
  15401. @item filter, f
  15402. @table @samp
  15403. @item lowpass
  15404. No filtering, this is default.
  15405. @item flat
  15406. Luma and chroma combined together.
  15407. @item aflat
  15408. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  15409. @item xflat
  15410. Similar as above, but use different colors.
  15411. @item yflat
  15412. Similar as above, but again with different colors.
  15413. @item chroma
  15414. Displays only chroma.
  15415. @item color
  15416. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  15417. @item acolor
  15418. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  15419. @end table
  15420. @item graticule, g
  15421. Set which graticule to display.
  15422. @table @samp
  15423. @item none
  15424. Do not display graticule.
  15425. @item green
  15426. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15427. @item orange
  15428. Display orange graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15429. @item invert
  15430. Display invert graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15431. @end table
  15432. @item opacity, o
  15433. Set graticule opacity.
  15434. @item flags, fl
  15435. Set graticule flags.
  15436. @table @samp
  15437. @item numbers
  15438. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  15439. @item dots
  15440. Draw dots instead of lines.
  15441. @end table
  15442. @item scale, s
  15443. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  15444. @table @samp
  15445. @item digital
  15446. @item millivolts
  15447. @item ire
  15448. @end table
  15449. Default is digital.
  15450. @item bgopacity, b
  15451. Set background opacity.
  15452. @item tint0, t0
  15453. @item tint1, t1
  15454. Set tint for output.
  15455. Only used with lowpass filter and when display is not overlay and input
  15456. pixel formats are not RGB.
  15457. @end table
  15458. @section weave, doubleweave
  15459. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  15460. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  15461. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  15462. The @code{doubleweave} works same as @code{weave} but without
  15463. halving frame rate and frame count.
  15464. It accepts the following option:
  15465. @table @option
  15466. @item first_field
  15467. Set first field. Available values are:
  15468. @table @samp
  15469. @item top, t
  15470. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  15471. @item bottom, b
  15472. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  15473. @end table
  15474. @end table
  15475. @subsection Examples
  15476. @itemize
  15477. @item
  15478. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  15479. @example
  15480. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  15481. @end example
  15482. @end itemize
  15483. @section xbr
  15484. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  15485. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  15486. @url{https://forums.libretro.com/t/xbr-algorithm-tutorial/123}.
  15487. It accepts the following option:
  15488. @table @option
  15489. @item n
  15490. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  15491. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  15492. Default is @code{3}.
  15493. @end table
  15494. @section xfade
  15495. Apply cross fade from one input video stream to another input video stream.
  15496. The cross fade is applied for specified duration.
  15497. The filter accepts the following options:
  15498. @table @option
  15499. @item transition
  15500. Set one of available transition effects:
  15501. @table @samp
  15502. @item custom
  15503. @item fade
  15504. @item wipeleft
  15505. @item wiperight
  15506. @item wipeup
  15507. @item wipedown
  15508. @item slideleft
  15509. @item slideright
  15510. @item slideup
  15511. @item slidedown
  15512. @item circlecrop
  15513. @item rectcrop
  15514. @item distance
  15515. @item fadeblack
  15516. @item fadewhite
  15517. @item radial
  15518. @item smoothleft
  15519. @item smoothright
  15520. @item smoothup
  15521. @item smoothdown
  15522. @item circleopen
  15523. @item circleclose
  15524. @item vertopen
  15525. @item vertclose
  15526. @item horzopen
  15527. @item horzclose
  15528. @item dissolve
  15529. @item pixelize
  15530. @item diagtl
  15531. @item diagtr
  15532. @item diagbl
  15533. @item diagbr
  15534. @item hlslice
  15535. @item hrslice
  15536. @item vuslice
  15537. @item vdslice
  15538. @end table
  15539. Default transition effect is fade.
  15540. @item duration
  15541. Set cross fade duration in seconds.
  15542. Default duration is 1 second.
  15543. @item offset
  15544. Set cross fade start relative to first input stream in seconds.
  15545. Default offset is 0.
  15546. @item expr
  15547. Set expression for custom transition effect.
  15548. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  15549. @table @option
  15550. @item X
  15551. @item Y
  15552. The coordinates of the current sample.
  15553. @item W
  15554. @item H
  15555. The width and height of the image.
  15556. @item P
  15557. Progress of transition effect.
  15558. @item PLANE
  15559. Currently processed plane.
  15560. @item A
  15561. Return value of first input at current location and plane.
  15562. @item B
  15563. Return value of second input at current location and plane.
  15564. @item a0(x, y)
  15565. @item a1(x, y)
  15566. @item a2(x, y)
  15567. @item a3(x, y)
  15568. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  15569. first/second/third/fourth component of first input.
  15570. @item b0(x, y)
  15571. @item b1(x, y)
  15572. @item b2(x, y)
  15573. @item b3(x, y)
  15574. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  15575. first/second/third/fourth component of second input.
  15576. @end table
  15577. @end table
  15578. @subsection Examples
  15579. @itemize
  15580. @item
  15581. Cross fade from one input video to another input video, with fade transition and duration of transition
  15582. of 2 seconds starting at offset of 5 seconds:
  15583. @example
  15584. ffmpeg -i first.mp4 -i second.mp4 -filter_complex xfade=transition=fade:duration=2:offset=5 output.mp4
  15585. @end example
  15586. @end itemize
  15587. @section xmedian
  15588. Pick median pixels from several input videos.
  15589. The filter accepts the following options:
  15590. @table @option
  15591. @item inputs
  15592. Set number of inputs.
  15593. Default is 3. Allowed range is from 3 to 255.
  15594. If number of inputs is even number, than result will be mean value between two median values.
  15595. @item planes
  15596. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  15597. @item percentile
  15598. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  15599. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  15600. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  15601. @end table
  15602. @section xstack
  15603. Stack video inputs into custom layout.
  15604. All streams must be of same pixel format.
  15605. The filter accepts the following options:
  15606. @table @option
  15607. @item inputs
  15608. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15609. @item layout
  15610. Specify layout of inputs.
  15611. This option requires the desired layout configuration to be explicitly set by the user.
  15612. This sets position of each video input in output. Each input
  15613. is separated by '|'.
  15614. The first number represents the column, and the second number represents the row.
  15615. Numbers start at 0 and are separated by '_'. Optionally one can use wX and hX,
  15616. where X is video input from which to take width or height.
  15617. Multiple values can be used when separated by '+'. In such
  15618. case values are summed together.
  15619. Note that if inputs are of different sizes gaps may appear, as not all of
  15620. the output video frame will be filled. Similarly, videos can overlap each
  15621. other if their position doesn't leave enough space for the full frame of
  15622. adjoining videos.
  15623. For 2 inputs, a default layout of @code{0_0|w0_0} is set. In all other cases,
  15624. a layout must be set by the user.
  15625. @item shortest
  15626. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15627. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15628. @item fill
  15629. If set to valid color, all unused pixels will be filled with that color.
  15630. By default fill is set to none, so it is disabled.
  15631. @end table
  15632. @subsection Examples
  15633. @itemize
  15634. @item
  15635. Display 4 inputs into 2x2 grid.
  15636. Layout:
  15637. @example
  15638. input1(0, 0) | input3(w0, 0)
  15639. input2(0, h0) | input4(w0, h0)
  15640. @end example
  15641. @example
  15642. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|w0_0|w0_h0
  15643. @end example
  15644. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15645. @item
  15646. Display 4 inputs into 1x4 grid.
  15647. Layout:
  15648. @example
  15649. input1(0, 0)
  15650. input2(0, h0)
  15651. input3(0, h0+h1)
  15652. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)
  15653. @end example
  15654. @example
  15655. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2
  15656. @end example
  15657. Note that if inputs are of different widths, unused space will appear.
  15658. @item
  15659. Display 9 inputs into 3x3 grid.
  15660. Layout:
  15661. @example
  15662. input1(0, 0) | input4(w0, 0) | input7(w0+w3, 0)
  15663. input2(0, h0) | input5(w0, h0) | input8(w0+w3, h0)
  15664. input3(0, h0+h1) | input6(w0, h0+h1) | input9(w0+w3, h0+h1)
  15665. @end example
  15666. @example
  15667. xstack=inputs=9:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0+w3_0|w0+w3_h0|w0+w3_h0+h1
  15668. @end example
  15669. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15670. @item
  15671. Display 16 inputs into 4x4 grid.
  15672. Layout:
  15673. @example
  15674. input1(0, 0) | input5(w0, 0) | input9 (w0+w4, 0) | input13(w0+w4+w8, 0)
  15675. input2(0, h0) | input6(w0, h0) | input10(w0+w4, h0) | input14(w0+w4+w8, h0)
  15676. input3(0, h0+h1) | input7(w0, h0+h1) | input11(w0+w4, h0+h1) | input15(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1)
  15677. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)| input8(w0, h0+h1+h2)| input12(w0+w4, h0+h1+h2)| input16(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1+h2)
  15678. @end example
  15679. @example
  15680. xstack=inputs=16:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4_0|
  15681. w0+w4_h0|w0+w4_h0+h1|w0+w4_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4+w8_0|w0+w4+w8_h0|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1+h2
  15682. @end example
  15683. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15684. @end itemize
  15685. @anchor{yadif}
  15686. @section yadif
  15687. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  15688. filter").
  15689. It accepts the following parameters:
  15690. @table @option
  15691. @item mode
  15692. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15693. @table @option
  15694. @item 0, send_frame
  15695. Output one frame for each frame.
  15696. @item 1, send_field
  15697. Output one frame for each field.
  15698. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15699. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15700. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15701. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15702. @end table
  15703. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15704. @item parity
  15705. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15706. of the following values:
  15707. @table @option
  15708. @item 0, tff
  15709. Assume the top field is first.
  15710. @item 1, bff
  15711. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15712. @item -1, auto
  15713. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15714. @end table
  15715. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15716. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15717. top field first will be assumed.
  15718. @item deint
  15719. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15720. values:
  15721. @table @option
  15722. @item 0, all
  15723. Deinterlace all frames.
  15724. @item 1, interlaced
  15725. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15726. @end table
  15727. The default value is @code{all}.
  15728. @end table
  15729. @section yadif_cuda
  15730. Deinterlace the input video using the @ref{yadif} algorithm, but implemented
  15731. in CUDA so that it can work as part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec
  15732. and/or nvenc.
  15733. It accepts the following parameters:
  15734. @table @option
  15735. @item mode
  15736. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15737. @table @option
  15738. @item 0, send_frame
  15739. Output one frame for each frame.
  15740. @item 1, send_field
  15741. Output one frame for each field.
  15742. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15743. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15744. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15745. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15746. @end table
  15747. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15748. @item parity
  15749. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15750. of the following values:
  15751. @table @option
  15752. @item 0, tff
  15753. Assume the top field is first.
  15754. @item 1, bff
  15755. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15756. @item -1, auto
  15757. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15758. @end table
  15759. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15760. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15761. top field first will be assumed.
  15762. @item deint
  15763. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15764. values:
  15765. @table @option
  15766. @item 0, all
  15767. Deinterlace all frames.
  15768. @item 1, interlaced
  15769. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15770. @end table
  15771. The default value is @code{all}.
  15772. @end table
  15773. @section yaepblur
  15774. Apply blur filter while preserving edges ("yaepblur" means "yet another edge preserving blur filter").
  15775. The algorithm is described in
  15776. "J. S. Lee, Digital image enhancement and noise filtering by use of local statistics, IEEE Trans. Pattern Anal. Mach. Intell. PAMI-2, 1980."
  15777. It accepts the following parameters:
  15778. @table @option
  15779. @item radius, r
  15780. Set the window radius. Default value is 3.
  15781. @item planes, p
  15782. Set which planes to filter. Default is only the first plane.
  15783. @item sigma, s
  15784. Set blur strength. Default value is 128.
  15785. @end table
  15786. @subsection Commands
  15787. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  15788. @section zoompan
  15789. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  15790. This filter accepts the following options:
  15791. @table @option
  15792. @item zoom, z
  15793. Set the zoom expression. Range is 1-10. Default is 1.
  15794. @item x
  15795. @item y
  15796. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  15797. @item d
  15798. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  15799. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  15800. single input image.
  15801. @item s
  15802. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  15803. @item fps
  15804. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  15805. @end table
  15806. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  15807. @table @option
  15808. @item in_w, iw
  15809. Input width.
  15810. @item in_h, ih
  15811. Input height.
  15812. @item out_w, ow
  15813. Output width.
  15814. @item out_h, oh
  15815. Output height.
  15816. @item in
  15817. Input frame count.
  15818. @item on
  15819. Output frame count.
  15820. @item in_time, it
  15821. The input timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  15822. @item out_time, time, ot
  15823. The output timestamp expressed in seconds.
  15824. @item x
  15825. @item y
  15826. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  15827. for current input frame.
  15828. @item px
  15829. @item py
  15830. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  15831. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  15832. @item zoom
  15833. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  15834. @item pzoom
  15835. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  15836. @item duration
  15837. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  15838. for each input frame.
  15839. @item pduration
  15840. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  15841. @item a
  15842. Rational number: input width / input height
  15843. @item sar
  15844. sample aspect ratio
  15845. @item dar
  15846. display aspect ratio
  15847. @end table
  15848. @subsection Examples
  15849. @itemize
  15850. @item
  15851. Zoom in up to 1.5x and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  15852. @example
  15853. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  15854. @end example
  15855. @item
  15856. Zoom in up to 1.5x and pan always at center of picture:
  15857. @example
  15858. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15859. @end example
  15860. @item
  15861. Same as above but without pausing:
  15862. @example
  15863. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15864. @end example
  15865. @item
  15866. Zoom in 2x into center of picture only for the first second of the input video:
  15867. @example
  15868. zoompan=z='if(between(in_time,0,1),2,1)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15869. @end example
  15870. @end itemize
  15871. @anchor{zscale}
  15872. @section zscale
  15873. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  15874. @url{https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg}. To enable compilation of this
  15875. filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzimg}.
  15876. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  15877. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  15878. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  15879. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  15880. requested format.
  15881. @subsection Options
  15882. The filter accepts the following options.
  15883. @table @option
  15884. @item width, w
  15885. @item height, h
  15886. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  15887. dimension.
  15888. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  15889. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  15890. is used for the output.
  15891. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the zscale filter
  15892. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  15893. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  15894. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  15895. adjust the value if necessary.
  15896. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  15897. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  15898. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  15899. expression.
  15900. @item size, s
  15901. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15902. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15903. @item dither, d
  15904. Set the dither type.
  15905. Possible values are:
  15906. @table @var
  15907. @item none
  15908. @item ordered
  15909. @item random
  15910. @item error_diffusion
  15911. @end table
  15912. Default is none.
  15913. @item filter, f
  15914. Set the resize filter type.
  15915. Possible values are:
  15916. @table @var
  15917. @item point
  15918. @item bilinear
  15919. @item bicubic
  15920. @item spline16
  15921. @item spline36
  15922. @item lanczos
  15923. @end table
  15924. Default is bilinear.
  15925. @item range, r
  15926. Set the color range.
  15927. Possible values are:
  15928. @table @var
  15929. @item input
  15930. @item limited
  15931. @item full
  15932. @end table
  15933. Default is same as input.
  15934. @item primaries, p
  15935. Set the color primaries.
  15936. Possible values are:
  15937. @table @var
  15938. @item input
  15939. @item 709
  15940. @item unspecified
  15941. @item 170m
  15942. @item 240m
  15943. @item 2020
  15944. @end table
  15945. Default is same as input.
  15946. @item transfer, t
  15947. Set the transfer characteristics.
  15948. Possible values are:
  15949. @table @var
  15950. @item input
  15951. @item 709
  15952. @item unspecified
  15953. @item 601
  15954. @item linear
  15955. @item 2020_10
  15956. @item 2020_12
  15957. @item smpte2084
  15958. @item iec61966-2-1
  15959. @item arib-std-b67
  15960. @end table
  15961. Default is same as input.
  15962. @item matrix, m
  15963. Set the colorspace matrix.
  15964. Possible value are:
  15965. @table @var
  15966. @item input
  15967. @item 709
  15968. @item unspecified
  15969. @item 470bg
  15970. @item 170m
  15971. @item 2020_ncl
  15972. @item 2020_cl
  15973. @end table
  15974. Default is same as input.
  15975. @item rangein, rin
  15976. Set the input color range.
  15977. Possible values are:
  15978. @table @var
  15979. @item input
  15980. @item limited
  15981. @item full
  15982. @end table
  15983. Default is same as input.
  15984. @item primariesin, pin
  15985. Set the input color primaries.
  15986. Possible values are:
  15987. @table @var
  15988. @item input
  15989. @item 709
  15990. @item unspecified
  15991. @item 170m
  15992. @item 240m
  15993. @item 2020
  15994. @end table
  15995. Default is same as input.
  15996. @item transferin, tin
  15997. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  15998. Possible values are:
  15999. @table @var
  16000. @item input
  16001. @item 709
  16002. @item unspecified
  16003. @item 601
  16004. @item linear
  16005. @item 2020_10
  16006. @item 2020_12
  16007. @end table
  16008. Default is same as input.
  16009. @item matrixin, min
  16010. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  16011. Possible value are:
  16012. @table @var
  16013. @item input
  16014. @item 709
  16015. @item unspecified
  16016. @item 470bg
  16017. @item 170m
  16018. @item 2020_ncl
  16019. @item 2020_cl
  16020. @end table
  16021. @item chromal, c
  16022. Set the output chroma location.
  16023. Possible values are:
  16024. @table @var
  16025. @item input
  16026. @item left
  16027. @item center
  16028. @item topleft
  16029. @item top
  16030. @item bottomleft
  16031. @item bottom
  16032. @end table
  16033. @item chromalin, cin
  16034. Set the input chroma location.
  16035. Possible values are:
  16036. @table @var
  16037. @item input
  16038. @item left
  16039. @item center
  16040. @item topleft
  16041. @item top
  16042. @item bottomleft
  16043. @item bottom
  16044. @end table
  16045. @item npl
  16046. Set the nominal peak luminance.
  16047. @end table
  16048. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  16049. containing the following constants:
  16050. @table @var
  16051. @item in_w
  16052. @item in_h
  16053. The input width and height
  16054. @item iw
  16055. @item ih
  16056. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  16057. @item out_w
  16058. @item out_h
  16059. The output (scaled) width and height
  16060. @item ow
  16061. @item oh
  16062. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  16063. @item a
  16064. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  16065. @item sar
  16066. input sample aspect ratio
  16067. @item dar
  16068. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  16069. @item hsub
  16070. @item vsub
  16071. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  16072. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  16073. @item ohsub
  16074. @item ovsub
  16075. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  16076. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  16077. @end table
  16078. @subsection Commands
  16079. This filter supports the following commands:
  16080. @table @option
  16081. @item width, w
  16082. @item height, h
  16083. Set the output video dimension expression.
  16084. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  16085. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  16086. value.
  16087. @end table
  16088. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  16089. @chapter OpenCL Video Filters
  16090. @c man begin OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  16091. Below is a description of the currently available OpenCL video filters.
  16092. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  16093. @code{--enable-opencl}.
  16094. Running OpenCL filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all filters in any filter graph.
  16095. @table @option
  16096. @item -init_hw_device opencl[=@var{name}][:@var{device}[,@var{key=value}...]]
  16097. Initialise a new hardware device of type @var{opencl} called @var{name}, using the
  16098. given device parameters.
  16099. @item -filter_hw_device @var{name}
  16100. Pass the hardware device called @var{name} to all filters in any filter graph.
  16101. @end table
  16102. For more detailed information see @url{https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options}
  16103. @itemize
  16104. @item
  16105. Example of choosing the first device on the second platform and running avgblur_opencl filter with default parameters on it.
  16106. @example
  16107. -init_hw_device opencl=gpu:1.0 -filter_hw_device gpu -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16108. @end example
  16109. @end itemize
  16110. Since OpenCL filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be uploaded(@ref{hwupload}) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then downloaded(@ref{hwdownload}) back to normal memory. Note that @ref{hwupload} will upload to a surface with the same layout as the software frame, so it may be necessary to add a @ref{format} filter immediately before to get the input into the right format and @ref{hwdownload} does not support all formats on the output - it may be necessary to insert an additional @ref{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a supported format.
  16111. @section avgblur_opencl
  16112. Apply average blur filter.
  16113. The filter accepts the following options:
  16114. @table @option
  16115. @item sizeX
  16116. Set horizontal radius size.
  16117. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{1}.
  16118. @item planes
  16119. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16120. @item sizeY
  16121. Set vertical radius size. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{0}. If zero, @code{sizeX} value will be used.
  16122. @end table
  16123. @subsection Example
  16124. @itemize
  16125. @item
  16126. Apply average blur filter with horizontal and vertical size of 3, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of the 7x7 region centered on it in the input. For pixels on the edges of the image, the region does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  16127. @example
  16128. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16129. @end example
  16130. @end itemize
  16131. @section boxblur_opencl
  16132. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  16133. It accepts the following parameters:
  16134. @table @option
  16135. @item luma_radius, lr
  16136. @item luma_power, lp
  16137. @item chroma_radius, cr
  16138. @item chroma_power, cp
  16139. @item alpha_radius, ar
  16140. @item alpha_power, ap
  16141. @end table
  16142. A description of the accepted options follows.
  16143. @table @option
  16144. @item luma_radius, lr
  16145. @item chroma_radius, cr
  16146. @item alpha_radius, ar
  16147. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  16148. corresponding input plane.
  16149. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  16150. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  16151. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  16152. planes.
  16153. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  16154. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  16155. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  16156. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  16157. @table @option
  16158. @item w
  16159. @item h
  16160. The input width and height in pixels.
  16161. @item cw
  16162. @item ch
  16163. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  16164. @item hsub
  16165. @item vsub
  16166. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  16167. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  16168. @end table
  16169. @item luma_power, lp
  16170. @item chroma_power, cp
  16171. @item alpha_power, ap
  16172. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  16173. corresponding plane.
  16174. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  16175. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  16176. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  16177. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  16178. @end table
  16179. @subsection Examples
  16180. Apply boxblur filter, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of box-radiuses @var{luma_radius}, @var{chroma_radius}, @var{alpha_radius} for each plane respectively. The filter will apply @var{luma_power}, @var{chroma_power}, @var{alpha_power} times onto the corresponding plane. For pixels on the edges of the image, the radius does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  16181. @itemize
  16182. @item
  16183. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radius
  16184. set to 2 and luma, chroma, and alpha power set to 3. The filter will run 3 times with box-radius set to 2 for every plane of the image.
  16185. @example
  16186. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=luma_radius=2:luma_power=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16187. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16188. @end example
  16189. @item
  16190. Apply a boxblur filter with luma radius set to 2, luma_power to 1, chroma_radius to 4, chroma_power to 5, alpha_radius to 3 and alpha_power to 7.
  16191. For the luma plane, a 2x2 box radius will be run once.
  16192. For the chroma plane, a 4x4 box radius will be run 5 times.
  16193. For the alpha plane, a 3x3 box radius will be run 7 times.
  16194. @example
  16195. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:1:4:5:3:7, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16196. @end example
  16197. @end itemize
  16198. @section colorkey_opencl
  16199. RGB colorspace color keying.
  16200. The filter accepts the following options:
  16201. @table @option
  16202. @item color
  16203. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  16204. @item similarity
  16205. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  16206. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  16207. @item blend
  16208. Blend percentage.
  16209. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  16210. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  16211. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  16212. @end table
  16213. @subsection Examples
  16214. @itemize
  16215. @item
  16216. Make every semi-green pixel in the input transparent with some slight blending:
  16217. @example
  16218. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, colorkey_opencl=green:0.3:0.1, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16219. @end example
  16220. @end itemize
  16221. @section convolution_opencl
  16222. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 matrix.
  16223. The filter accepts the following options:
  16224. @table @option
  16225. @item 0m
  16226. @item 1m
  16227. @item 2m
  16228. @item 3m
  16229. Set matrix for each plane.
  16230. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed numbers.
  16231. Default value for each plane is @code{0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0}.
  16232. @item 0rdiv
  16233. @item 1rdiv
  16234. @item 2rdiv
  16235. @item 3rdiv
  16236. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  16237. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  16238. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{1.0}.
  16239. @item 0bias
  16240. @item 1bias
  16241. @item 2bias
  16242. @item 3bias
  16243. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  16244. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker.
  16245. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{0.0}.
  16246. @end table
  16247. @subsection Examples
  16248. @itemize
  16249. @item
  16250. Apply sharpen:
  16251. @example
  16252. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16253. @end example
  16254. @item
  16255. Apply blur:
  16256. @example
  16257. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16258. @end example
  16259. @item
  16260. Apply edge enhance:
  16261. @example
  16262. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16263. @end example
  16264. @item
  16265. Apply edge detect:
  16266. @example
  16267. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16268. @end example
  16269. @item
  16270. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  16271. @example
  16272. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16273. @end example
  16274. @item
  16275. Apply emboss:
  16276. @example
  16277. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16278. @end example
  16279. @end itemize
  16280. @section erosion_opencl
  16281. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  16282. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  16283. It accepts the following options:
  16284. @table @option
  16285. @item threshold0
  16286. @item threshold1
  16287. @item threshold2
  16288. @item threshold3
  16289. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  16290. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  16291. @item coordinates
  16292. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  16293. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  16294. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  16295. 1 2 3
  16296. 4 x 5
  16297. 6 7 8
  16298. @end table
  16299. @subsection Example
  16300. @itemize
  16301. @item
  16302. Apply erosion filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local minimum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local minimum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel - threshold of corresponding plane.
  16303. @example
  16304. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, erosion_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16305. @end example
  16306. @end itemize
  16307. @section deshake_opencl
  16308. Feature-point based video stabilization filter.
  16309. The filter accepts the following options:
  16310. @table @option
  16311. @item tripod
  16312. Simulates a tripod by preventing any camera movement whatsoever from the original frame. Defaults to @code{0}.
  16313. @item debug
  16314. Whether or not additional debug info should be displayed, both in the processed output and in the console.
  16315. Note that in order to see console debug output you will also need to pass @code{-v verbose} to ffmpeg.
  16316. Viewing point matches in the output video is only supported for RGB input.
  16317. Defaults to @code{0}.
  16318. @item adaptive_crop
  16319. Whether or not to do a tiny bit of cropping at the borders to cut down on the amount of mirrored pixels.
  16320. Defaults to @code{1}.
  16321. @item refine_features
  16322. Whether or not feature points should be refined at a sub-pixel level.
  16323. This can be turned off for a slight performance gain at the cost of precision.
  16324. Defaults to @code{1}.
  16325. @item smooth_strength
  16326. The strength of the smoothing applied to the camera path from @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}.
  16327. @code{1.0} is the maximum smoothing strength while values less than that result in less smoothing.
  16328. @code{0.0} causes the filter to adaptively choose a smoothing strength on a per-frame basis.
  16329. Defaults to @code{0.0}.
  16330. @item smooth_window_multiplier
  16331. Controls the size of the smoothing window (the number of frames buffered to determine motion information from).
  16332. The size of the smoothing window is determined by multiplying the framerate of the video by this number.
  16333. Acceptable values range from @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}.
  16334. Larger values increase the amount of motion data available for determining how to smooth the camera path,
  16335. potentially improving smoothness, but also increase latency and memory usage.
  16336. Defaults to @code{2.0}.
  16337. @end table
  16338. @subsection Examples
  16339. @itemize
  16340. @item
  16341. Stabilize a video with a fixed, medium smoothing strength:
  16342. @example
  16343. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, deshake_opencl=smooth_strength=0.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16344. @end example
  16345. @item
  16346. Stabilize a video with debugging (both in console and in rendered video):
  16347. @example
  16348. -i INPUT -filter_complex "[0:v]format=rgba, hwupload, deshake_opencl=debug=1, hwdownload, format=rgba, format=yuv420p" -v verbose OUTPUT
  16349. @end example
  16350. @end itemize
  16351. @section dilation_opencl
  16352. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  16353. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  16354. It accepts the following options:
  16355. @table @option
  16356. @item threshold0
  16357. @item threshold1
  16358. @item threshold2
  16359. @item threshold3
  16360. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  16361. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  16362. @item coordinates
  16363. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  16364. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  16365. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  16366. 1 2 3
  16367. 4 x 5
  16368. 6 7 8
  16369. @end table
  16370. @subsection Example
  16371. @itemize
  16372. @item
  16373. Apply dilation filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local maximum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local maximum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel + threshold of corresponding plane.
  16374. @example
  16375. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, dilation_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16376. @end example
  16377. @end itemize
  16378. @section nlmeans_opencl
  16379. Non-local Means denoise filter through OpenCL, this filter accepts same options as @ref{nlmeans}.
  16380. @section overlay_opencl
  16381. Overlay one video on top of another.
  16382. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is overlaid.
  16383. This filter requires same memory layout for all the inputs. So, format conversion may be needed.
  16384. The filter accepts the following options:
  16385. @table @option
  16386. @item x
  16387. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  16388. Default value is @code{0}.
  16389. @item y
  16390. Set the y coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  16391. Default value is @code{0}.
  16392. @end table
  16393. @subsection Examples
  16394. @itemize
  16395. @item
  16396. Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs are yuv420p format.
  16397. @example
  16398. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16399. @end example
  16400. @item
  16401. The inputs have same memory layout for color channels , the overlay has additional alpha plane, like INPUT is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.
  16402. @example
  16403. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16404. @end example
  16405. @end itemize
  16406. @section pad_opencl
  16407. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  16408. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  16409. It accepts the following options:
  16410. @table @option
  16411. @item width, w
  16412. @item height, h
  16413. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  16414. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  16415. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  16416. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  16417. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  16418. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  16419. @item x
  16420. @item y
  16421. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  16422. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  16423. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  16424. expression, and vice versa.
  16425. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  16426. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  16427. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  16428. @item color
  16429. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  16430. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  16431. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16432. @item aspect
  16433. Pad to an aspect instead to a resolution.
  16434. @end table
  16435. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  16436. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  16437. @table @option
  16438. @item in_w
  16439. @item in_h
  16440. The input video width and height.
  16441. @item iw
  16442. @item ih
  16443. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  16444. @item out_w
  16445. @item out_h
  16446. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  16447. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  16448. @item ow
  16449. @item oh
  16450. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  16451. @item x
  16452. @item y
  16453. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  16454. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  16455. @item a
  16456. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  16457. @item sar
  16458. input sample aspect ratio
  16459. @item dar
  16460. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  16461. @end table
  16462. @section prewitt_opencl
  16463. Apply the Prewitt operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Prewitt_operator}) to input video stream.
  16464. The filter accepts the following option:
  16465. @table @option
  16466. @item planes
  16467. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16468. @item scale
  16469. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16470. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16471. @item delta
  16472. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16473. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16474. @end table
  16475. @subsection Example
  16476. @itemize
  16477. @item
  16478. Apply the Prewitt operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10.
  16479. @example
  16480. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, prewitt_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16481. @end example
  16482. @end itemize
  16483. @anchor{program_opencl}
  16484. @section program_opencl
  16485. Filter video using an OpenCL program.
  16486. @table @option
  16487. @item source
  16488. OpenCL program source file.
  16489. @item kernel
  16490. Kernel name in program.
  16491. @item inputs
  16492. Number of inputs to the filter. Defaults to 1.
  16493. @item size, s
  16494. Size of output frames. Defaults to the same as the first input.
  16495. @end table
  16496. The @code{program_opencl} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  16497. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  16498. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  16499. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  16500. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  16501. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  16502. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  16503. @itemize
  16504. @item
  16505. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  16506. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  16507. @item
  16508. Frame index, @var{unsigned int}.
  16509. This is a counter starting from zero and increasing by one for each frame.
  16510. @item
  16511. Source images, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16512. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  16513. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  16514. @end itemize
  16515. Example programs:
  16516. @itemize
  16517. @item
  16518. Copy the input to the output (output must be the same size as the input).
  16519. @verbatim
  16520. __kernel void copy(__write_only image2d_t destination,
  16521. unsigned int index,
  16522. __read_only image2d_t source)
  16523. {
  16524. const sampler_t sampler = CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE;
  16525. int2 location = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16526. float4 value = read_imagef(source, sampler, location);
  16527. write_imagef(destination, location, value);
  16528. }
  16529. @end verbatim
  16530. @item
  16531. Apply a simple transformation, rotating the input by an amount increasing
  16532. with the index counter. Pixel values are linearly interpolated by the
  16533. sampler, and the output need not have the same dimensions as the input.
  16534. @verbatim
  16535. __kernel void rotate_image(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16536. unsigned int index,
  16537. __read_only image2d_t src)
  16538. {
  16539. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16540. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16541. float angle = (float)index / 100.0f;
  16542. float2 dst_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  16543. float2 src_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(src));
  16544. float2 dst_cen = dst_dim / 2.0f;
  16545. float2 src_cen = src_dim / 2.0f;
  16546. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16547. float2 dst_pos = convert_float2(dst_loc) - dst_cen;
  16548. float2 src_pos = {
  16549. cos(angle) * dst_pos.x - sin(angle) * dst_pos.y,
  16550. sin(angle) * dst_pos.x + cos(angle) * dst_pos.y
  16551. };
  16552. src_pos = src_pos * src_dim / dst_dim;
  16553. float2 src_loc = src_pos + src_cen;
  16554. if (src_loc.x < 0.0f || src_loc.y < 0.0f ||
  16555. src_loc.x > src_dim.x || src_loc.y > src_dim.y)
  16556. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, 0.5f);
  16557. else
  16558. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, read_imagef(src, sampler, src_loc));
  16559. }
  16560. @end verbatim
  16561. @item
  16562. Blend two inputs together, with the amount of each input used varying
  16563. with the index counter.
  16564. @verbatim
  16565. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16566. unsigned int index,
  16567. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  16568. __read_only image2d_t src2)
  16569. {
  16570. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16571. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16572. float blend = (cos((float)index / 50.0f) + 1.0f) / 2.0f;
  16573. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16574. int2 src1_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src1) / get_image_dim(dst);
  16575. int2 src2_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src2) / get_image_dim(dst);
  16576. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, src1_loc);
  16577. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, src2_loc);
  16578. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, val1 * blend + val2 * (1.0f - blend));
  16579. }
  16580. @end verbatim
  16581. @end itemize
  16582. @section roberts_opencl
  16583. Apply the Roberts cross operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Roberts_cross}) to input video stream.
  16584. The filter accepts the following option:
  16585. @table @option
  16586. @item planes
  16587. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16588. @item scale
  16589. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16590. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16591. @item delta
  16592. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16593. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16594. @end table
  16595. @subsection Example
  16596. @itemize
  16597. @item
  16598. Apply the Roberts cross operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16599. @example
  16600. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, roberts_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16601. @end example
  16602. @end itemize
  16603. @section sobel_opencl
  16604. Apply the Sobel operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sobel_operator}) to input video stream.
  16605. The filter accepts the following option:
  16606. @table @option
  16607. @item planes
  16608. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16609. @item scale
  16610. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16611. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16612. @item delta
  16613. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16614. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16615. @end table
  16616. @subsection Example
  16617. @itemize
  16618. @item
  16619. Apply sobel operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16620. @example
  16621. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, sobel_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16622. @end example
  16623. @end itemize
  16624. @section tonemap_opencl
  16625. Perform HDR(PQ/HLG) to SDR conversion with tone-mapping.
  16626. It accepts the following parameters:
  16627. @table @option
  16628. @item tonemap
  16629. Specify the tone-mapping operator to be used. Same as tonemap option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16630. @item param
  16631. Tune the tone mapping algorithm. same as param option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16632. @item desat
  16633. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  16634. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  16635. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  16636. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  16637. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  16638. The default value is 0.5, and the algorithm here is a little different from
  16639. the cpu version tonemap currently. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  16640. @item threshold
  16641. The tonemapping algorithm parameters is fine-tuned per each scene. And a threshold
  16642. is used to detect whether the scene has changed or not. If the distance between
  16643. the current frame average brightness and the current running average exceeds
  16644. a threshold value, we would re-calculate scene average and peak brightness.
  16645. The default value is 0.2.
  16646. @item format
  16647. Specify the output pixel format.
  16648. Currently supported formats are:
  16649. @table @var
  16650. @item p010
  16651. @item nv12
  16652. @end table
  16653. @item range, r
  16654. Set the output color range.
  16655. Possible values are:
  16656. @table @var
  16657. @item tv/mpeg
  16658. @item pc/jpeg
  16659. @end table
  16660. Default is same as input.
  16661. @item primaries, p
  16662. Set the output color primaries.
  16663. Possible values are:
  16664. @table @var
  16665. @item bt709
  16666. @item bt2020
  16667. @end table
  16668. Default is same as input.
  16669. @item transfer, t
  16670. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16671. Possible values are:
  16672. @table @var
  16673. @item bt709
  16674. @item bt2020
  16675. @end table
  16676. Default is bt709.
  16677. @item matrix, m
  16678. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16679. Possible value are:
  16680. @table @var
  16681. @item bt709
  16682. @item bt2020
  16683. @end table
  16684. Default is same as input.
  16685. @end table
  16686. @subsection Example
  16687. @itemize
  16688. @item
  16689. Convert HDR(PQ/HLG) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format using linear operator.
  16690. @example
  16691. -i INPUT -vf "format=p010,hwupload,tonemap_opencl=t=bt2020:tonemap=linear:format=p010,hwdownload,format=p010" OUTPUT
  16692. @end example
  16693. @end itemize
  16694. @section unsharp_opencl
  16695. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  16696. It accepts the following parameters:
  16697. @table @option
  16698. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  16699. Set the luma matrix horizontal size.
  16700. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16701. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  16702. Set the luma matrix vertical size.
  16703. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16704. @item luma_amount, la
  16705. Set the luma effect strength.
  16706. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16707. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16708. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16709. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  16710. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size.
  16711. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16712. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  16713. Set the chroma matrix vertical size.
  16714. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16715. @item chroma_amount, ca
  16716. Set the chroma effect strength.
  16717. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16718. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16719. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16720. @end table
  16721. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  16722. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  16723. @subsection Examples
  16724. @itemize
  16725. @item
  16726. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  16727. @example
  16728. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16729. @end example
  16730. @item
  16731. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  16732. @example
  16733. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=7:7:-2:7:7:-2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16734. @end example
  16735. @end itemize
  16736. @section xfade_opencl
  16737. Cross fade two videos with custom transition effect by using OpenCL.
  16738. It accepts the following options:
  16739. @table @option
  16740. @item transition
  16741. Set one of possible transition effects.
  16742. @table @option
  16743. @item custom
  16744. Select custom transition effect, the actual transition description
  16745. will be picked from source and kernel options.
  16746. @item fade
  16747. @item wipeleft
  16748. @item wiperight
  16749. @item wipeup
  16750. @item wipedown
  16751. @item slideleft
  16752. @item slideright
  16753. @item slideup
  16754. @item slidedown
  16755. Default transition is fade.
  16756. @end table
  16757. @item source
  16758. OpenCL program source file for custom transition.
  16759. @item kernel
  16760. Set name of kernel to use for custom transition from program source file.
  16761. @item duration
  16762. Set duration of video transition.
  16763. @item offset
  16764. Set time of start of transition relative to first video.
  16765. @end table
  16766. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  16767. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  16768. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  16769. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  16770. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  16771. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  16772. @itemize
  16773. @item
  16774. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  16775. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  16776. @item
  16777. First Source image, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16778. Second Source image, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16779. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  16780. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  16781. @item
  16782. Transition progress, @var{float}. This value is always between 0 and 1 inclusive.
  16783. @end itemize
  16784. Example programs:
  16785. @itemize
  16786. @item
  16787. Apply dots curtain transition effect:
  16788. @verbatim
  16789. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16790. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  16791. __read_only image2d_t src2,
  16792. float progress)
  16793. {
  16794. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16795. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16796. int2 p = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16797. float2 rp = (float2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16798. float2 dim = (float2)(get_image_dim(src1).x, get_image_dim(src1).y);
  16799. rp = rp / dim;
  16800. float2 dots = (float2)(20.0, 20.0);
  16801. float2 center = (float2)(0,0);
  16802. float2 unused;
  16803. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, p);
  16804. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, p);
  16805. bool next = distance(fract(rp * dots, &unused), (float2)(0.5, 0.5)) < (progress / distance(rp, center));
  16806. write_imagef(dst, p, next ? val1 : val2);
  16807. }
  16808. @end verbatim
  16809. @end itemize
  16810. @c man end OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  16811. @chapter VAAPI Video Filters
  16812. @c man begin VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16813. VAAPI Video filters are usually used with VAAPI decoder and VAAPI encoder. Below is a description of VAAPI video filters.
  16814. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  16815. @code{--enable-vaapi}.
  16816. To use vaapi filters, you need to setup the vaapi device correctly. For more information, please read @url{https://trac.ffmpeg.org/wiki/Hardware/VAAPI}
  16817. @section tonemap_vaapi
  16818. Perform HDR(High Dynamic Range) to SDR(Standard Dynamic Range) conversion with tone-mapping.
  16819. It maps the dynamic range of HDR10 content to the SDR content.
  16820. It currently only accepts HDR10 as input.
  16821. It accepts the following parameters:
  16822. @table @option
  16823. @item format
  16824. Specify the output pixel format.
  16825. Currently supported formats are:
  16826. @table @var
  16827. @item p010
  16828. @item nv12
  16829. @end table
  16830. Default is nv12.
  16831. @item primaries, p
  16832. Set the output color primaries.
  16833. Default is same as input.
  16834. @item transfer, t
  16835. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16836. Default is bt709.
  16837. @item matrix, m
  16838. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16839. Default is same as input.
  16840. @end table
  16841. @subsection Example
  16842. @itemize
  16843. @item
  16844. Convert HDR(HDR10) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format
  16845. @example
  16846. tonemap_vaapi=format=p010:t=bt2020-10
  16847. @end example
  16848. @end itemize
  16849. @c man end VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16850. @chapter Video Sources
  16851. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  16852. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  16853. @section buffer
  16854. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  16855. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  16856. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  16857. It accepts the following parameters:
  16858. @table @option
  16859. @item video_size
  16860. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  16861. syntax of this option, check the
  16862. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16863. @item width
  16864. The input video width.
  16865. @item height
  16866. The input video height.
  16867. @item pix_fmt
  16868. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  16869. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  16870. name.
  16871. @item time_base
  16872. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  16873. @item frame_rate
  16874. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  16875. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  16876. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  16877. @item sws_param
  16878. This option is deprecated and ignored. Prepend @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  16879. to the filtergraph description to specify swscale flags for automatically
  16880. inserted scalers. See @ref{Filtergraph syntax}.
  16881. @item hw_frames_ctx
  16882. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  16883. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  16884. @end table
  16885. For example:
  16886. @example
  16887. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  16888. @end example
  16889. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  16890. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  16891. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  16892. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  16893. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  16894. this example corresponds to:
  16895. @example
  16896. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  16897. @end example
  16898. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  16899. syntax is deprecated:
  16900. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}
  16901. @section cellauto
  16902. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  16903. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  16904. @option{filename} and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  16905. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  16906. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  16907. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  16908. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  16909. This source accepts the following options:
  16910. @table @option
  16911. @item filename, f
  16912. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16913. the specified file.
  16914. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  16915. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16916. file will be ignored.
  16917. @item pattern, p
  16918. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16919. the specified string.
  16920. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  16921. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16922. string will be ignored.
  16923. @item rate, r
  16924. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16925. Default is 25.
  16926. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16927. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  16928. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  16929. 1/PHI.
  16930. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  16931. @item random_seed, seed
  16932. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  16933. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16934. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16935. effort basis.
  16936. @item rule
  16937. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  16938. Default value is 110.
  16939. @item size, s
  16940. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16941. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16942. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  16943. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  16944. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  16945. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  16946. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  16947. larger row.
  16948. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  16949. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  16950. @item scroll
  16951. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  16952. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  16953. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  16954. Defaults to 1.
  16955. @item start_full, full
  16956. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  16957. outputting the first frame.
  16958. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16959. @item stitch
  16960. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  16961. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16962. @end table
  16963. @subsection Examples
  16964. @itemize
  16965. @item
  16966. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  16967. size 200x400.
  16968. @example
  16969. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  16970. @end example
  16971. @item
  16972. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  16973. ratio of 2/3:
  16974. @example
  16975. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16976. @end example
  16977. @item
  16978. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  16979. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  16980. @example
  16981. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16982. @end example
  16983. @item
  16984. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  16985. @example
  16986. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16987. @end example
  16988. @end itemize
  16989. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  16990. @section coreimagesrc
  16991. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  16992. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  16993. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  16994. generate the content.
  16995. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  16996. @table @option
  16997. @item list_generators
  16998. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  16999. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  17000. @example
  17001. list_generators=true
  17002. @end example
  17003. @item size, s
  17004. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17005. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17006. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  17007. @item rate, r
  17008. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  17009. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  17010. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  17011. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  17012. "25".
  17013. @item sar
  17014. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  17015. @item duration, d
  17016. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  17017. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  17018. for the accepted syntax.
  17019. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  17020. supposed to be generated forever.
  17021. @end table
  17022. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  17023. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  17024. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  17025. and examples for details.
  17026. @subsection Examples
  17027. @itemize
  17028. @item
  17029. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  17030. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  17031. @example
  17032. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  17033. @end example
  17034. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  17035. need for a nullsrc video source.
  17036. @end itemize
  17037. @section gradients
  17038. Generate several gradients.
  17039. @table @option
  17040. @item size, s
  17041. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  17042. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  17043. @item rate, r
  17044. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17045. value is "25".
  17046. @item c0, c1, c2, c3, c4, c5, c6, c7
  17047. Set 8 colors. Default values for colors is to pick random one.
  17048. @item x0, y0, y0, y1
  17049. Set gradient line source and destination points. If negative or out of range, random ones
  17050. are picked.
  17051. @item nb_colors, n
  17052. Set number of colors to use at once. Allowed range is from 2 to 8. Default value is 2.
  17053. @item seed
  17054. Set seed for picking gradient line points.
  17055. @end table
  17056. @section mandelbrot
  17057. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  17058. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  17059. This source accepts the following options:
  17060. @table @option
  17061. @item end_pts
  17062. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  17063. @item end_scale
  17064. Set the terminal scale value.
  17065. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  17066. @item inner
  17067. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  17068. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  17069. It shall assume one of the following values:
  17070. @table @option
  17071. @item black
  17072. Set black mode.
  17073. @item convergence
  17074. Show time until convergence.
  17075. @item mincol
  17076. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  17077. @item period
  17078. Set period mode.
  17079. @end table
  17080. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  17081. @item bailout
  17082. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  17083. @item maxiter
  17084. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  17085. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  17086. @item outer
  17087. Set outer coloring mode.
  17088. It shall assume one of following values:
  17089. @table @option
  17090. @item iteration_count
  17091. Set iteration count mode.
  17092. @item normalized_iteration_count
  17093. set normalized iteration count mode.
  17094. @end table
  17095. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  17096. @item rate, r
  17097. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17098. value is "25".
  17099. @item size, s
  17100. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  17101. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  17102. @item start_scale
  17103. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  17104. @item start_x
  17105. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  17106. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  17107. @item start_y
  17108. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  17109. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  17110. @end table
  17111. @section mptestsrc
  17112. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  17113. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  17114. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  17115. This source accepts the following options:
  17116. @table @option
  17117. @item rate, r
  17118. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  17119. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  17120. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  17121. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  17122. "25".
  17123. @item duration, d
  17124. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  17125. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  17126. for the accepted syntax.
  17127. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  17128. supposed to be generated forever.
  17129. @item test, t
  17130. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  17131. @table @option
  17132. @item dc_luma
  17133. @item dc_chroma
  17134. @item freq_luma
  17135. @item freq_chroma
  17136. @item amp_luma
  17137. @item amp_chroma
  17138. @item cbp
  17139. @item mv
  17140. @item ring1
  17141. @item ring2
  17142. @item all
  17143. @item max_frames, m
  17144. Set the maximum number of frames generated for each test, default value is 30.
  17145. @end table
  17146. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  17147. @end table
  17148. Some examples:
  17149. @example
  17150. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  17151. @end example
  17152. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  17153. @section frei0r_src
  17154. Provide a frei0r source.
  17155. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  17156. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  17157. This source accepts the following parameters:
  17158. @table @option
  17159. @item size
  17160. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17161. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17162. @item framerate
  17163. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  17164. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  17165. @item filter_name
  17166. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  17167. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  17168. documentation.
  17169. @item filter_params
  17170. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  17171. @end table
  17172. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  17173. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  17174. @example
  17175. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  17176. @end example
  17177. @section life
  17178. Generate a life pattern.
  17179. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  17180. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  17181. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  17182. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  17183. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  17184. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  17185. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  17186. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  17187. the rule to adopt.
  17188. This source accepts the following options:
  17189. @table @option
  17190. @item filename, f
  17191. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  17192. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  17193. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  17194. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  17195. randomly.
  17196. @item rate, r
  17197. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  17198. Default is 25.
  17199. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  17200. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  17201. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  17202. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  17203. @item random_seed, seed
  17204. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  17205. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  17206. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  17207. effort basis.
  17208. @item rule
  17209. Set the life rule.
  17210. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  17211. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  17212. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  17213. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  17214. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  17215. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  17216. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  17217. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  17218. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  17219. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  17220. higher number of neighbor cells.
  17221. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  17222. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  17223. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  17224. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  17225. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  17226. a dead cell.
  17227. @item size, s
  17228. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17229. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17230. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  17231. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  17232. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  17233. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  17234. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  17235. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  17236. @item stitch
  17237. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  17238. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  17239. @item mold
  17240. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  17241. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  17242. value from 0 to 255.
  17243. @item life_color
  17244. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  17245. @item death_color
  17246. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  17247. used to represent a dead cell.
  17248. @item mold_color
  17249. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  17250. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  17251. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17252. @end table
  17253. @subsection Examples
  17254. @itemize
  17255. @item
  17256. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  17257. 300x300 pixels:
  17258. @example
  17259. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  17260. @end example
  17261. @item
  17262. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  17263. @example
  17264. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  17265. @end example
  17266. @item
  17267. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  17268. @example
  17269. life=rule=S14/B34
  17270. @end example
  17271. @item
  17272. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  17273. @example
  17274. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  17275. @end example
  17276. @end itemize
  17277. @anchor{allrgb}
  17278. @anchor{allyuv}
  17279. @anchor{color}
  17280. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  17281. @anchor{nullsrc}
  17282. @anchor{pal75bars}
  17283. @anchor{pal100bars}
  17284. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  17285. @anchor{smptebars}
  17286. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  17287. @anchor{testsrc}
  17288. @anchor{testsrc2}
  17289. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  17290. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, pal75bars, pal100bars, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  17291. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  17292. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  17293. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  17294. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  17295. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  17296. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  17297. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  17298. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  17299. The @code{pal75bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17300. EBU PAL recommendations with 75% color levels.
  17301. The @code{pal100bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17302. EBU PAL recommendations with 100% color levels.
  17303. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  17304. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  17305. stripe from top to bottom.
  17306. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17307. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  17308. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17309. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  17310. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  17311. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  17312. intended for testing purposes.
  17313. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  17314. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  17315. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  17316. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  17317. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  17318. The sources accept the following parameters:
  17319. @table @option
  17320. @item level
  17321. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  17322. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  17323. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  17324. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  17325. @item color, c
  17326. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  17327. source. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17328. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17329. @item size, s
  17330. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17331. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17332. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  17333. This option is not available with the @code{allrgb}, @code{allyuv}, and
  17334. @code{haldclutsrc} filters.
  17335. @item rate, r
  17336. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  17337. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  17338. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  17339. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  17340. "25".
  17341. @item duration, d
  17342. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  17343. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  17344. for the accepted syntax.
  17345. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  17346. supposed to be generated forever.
  17347. @item sar
  17348. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  17349. @item alpha
  17350. Specify the alpha (opacity) of the background, only available in the
  17351. @code{testsrc2} source. The value must be between 0 (fully transparent) and
  17352. 255 (fully opaque, the default).
  17353. @item decimals, n
  17354. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  17355. @code{testsrc} source.
  17356. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  17357. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  17358. value. Default value is 0.
  17359. @end table
  17360. @subsection Examples
  17361. @itemize
  17362. @item
  17363. Generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  17364. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second:
  17365. @example
  17366. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  17367. @end example
  17368. @item
  17369. The following graph description will generate a red source
  17370. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  17371. frames per second:
  17372. @example
  17373. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  17374. @end example
  17375. @item
  17376. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  17377. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  17378. the @code{geq} filter:
  17379. @example
  17380. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  17381. @end example
  17382. @end itemize
  17383. @subsection Commands
  17384. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  17385. @table @option
  17386. @item c, color
  17387. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  17388. corresponding @option{color} option.
  17389. @end table
  17390. @section openclsrc
  17391. Generate video using an OpenCL program.
  17392. @table @option
  17393. @item source
  17394. OpenCL program source file.
  17395. @item kernel
  17396. Kernel name in program.
  17397. @item size, s
  17398. Size of frames to generate. This must be set.
  17399. @item format
  17400. Pixel format to use for the generated frames. This must be set.
  17401. @item rate, r
  17402. Number of frames generated every second. Default value is '25'.
  17403. @end table
  17404. For details of how the program loading works, see the @ref{program_opencl}
  17405. filter.
  17406. Example programs:
  17407. @itemize
  17408. @item
  17409. Generate a colour ramp by setting pixel values from the position of the pixel
  17410. in the output image. (Note that this will work with all pixel formats, but
  17411. the generated output will not be the same.)
  17412. @verbatim
  17413. __kernel void ramp(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  17414. unsigned int index)
  17415. {
  17416. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  17417. float4 val;
  17418. val.xy = val.zw = convert_float2(loc) / convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  17419. write_imagef(dst, loc, val);
  17420. }
  17421. @end verbatim
  17422. @item
  17423. Generate a Sierpinski carpet pattern, panning by a single pixel each frame.
  17424. @verbatim
  17425. __kernel void sierpinski_carpet(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  17426. unsigned int index)
  17427. {
  17428. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  17429. float4 value = 0.0f;
  17430. int x = loc.x + index;
  17431. int y = loc.y + index;
  17432. while (x > 0 || y > 0) {
  17433. if (x % 3 == 1 && y % 3 == 1) {
  17434. value = 1.0f;
  17435. break;
  17436. }
  17437. x /= 3;
  17438. y /= 3;
  17439. }
  17440. write_imagef(dst, loc, value);
  17441. }
  17442. @end verbatim
  17443. @end itemize
  17444. @section sierpinski
  17445. Generate a Sierpinski carpet/triangle fractal, and randomly pan around.
  17446. This source accepts the following options:
  17447. @table @option
  17448. @item size, s
  17449. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  17450. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  17451. @item rate, r
  17452. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17453. value is "25".
  17454. @item seed
  17455. Set seed which is used for random panning.
  17456. @item jump
  17457. Set max jump for single pan destination. Allowed range is from 1 to 10000.
  17458. @item type
  17459. Set fractal type, can be default @code{carpet} or @code{triangle}.
  17460. @end table
  17461. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  17462. @chapter Video Sinks
  17463. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  17464. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  17465. @section buffersink
  17466. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  17467. graph.
  17468. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  17469. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  17470. or the options system.
  17471. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  17472. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  17473. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  17474. @section nullsink
  17475. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  17476. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  17477. tools.
  17478. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  17479. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  17480. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  17481. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  17482. @section abitscope
  17483. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio bit scope.
  17484. The filter accepts the following options:
  17485. @table @option
  17486. @item rate, r
  17487. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17488. value is "25".
  17489. @item size, s
  17490. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17491. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17492. Default value is @code{1024x256}.
  17493. @item colors
  17494. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  17495. draw channels. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  17496. by white color.
  17497. @end table
  17498. @section adrawgraph
  17499. Draw a graph using input audio metadata.
  17500. See @ref{drawgraph}
  17501. @section agraphmonitor
  17502. See @ref{graphmonitor}.
  17503. @section ahistogram
  17504. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  17505. The filter accepts the following options:
  17506. @table @option
  17507. @item dmode
  17508. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  17509. It accepts the following values:
  17510. @table @samp
  17511. @item single
  17512. Use single histogram for all channels.
  17513. @item separate
  17514. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  17515. @end table
  17516. Default is @code{single}.
  17517. @item rate, r
  17518. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17519. value is "25".
  17520. @item size, s
  17521. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17522. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17523. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  17524. @item scale
  17525. Set display scale.
  17526. It accepts the following values:
  17527. @table @samp
  17528. @item log
  17529. logarithmic
  17530. @item sqrt
  17531. square root
  17532. @item cbrt
  17533. cubic root
  17534. @item lin
  17535. linear
  17536. @item rlog
  17537. reverse logarithmic
  17538. @end table
  17539. Default is @code{log}.
  17540. @item ascale
  17541. Set amplitude scale.
  17542. It accepts the following values:
  17543. @table @samp
  17544. @item log
  17545. logarithmic
  17546. @item lin
  17547. linear
  17548. @end table
  17549. Default is @code{log}.
  17550. @item acount
  17551. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  17552. Default is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  17553. @item rheight
  17554. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  17555. @item slide
  17556. Set sonogram sliding.
  17557. It accepts the following values:
  17558. @table @samp
  17559. @item replace
  17560. replace old rows with new ones.
  17561. @item scroll
  17562. scroll from top to bottom.
  17563. @end table
  17564. Default is @code{replace}.
  17565. @end table
  17566. @section aphasemeter
  17567. Measures phase of input audio, which is exported as metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase},
  17568. representing mean phase of current audio frame. A video output can also be produced and is
  17569. enabled by default. The audio is passed through as first output.
  17570. Audio will be rematrixed to stereo if it has a different channel layout. Phase value is in
  17571. range @code{[-1, 1]} where @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase
  17572. and @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  17573. The filter accepts the following options, all related to its video output:
  17574. @table @option
  17575. @item rate, r
  17576. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17577. @item size, s
  17578. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17579. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17580. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  17581. @item rc
  17582. @item gc
  17583. @item bc
  17584. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  17585. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  17586. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17587. @item mpc
  17588. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  17589. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  17590. @item video
  17591. Enable video output. Default is enabled.
  17592. @end table
  17593. @section avectorscope
  17594. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  17595. scope.
  17596. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  17597. audio stream. A monaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  17598. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  17599. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  17600. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  17601. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  17602. The filter accepts the following options:
  17603. @table @option
  17604. @item mode, m
  17605. Set the vectorscope mode.
  17606. Available values are:
  17607. @table @samp
  17608. @item lissajous
  17609. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  17610. @item lissajous_xy
  17611. Same as above but not rotated.
  17612. @item polar
  17613. Shape resembling half of circle.
  17614. @end table
  17615. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  17616. @item size, s
  17617. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17618. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17619. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  17620. @item rate, r
  17621. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17622. @item rc
  17623. @item gc
  17624. @item bc
  17625. @item ac
  17626. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  17627. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  17628. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17629. @item rf
  17630. @item gf
  17631. @item bf
  17632. @item af
  17633. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  17634. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  17635. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17636. @item zoom
  17637. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  17638. Values lower than @var{1} will auto adjust zoom factor to maximal possible value.
  17639. @item draw
  17640. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  17641. Available values are:
  17642. @table @samp
  17643. @item dot
  17644. Draw dot for each sample.
  17645. @item line
  17646. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  17647. @end table
  17648. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  17649. @item scale
  17650. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  17651. Available values are:
  17652. @table @samp
  17653. @item lin
  17654. Linear.
  17655. @item sqrt
  17656. Square root.
  17657. @item cbrt
  17658. Cubic root.
  17659. @item log
  17660. Logarithmic.
  17661. @end table
  17662. @item swap
  17663. Swap left channel axis with right channel axis.
  17664. @item mirror
  17665. Mirror axis.
  17666. @table @samp
  17667. @item none
  17668. No mirror.
  17669. @item x
  17670. Mirror only x axis.
  17671. @item y
  17672. Mirror only y axis.
  17673. @item xy
  17674. Mirror both axis.
  17675. @end table
  17676. @end table
  17677. @subsection Examples
  17678. @itemize
  17679. @item
  17680. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  17681. @example
  17682. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  17683. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  17684. @end example
  17685. @end itemize
  17686. @section bench, abench
  17687. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  17688. The filter accepts the following options:
  17689. @table @option
  17690. @item action
  17691. Start or stop a timer.
  17692. Available values are:
  17693. @table @samp
  17694. @item start
  17695. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  17696. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  17697. @item stop
  17698. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  17699. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  17700. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  17701. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  17702. @end table
  17703. @end table
  17704. @subsection Examples
  17705. @itemize
  17706. @item
  17707. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  17708. @example
  17709. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  17710. @end example
  17711. @end itemize
  17712. @section concat
  17713. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  17714. other.
  17715. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  17716. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  17717. also be the number of streams at output.
  17718. The filter accepts the following options:
  17719. @table @option
  17720. @item n
  17721. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  17722. @item v
  17723. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  17724. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  17725. @item a
  17726. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  17727. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  17728. @item unsafe
  17729. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  17730. @end table
  17731. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  17732. @var{a} audio outputs.
  17733. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  17734. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  17735. segment, etc.
  17736. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  17737. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  17738. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  17739. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  17740. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  17741. audio streams with silence.
  17742. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  17743. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  17744. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  17745. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  17746. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  17747. explicitly by the user.
  17748. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  17749. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  17750. @subsection Examples
  17751. @itemize
  17752. @item
  17753. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  17754. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  17755. @example
  17756. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  17757. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  17758. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  17759. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  17760. @end example
  17761. @item
  17762. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  17763. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  17764. @example
  17765. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  17766. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  17767. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  17768. @end example
  17769. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  17770. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  17771. @end itemize
  17772. @subsection Commands
  17773. This filter supports the following commands:
  17774. @table @option
  17775. @item next
  17776. Close the current segment and step to the next one
  17777. @end table
  17778. @anchor{ebur128}
  17779. @section ebur128
  17780. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream and analyzes its loudness
  17781. level. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  17782. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  17783. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  17784. The filter can only analyze streams which have a sampling rate of 48000 Hz and whose
  17785. sample format is double-precision floating point. The input stream will be converted to
  17786. this specification, if needed. Users may need to insert aformat and/or aresample filters
  17787. after this filter to obtain the original parameters.
  17788. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  17789. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  17790. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  17791. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  17792. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  17793. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds), but can optionally be configured
  17794. to instead display short-term loudness (see @var{gauge}).
  17795. The green area marks a +/- 1LU target range around the target loudness
  17796. (-23LUFS by default, unless modified through @var{target}).
  17797. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  17798. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  17799. The filter accepts the following options:
  17800. @table @option
  17801. @item video
  17802. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  17803. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  17804. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  17805. @item size
  17806. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  17807. option, check the
  17808. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17809. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  17810. @item meter
  17811. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  17812. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  17813. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  17814. @item metadata
  17815. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  17816. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  17817. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  17818. Default is @code{0}.
  17819. @item framelog
  17820. Force the frame logging level.
  17821. Available values are:
  17822. @table @samp
  17823. @item info
  17824. information logging level
  17825. @item verbose
  17826. verbose logging level
  17827. @end table
  17828. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  17829. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  17830. @item peak
  17831. Set peak mode(s).
  17832. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  17833. values are:
  17834. @table @samp
  17835. @item none
  17836. Disable any peak mode (default).
  17837. @item sample
  17838. Enable sample-peak mode.
  17839. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  17840. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  17841. @item true
  17842. Enable true-peak mode.
  17843. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  17844. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  17845. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  17846. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  17847. @end table
  17848. @item dualmono
  17849. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  17850. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  17851. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  17852. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  17853. @item panlaw
  17854. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  17855. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  17856. @item target
  17857. Set a specific target level (in LUFS) used as relative zero in the visualization.
  17858. This parameter is optional and has a default value of -23LUFS as specified
  17859. by EBU R128. However, material published online may prefer a level of -16LUFS
  17860. (e.g. for use with podcasts or video platforms).
  17861. @item gauge
  17862. Set the value displayed by the gauge. Valid values are @code{momentary} and s
  17863. @code{shortterm}. By default the momentary value will be used, but in certain
  17864. scenarios it may be more useful to observe the short term value instead (e.g.
  17865. live mixing).
  17866. @item scale
  17867. Sets the display scale for the loudness. Valid parameters are @code{absolute}
  17868. (in LUFS) or @code{relative} (LU) relative to the target. This only affects the
  17869. video output, not the summary or continuous log output.
  17870. @end table
  17871. @subsection Examples
  17872. @itemize
  17873. @item
  17874. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  17875. @example
  17876. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  17877. @end example
  17878. @item
  17879. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  17880. @example
  17881. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  17882. @end example
  17883. @end itemize
  17884. @section interleave, ainterleave
  17885. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  17886. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  17887. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  17888. queued frame to the output.
  17889. Input streams must have well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  17890. timestamp values.
  17891. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  17892. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  17893. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  17894. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  17895. which always drops input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  17896. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  17897. to output until the input sends an end-of-stream signal.
  17898. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  17899. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  17900. the queue is already filled.
  17901. These filters accept the following options:
  17902. @table @option
  17903. @item nb_inputs, n
  17904. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  17905. @item duration
  17906. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  17907. @table @option
  17908. @item longest
  17909. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  17910. @item shortest
  17911. The duration of the shortest input.
  17912. @item first
  17913. The duration of the first input.
  17914. @end table
  17915. @end table
  17916. @subsection Examples
  17917. @itemize
  17918. @item
  17919. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  17920. @example
  17921. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  17922. @end example
  17923. @item
  17924. Add flickering blur effect:
  17925. @example
  17926. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  17927. @end example
  17928. @end itemize
  17929. @section metadata, ametadata
  17930. Manipulate frame metadata.
  17931. This filter accepts the following options:
  17932. @table @option
  17933. @item mode
  17934. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  17935. Can be one of the following:
  17936. @table @samp
  17937. @item select
  17938. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  17939. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  17940. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  17941. @item add
  17942. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  17943. do nothing.
  17944. @item modify
  17945. Modify value of already present key.
  17946. @item delete
  17947. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  17948. Otherwise, delete key. If @code{key} is not set, delete all metadata values in
  17949. the frame.
  17950. @item print
  17951. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  17952. metadata values available in frame.
  17953. @end table
  17954. @item key
  17955. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print} and @code{delete}.
  17956. @item value
  17957. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  17958. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  17959. @item function
  17960. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  17961. Can be one of following:
  17962. @table @samp
  17963. @item same_str
  17964. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  17965. @item starts_with
  17966. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  17967. the @code{value} option string.
  17968. @item less
  17969. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  17970. @item equal
  17971. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  17972. @item greater
  17973. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  17974. @item expr
  17975. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  17976. evaluates to true.
  17977. @item ends_with
  17978. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value ends with
  17979. the @code{value} option string.
  17980. @end table
  17981. @item expr
  17982. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  17983. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  17984. constants:
  17985. @table @option
  17986. @item VALUE1
  17987. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  17988. @item VALUE2
  17989. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  17990. @end table
  17991. @item file
  17992. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  17993. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  17994. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  17995. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  17996. @item direct
  17997. Reduces buffering in print mode when output is written to a URL set using @var{file}.
  17998. @end table
  17999. @subsection Examples
  18000. @itemize
  18001. @item
  18002. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.signalstats.YDIF} with values
  18003. between 0 and 1.
  18004. @example
  18005. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  18006. @end example
  18007. @item
  18008. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  18009. @example
  18010. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  18011. @end example
  18012. @item
  18013. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  18014. @example
  18015. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  18016. @end example
  18017. @end itemize
  18018. @section perms, aperms
  18019. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  18020. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  18021. following filter in the filtergraph.
  18022. The filters accept the following options:
  18023. @table @option
  18024. @item mode
  18025. Select the permissions mode.
  18026. It accepts the following values:
  18027. @table @samp
  18028. @item none
  18029. Do nothing. This is the default.
  18030. @item ro
  18031. Set all the output frames read-only.
  18032. @item rw
  18033. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  18034. @item toggle
  18035. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  18036. @item random
  18037. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  18038. @end table
  18039. @item seed
  18040. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  18041. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  18042. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  18043. basis.
  18044. @end table
  18045. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  18046. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  18047. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  18048. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  18049. @section realtime, arealtime
  18050. Slow down filtering to match real time approximately.
  18051. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  18052. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  18053. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  18054. They accept the following options:
  18055. @table @option
  18056. @item limit
  18057. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  18058. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  18059. @item speed
  18060. Speed factor for processing. The value must be a float larger than zero.
  18061. Values larger than 1.0 will result in faster than realtime processing,
  18062. smaller will slow processing down. The @var{limit} is automatically adapted
  18063. accordingly. Default is 1.0.
  18064. A processing speed faster than what is possible without these filters cannot
  18065. be achieved.
  18066. @end table
  18067. @anchor{select}
  18068. @section select, aselect
  18069. Select frames to pass in output.
  18070. This filter accepts the following options:
  18071. @table @option
  18072. @item expr, e
  18073. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  18074. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  18075. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  18076. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  18077. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  18078. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  18079. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  18080. @item outputs, n
  18081. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  18082. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  18083. @end table
  18084. The expression can contain the following constants:
  18085. @table @option
  18086. @item n
  18087. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  18088. @item selected_n
  18089. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  18090. @item prev_selected_n
  18091. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  18092. @item TB
  18093. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  18094. @item pts
  18095. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  18096. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  18097. @item t
  18098. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  18099. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  18100. @item prev_pts
  18101. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  18102. @item prev_selected_pts
  18103. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  18104. @item prev_selected_t
  18105. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  18106. @item start_pts
  18107. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  18108. @item start_t
  18109. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  18110. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  18111. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  18112. values:
  18113. @table @option
  18114. @item I
  18115. @item P
  18116. @item B
  18117. @item S
  18118. @item SI
  18119. @item SP
  18120. @item BI
  18121. @end table
  18122. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  18123. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  18124. @table @option
  18125. @item PROGRESSIVE
  18126. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  18127. @item TOPFIRST
  18128. The frame is top-field-first.
  18129. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  18130. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  18131. @end table
  18132. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  18133. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  18134. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  18135. the number of samples in the current frame
  18136. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  18137. the input sample rate
  18138. @item key
  18139. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  18140. @item pos
  18141. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  18142. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  18143. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  18144. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  18145. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  18146. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  18147. @item concatdec_select
  18148. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  18149. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  18150. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  18151. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  18152. interval.
  18153. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  18154. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  18155. present in the decoded frames.
  18156. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  18157. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  18158. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  18159. missing.
  18160. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  18161. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  18162. @end table
  18163. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  18164. @subsection Examples
  18165. @itemize
  18166. @item
  18167. Select all frames in input:
  18168. @example
  18169. select
  18170. @end example
  18171. The example above is the same as:
  18172. @example
  18173. select=1
  18174. @end example
  18175. @item
  18176. Skip all frames:
  18177. @example
  18178. select=0
  18179. @end example
  18180. @item
  18181. Select only I-frames:
  18182. @example
  18183. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  18184. @end example
  18185. @item
  18186. Select one frame every 100:
  18187. @example
  18188. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  18189. @end example
  18190. @item
  18191. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  18192. @example
  18193. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  18194. @end example
  18195. @item
  18196. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  18197. @example
  18198. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  18199. @end example
  18200. @item
  18201. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  18202. @example
  18203. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  18204. @end example
  18205. @item
  18206. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  18207. @example
  18208. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  18209. @end example
  18210. @item
  18211. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  18212. @example
  18213. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  18214. @end example
  18215. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  18216. choice.
  18217. @item
  18218. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  18219. @example
  18220. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  18221. @end example
  18222. @item
  18223. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  18224. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  18225. @example
  18226. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  18227. @end example
  18228. @end itemize
  18229. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  18230. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  18231. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  18232. filtergraph.
  18233. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  18234. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  18235. from that they act the same way.
  18236. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  18237. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  18238. @var{filename} option.
  18239. These filters accept the following options:
  18240. @table @option
  18241. @item commands, c
  18242. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  18243. @item filename, f
  18244. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  18245. filters.
  18246. @end table
  18247. @subsection Commands syntax
  18248. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  18249. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  18250. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  18251. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  18252. interval.
  18253. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  18254. @example
  18255. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  18256. @end example
  18257. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  18258. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  18259. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  18260. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  18261. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  18262. @var{END}.
  18263. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  18264. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  18265. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  18266. @example
  18267. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  18268. @end example
  18269. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  18270. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  18271. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  18272. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  18273. The following flags are recognized:
  18274. @table @option
  18275. @item enter
  18276. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  18277. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  18278. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  18279. current is.
  18280. @item leave
  18281. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  18282. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  18283. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  18284. current is not.
  18285. @item expr
  18286. The command @var{ARG} is interpreted as expression and result of
  18287. expression is passed as @var{ARG}.
  18288. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  18289. constants:
  18290. @table @option
  18291. @item POS
  18292. Original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  18293. for the current frame.
  18294. @item PTS
  18295. The presentation timestamp in input.
  18296. @item N
  18297. The count of the input frame for video or audio, starting from 0.
  18298. @item T
  18299. The time in seconds of the current frame.
  18300. @item TS
  18301. The start time in seconds of the current command interval.
  18302. @item TE
  18303. The end time in seconds of the current command interval.
  18304. @item TI
  18305. The interpolated time of the current command interval, TI = (T - TS) / (TE - TS).
  18306. @end table
  18307. @end table
  18308. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  18309. assumed.
  18310. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  18311. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  18312. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  18313. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  18314. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  18315. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  18316. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  18317. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  18318. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  18319. follows:
  18320. @example
  18321. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  18322. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  18323. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  18324. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  18325. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  18326. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  18327. @end example
  18328. @subsection Examples
  18329. @itemize
  18330. @item
  18331. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  18332. @example
  18333. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  18334. @end example
  18335. @item
  18336. Target a specific filter instance:
  18337. @example
  18338. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo@@my tempo 1.5',atempo@@my
  18339. @end example
  18340. @item
  18341. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  18342. @example
  18343. # show text in the interval 5-10
  18344. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  18345. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  18346. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  18347. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  18348. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  18349. [leave] hue s 1,
  18350. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  18351. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  18352. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  18353. @end example
  18354. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  18355. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  18356. @example
  18357. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  18358. @end example
  18359. @end itemize
  18360. @anchor{setpts}
  18361. @section setpts, asetpts
  18362. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  18363. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  18364. This filter accepts the following options:
  18365. @table @option
  18366. @item expr
  18367. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  18368. @end table
  18369. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  18370. constants:
  18371. @table @option
  18372. @item FRAME_RATE, FR
  18373. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  18374. @item PTS
  18375. The presentation timestamp in input
  18376. @item N
  18377. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  18378. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  18379. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  18380. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  18381. audio)
  18382. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  18383. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  18384. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  18385. The audio sample rate.
  18386. @item STARTPTS
  18387. The PTS of the first frame.
  18388. @item STARTT
  18389. the time in seconds of the first frame
  18390. @item INTERLACED
  18391. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  18392. @item T
  18393. the time in seconds of the current frame
  18394. @item POS
  18395. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  18396. for the current frame
  18397. @item PREV_INPTS
  18398. The previous input PTS.
  18399. @item PREV_INT
  18400. previous input time in seconds
  18401. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  18402. The previous output PTS.
  18403. @item PREV_OUTT
  18404. previous output time in seconds
  18405. @item RTCTIME
  18406. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  18407. instead.
  18408. @item RTCSTART
  18409. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  18410. @item TB
  18411. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  18412. @end table
  18413. @subsection Examples
  18414. @itemize
  18415. @item
  18416. Start counting PTS from zero
  18417. @example
  18418. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  18419. @end example
  18420. @item
  18421. Apply fast motion effect:
  18422. @example
  18423. setpts=0.5*PTS
  18424. @end example
  18425. @item
  18426. Apply slow motion effect:
  18427. @example
  18428. setpts=2.0*PTS
  18429. @end example
  18430. @item
  18431. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  18432. @example
  18433. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  18434. @end example
  18435. @item
  18436. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  18437. @example
  18438. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  18439. @end example
  18440. @item
  18441. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  18442. @example
  18443. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  18444. @end example
  18445. @item
  18446. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  18447. @example
  18448. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  18449. @end example
  18450. @item
  18451. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  18452. @example
  18453. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  18454. @end example
  18455. @end itemize
  18456. @section setrange
  18457. Force color range for the output video frame.
  18458. The @code{setrange} filter marks the color range property for the
  18459. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  18460. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  18461. following filters.
  18462. The filter accepts the following options:
  18463. @table @option
  18464. @item range
  18465. Available values are:
  18466. @table @samp
  18467. @item auto
  18468. Keep the same color range property.
  18469. @item unspecified, unknown
  18470. Set the color range as unspecified.
  18471. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  18472. Set the color range as limited.
  18473. @item full, pc, jpeg
  18474. Set the color range as full.
  18475. @end table
  18476. @end table
  18477. @section settb, asettb
  18478. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  18479. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  18480. It accepts the following parameters:
  18481. @table @option
  18482. @item expr, tb
  18483. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  18484. @end table
  18485. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  18486. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  18487. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  18488. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  18489. @subsection Examples
  18490. @itemize
  18491. @item
  18492. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  18493. @example
  18494. settb=expr=1/25
  18495. @end example
  18496. @item
  18497. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  18498. @example
  18499. settb=expr=0.1
  18500. @end example
  18501. @item
  18502. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  18503. @example
  18504. settb=1+0.001
  18505. @end example
  18506. @item
  18507. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  18508. @example
  18509. settb=2*intb
  18510. @end example
  18511. @item
  18512. Set the default timebase value:
  18513. @example
  18514. settb=AVTB
  18515. @end example
  18516. @end itemize
  18517. @section showcqt
  18518. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  18519. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  18520. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  18521. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  18522. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  18523. The filter accepts the following options:
  18524. @table @option
  18525. @item size, s
  18526. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  18527. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18528. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  18529. @item fps, rate, r
  18530. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  18531. @item bar_h
  18532. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  18533. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  18534. @item axis_h
  18535. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  18536. the axis height automatically.
  18537. @item sono_h
  18538. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  18539. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  18540. @item fullhd
  18541. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  18542. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  18543. @item sono_v, volume
  18544. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  18545. @table @option
  18546. @item bar_v
  18547. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  18548. @item frequency, freq, f
  18549. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18550. @item timeclamp, tc
  18551. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18552. @end table
  18553. and functions:
  18554. @table @option
  18555. @item a_weighting(f)
  18556. A-weighting of equal loudness
  18557. @item b_weighting(f)
  18558. B-weighting of equal loudness
  18559. @item c_weighting(f)
  18560. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  18561. @end table
  18562. Default value is @code{16}.
  18563. @item bar_v, volume2
  18564. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  18565. @table @option
  18566. @item sono_v
  18567. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  18568. @item frequency, freq, f
  18569. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18570. @item timeclamp, tc
  18571. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18572. @end table
  18573. and functions:
  18574. @table @option
  18575. @item a_weighting(f)
  18576. A-weighting of equal loudness
  18577. @item b_weighting(f)
  18578. B-weighting of equal loudness
  18579. @item c_weighting(f)
  18580. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  18581. @end table
  18582. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  18583. @item sono_g, gamma
  18584. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  18585. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  18586. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  18587. @item bar_g, gamma2
  18588. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  18589. @code{[1, 7]}.
  18590. @item bar_t
  18591. Specify the bargraph transparency level. Lower value makes the bargraph sharper.
  18592. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  18593. @item timeclamp, tc
  18594. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  18595. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  18596. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  18597. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  18598. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.002, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  18599. @item attack
  18600. Set attack time in seconds. The default is @code{0} (disabled). Otherwise, it
  18601. limits future samples by applying asymmetric windowing in time domain, useful
  18602. when low latency is required. Accepted range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  18603. @item basefreq
  18604. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  18605. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  18606. @item endfreq
  18607. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  18608. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  18609. @item coeffclamp
  18610. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  18611. @item tlength
  18612. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  18613. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  18614. It can contain variables:
  18615. @table @option
  18616. @item frequency, freq, f
  18617. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18618. @item timeclamp, tc
  18619. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  18620. @end table
  18621. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  18622. @item count
  18623. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  18624. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  18625. @item fcount
  18626. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  18627. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  18628. @item fontfile
  18629. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  18630. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  18631. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  18632. option instead.
  18633. @item font
  18634. Specify fontconfig pattern. This has lower priority than @var{fontfile}. The
  18635. @code{:} in the pattern may be replaced by @code{|} to avoid unnecessary
  18636. escaping.
  18637. @item fontcolor
  18638. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  18639. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  18640. @table @option
  18641. @item frequency, freq, f
  18642. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18643. @item timeclamp, tc
  18644. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18645. @end table
  18646. and functions:
  18647. @table @option
  18648. @item midi(f)
  18649. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  18650. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  18651. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  18652. @end table
  18653. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  18654. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  18655. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  18656. @item axisfile
  18657. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  18658. @var{fontcolor} option.
  18659. @item axis, text
  18660. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  18661. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  18662. Default value is @code{1}.
  18663. @item csp
  18664. Set colorspace. The accepted values are:
  18665. @table @samp
  18666. @item unspecified
  18667. Unspecified (default)
  18668. @item bt709
  18669. BT.709
  18670. @item fcc
  18671. FCC
  18672. @item bt470bg
  18673. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  18674. @item smpte170m
  18675. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  18676. @item smpte240m
  18677. SMPTE-240M
  18678. @item bt2020ncl
  18679. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  18680. @end table
  18681. @item cscheme
  18682. Set spectrogram color scheme. This is list of floating point values with format
  18683. @code{left_r|left_g|left_b|right_r|right_g|right_b}.
  18684. The default is @code{1|0.5|0|0|0.5|1}.
  18685. @end table
  18686. @subsection Examples
  18687. @itemize
  18688. @item
  18689. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  18690. @example
  18691. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  18692. @end example
  18693. @item
  18694. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  18695. @example
  18696. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  18697. @end example
  18698. @item
  18699. Playing at 1280x720:
  18700. @example
  18701. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  18702. @end example
  18703. @item
  18704. Disable sonogram display:
  18705. @example
  18706. sono_h=0
  18707. @end example
  18708. @item
  18709. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  18710. @example
  18711. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  18712. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  18713. @end example
  18714. @item
  18715. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  18716. @example
  18717. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  18718. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  18719. @end example
  18720. @item
  18721. Custom volume:
  18722. @example
  18723. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  18724. @end example
  18725. @item
  18726. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  18727. @example
  18728. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  18729. @end example
  18730. @item
  18731. Custom tlength equation:
  18732. @example
  18733. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  18734. @end example
  18735. @item
  18736. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  18737. @example
  18738. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  18739. @end example
  18740. @item
  18741. Custom font using fontconfig:
  18742. @example
  18743. font='Courier New,Monospace,mono|bold'
  18744. @end example
  18745. @item
  18746. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  18747. @example
  18748. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  18749. @end example
  18750. @end itemize
  18751. @section showfreqs
  18752. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  18753. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  18754. The filter accepts the following options:
  18755. @table @option
  18756. @item size, s
  18757. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18758. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18759. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  18760. @item mode
  18761. Set display mode.
  18762. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  18763. It accepts the following values:
  18764. @table @samp
  18765. @item line
  18766. @item bar
  18767. @item dot
  18768. @end table
  18769. Default is @code{bar}.
  18770. @item ascale
  18771. Set amplitude scale.
  18772. It accepts the following values:
  18773. @table @samp
  18774. @item lin
  18775. Linear scale.
  18776. @item sqrt
  18777. Square root scale.
  18778. @item cbrt
  18779. Cubic root scale.
  18780. @item log
  18781. Logarithmic scale.
  18782. @end table
  18783. Default is @code{log}.
  18784. @item fscale
  18785. Set frequency scale.
  18786. It accepts the following values:
  18787. @table @samp
  18788. @item lin
  18789. Linear scale.
  18790. @item log
  18791. Logarithmic scale.
  18792. @item rlog
  18793. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  18794. @end table
  18795. Default is @code{lin}.
  18796. @item win_size
  18797. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 65536.
  18798. Default is @code{2048}
  18799. @item win_func
  18800. Set windowing function.
  18801. It accepts the following values:
  18802. @table @samp
  18803. @item rect
  18804. @item bartlett
  18805. @item hanning
  18806. @item hamming
  18807. @item blackman
  18808. @item welch
  18809. @item flattop
  18810. @item bharris
  18811. @item bnuttall
  18812. @item bhann
  18813. @item sine
  18814. @item nuttall
  18815. @item lanczos
  18816. @item gauss
  18817. @item tukey
  18818. @item dolph
  18819. @item cauchy
  18820. @item parzen
  18821. @item poisson
  18822. @item bohman
  18823. @end table
  18824. Default is @code{hanning}.
  18825. @item overlap
  18826. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  18827. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  18828. @item averaging
  18829. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  18830. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  18831. @item colors
  18832. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  18833. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  18834. by white color.
  18835. @item cmode
  18836. Set channel display mode.
  18837. It accepts the following values:
  18838. @table @samp
  18839. @item combined
  18840. @item separate
  18841. @end table
  18842. Default is @code{combined}.
  18843. @item minamp
  18844. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  18845. @end table
  18846. @section showspatial
  18847. Convert stereo input audio to a video output, representing the spatial relationship
  18848. between two channels.
  18849. The filter accepts the following options:
  18850. @table @option
  18851. @item size, s
  18852. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18853. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18854. Default value is @code{512x512}.
  18855. @item win_size
  18856. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  18857. @item win_func
  18858. Set window function.
  18859. It accepts the following values:
  18860. @table @samp
  18861. @item rect
  18862. @item bartlett
  18863. @item hann
  18864. @item hanning
  18865. @item hamming
  18866. @item blackman
  18867. @item welch
  18868. @item flattop
  18869. @item bharris
  18870. @item bnuttall
  18871. @item bhann
  18872. @item sine
  18873. @item nuttall
  18874. @item lanczos
  18875. @item gauss
  18876. @item tukey
  18877. @item dolph
  18878. @item cauchy
  18879. @item parzen
  18880. @item poisson
  18881. @item bohman
  18882. @end table
  18883. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18884. @item overlap
  18885. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  18886. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  18887. window function currently used.
  18888. @end table
  18889. @anchor{showspectrum}
  18890. @section showspectrum
  18891. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  18892. spectrum.
  18893. The filter accepts the following options:
  18894. @table @option
  18895. @item size, s
  18896. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18897. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18898. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  18899. @item slide
  18900. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  18901. It accepts the following values:
  18902. @table @samp
  18903. @item replace
  18904. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  18905. @item scroll
  18906. the samples scroll from right to left
  18907. @item fullframe
  18908. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  18909. @item rscroll
  18910. the samples scroll from left to right
  18911. @end table
  18912. Default value is @code{replace}.
  18913. @item mode
  18914. Specify display mode.
  18915. It accepts the following values:
  18916. @table @samp
  18917. @item combined
  18918. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18919. @item separate
  18920. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18921. @end table
  18922. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18923. @item color
  18924. Specify display color mode.
  18925. It accepts the following values:
  18926. @table @samp
  18927. @item channel
  18928. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18929. @item intensity
  18930. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18931. @item rainbow
  18932. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18933. @item moreland
  18934. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18935. @item nebulae
  18936. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18937. @item fire
  18938. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18939. @item fiery
  18940. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18941. @item fruit
  18942. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18943. @item cool
  18944. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18945. @item magma
  18946. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18947. @item green
  18948. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18949. @item viridis
  18950. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18951. @item plasma
  18952. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18953. @item cividis
  18954. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18955. @item terrain
  18956. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18957. @end table
  18958. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  18959. @item scale
  18960. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18961. It accepts the following values:
  18962. @table @samp
  18963. @item lin
  18964. linear
  18965. @item sqrt
  18966. square root, default
  18967. @item cbrt
  18968. cubic root
  18969. @item log
  18970. logarithmic
  18971. @item 4thrt
  18972. 4th root
  18973. @item 5thrt
  18974. 5th root
  18975. @end table
  18976. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  18977. @item fscale
  18978. Specify frequency scale.
  18979. It accepts the following values:
  18980. @table @samp
  18981. @item lin
  18982. linear
  18983. @item log
  18984. logarithmic
  18985. @end table
  18986. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18987. @item saturation
  18988. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18989. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18990. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18991. Default value is @code{1}.
  18992. @item win_func
  18993. Set window function.
  18994. It accepts the following values:
  18995. @table @samp
  18996. @item rect
  18997. @item bartlett
  18998. @item hann
  18999. @item hanning
  19000. @item hamming
  19001. @item blackman
  19002. @item welch
  19003. @item flattop
  19004. @item bharris
  19005. @item bnuttall
  19006. @item bhann
  19007. @item sine
  19008. @item nuttall
  19009. @item lanczos
  19010. @item gauss
  19011. @item tukey
  19012. @item dolph
  19013. @item cauchy
  19014. @item parzen
  19015. @item poisson
  19016. @item bohman
  19017. @end table
  19018. Default value is @code{hann}.
  19019. @item orientation
  19020. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  19021. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  19022. @item overlap
  19023. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  19024. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  19025. window function currently used.
  19026. @item gain
  19027. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  19028. Default value is @code{1}.
  19029. @item data
  19030. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  19031. @item rotation
  19032. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  19033. Default value is @code{0}.
  19034. @item start
  19035. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  19036. @item stop
  19037. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  19038. @item fps
  19039. Set upper frame rate limit. Default is @code{auto}, unlimited.
  19040. @item legend
  19041. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is disabled.
  19042. @end table
  19043. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  19044. section.
  19045. @subsection Examples
  19046. @itemize
  19047. @item
  19048. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  19049. @example
  19050. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  19051. @end example
  19052. @item
  19053. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  19054. @example
  19055. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  19056. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  19057. @end example
  19058. @end itemize
  19059. @section showspectrumpic
  19060. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  19061. spectrum.
  19062. The filter accepts the following options:
  19063. @table @option
  19064. @item size, s
  19065. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  19066. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  19067. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  19068. @item mode
  19069. Specify display mode.
  19070. It accepts the following values:
  19071. @table @samp
  19072. @item combined
  19073. all channels are displayed in the same row
  19074. @item separate
  19075. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  19076. @end table
  19077. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  19078. @item color
  19079. Specify display color mode.
  19080. It accepts the following values:
  19081. @table @samp
  19082. @item channel
  19083. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  19084. @item intensity
  19085. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  19086. @item rainbow
  19087. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  19088. @item moreland
  19089. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  19090. @item nebulae
  19091. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  19092. @item fire
  19093. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  19094. @item fiery
  19095. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  19096. @item fruit
  19097. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  19098. @item cool
  19099. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  19100. @item magma
  19101. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  19102. @item green
  19103. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  19104. @item viridis
  19105. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  19106. @item plasma
  19107. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  19108. @item cividis
  19109. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  19110. @item terrain
  19111. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  19112. @end table
  19113. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  19114. @item scale
  19115. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  19116. It accepts the following values:
  19117. @table @samp
  19118. @item lin
  19119. linear
  19120. @item sqrt
  19121. square root, default
  19122. @item cbrt
  19123. cubic root
  19124. @item log
  19125. logarithmic
  19126. @item 4thrt
  19127. 4th root
  19128. @item 5thrt
  19129. 5th root
  19130. @end table
  19131. Default value is @samp{log}.
  19132. @item fscale
  19133. Specify frequency scale.
  19134. It accepts the following values:
  19135. @table @samp
  19136. @item lin
  19137. linear
  19138. @item log
  19139. logarithmic
  19140. @end table
  19141. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  19142. @item saturation
  19143. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  19144. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  19145. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  19146. Default value is @code{1}.
  19147. @item win_func
  19148. Set window function.
  19149. It accepts the following values:
  19150. @table @samp
  19151. @item rect
  19152. @item bartlett
  19153. @item hann
  19154. @item hanning
  19155. @item hamming
  19156. @item blackman
  19157. @item welch
  19158. @item flattop
  19159. @item bharris
  19160. @item bnuttall
  19161. @item bhann
  19162. @item sine
  19163. @item nuttall
  19164. @item lanczos
  19165. @item gauss
  19166. @item tukey
  19167. @item dolph
  19168. @item cauchy
  19169. @item parzen
  19170. @item poisson
  19171. @item bohman
  19172. @end table
  19173. Default value is @code{hann}.
  19174. @item orientation
  19175. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  19176. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  19177. @item gain
  19178. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  19179. Default value is @code{1}.
  19180. @item legend
  19181. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  19182. @item rotation
  19183. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  19184. Default value is @code{0}.
  19185. @item start
  19186. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  19187. @item stop
  19188. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  19189. @end table
  19190. @subsection Examples
  19191. @itemize
  19192. @item
  19193. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  19194. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  19195. @example
  19196. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  19197. @end example
  19198. @end itemize
  19199. @section showvolume
  19200. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  19201. The filter accepts the following options:
  19202. @table @option
  19203. @item rate, r
  19204. Set video rate.
  19205. @item b
  19206. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  19207. @item w
  19208. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  19209. @item h
  19210. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  19211. @item f
  19212. Set fade, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  19213. @item c
  19214. Set volume color expression.
  19215. The expression can use the following variables:
  19216. @table @option
  19217. @item VOLUME
  19218. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  19219. @item PEAK
  19220. Current peak.
  19221. @item CHANNEL
  19222. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  19223. @end table
  19224. @item t
  19225. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  19226. @item v
  19227. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  19228. @item o
  19229. Set orientation, can be horizontal: @code{h} or vertical: @code{v},
  19230. default is @code{h}.
  19231. @item s
  19232. Set step size, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  19233. step is disabled.
  19234. @item p
  19235. Set background opacity, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.
  19236. @item m
  19237. Set metering mode, can be peak: @code{p} or rms: @code{r},
  19238. default is @code{p}.
  19239. @item ds
  19240. Set display scale, can be linear: @code{lin} or log: @code{log},
  19241. default is @code{lin}.
  19242. @item dm
  19243. In second.
  19244. If set to > 0., display a line for the max level
  19245. in the previous seconds.
  19246. default is disabled: @code{0.}
  19247. @item dmc
  19248. The color of the max line. Use when @code{dm} option is set to > 0.
  19249. default is: @code{orange}
  19250. @end table
  19251. @section showwaves
  19252. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  19253. The filter accepts the following options:
  19254. @table @option
  19255. @item size, s
  19256. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  19257. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  19258. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  19259. @item mode
  19260. Set display mode.
  19261. Available values are:
  19262. @table @samp
  19263. @item point
  19264. Draw a point for each sample.
  19265. @item line
  19266. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  19267. @item p2p
  19268. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  19269. @item cline
  19270. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  19271. @end table
  19272. Default value is @code{point}.
  19273. @item n
  19274. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  19275. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  19276. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  19277. is not explicitly specified.
  19278. @item rate, r
  19279. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  19280. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  19281. @item split_channels
  19282. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  19283. @item colors
  19284. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  19285. @item scale
  19286. Set amplitude scale.
  19287. Available values are:
  19288. @table @samp
  19289. @item lin
  19290. Linear.
  19291. @item log
  19292. Logarithmic.
  19293. @item sqrt
  19294. Square root.
  19295. @item cbrt
  19296. Cubic root.
  19297. @end table
  19298. Default is linear.
  19299. @item draw
  19300. Set the draw mode. This is mostly useful to set for high @var{n}.
  19301. Available values are:
  19302. @table @samp
  19303. @item scale
  19304. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  19305. @item full
  19306. Draw every sample directly.
  19307. @end table
  19308. Default value is @code{scale}.
  19309. @end table
  19310. @subsection Examples
  19311. @itemize
  19312. @item
  19313. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  19314. at the same time:
  19315. @example
  19316. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  19317. @end example
  19318. @item
  19319. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  19320. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  19321. @example
  19322. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  19323. @end example
  19324. @end itemize
  19325. @section showwavespic
  19326. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  19327. The filter accepts the following options:
  19328. @table @option
  19329. @item size, s
  19330. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  19331. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  19332. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  19333. @item split_channels
  19334. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  19335. @item colors
  19336. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  19337. @item scale
  19338. Set amplitude scale.
  19339. Available values are:
  19340. @table @samp
  19341. @item lin
  19342. Linear.
  19343. @item log
  19344. Logarithmic.
  19345. @item sqrt
  19346. Square root.
  19347. @item cbrt
  19348. Cubic root.
  19349. @end table
  19350. Default is linear.
  19351. @item draw
  19352. Set the draw mode.
  19353. Available values are:
  19354. @table @samp
  19355. @item scale
  19356. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  19357. @item full
  19358. Draw every sample directly.
  19359. @end table
  19360. Default value is @code{scale}.
  19361. @end table
  19362. @subsection Examples
  19363. @itemize
  19364. @item
  19365. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  19366. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  19367. @example
  19368. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  19369. @end example
  19370. @end itemize
  19371. @section sidedata, asidedata
  19372. Delete frame side data, or select frames based on it.
  19373. This filter accepts the following options:
  19374. @table @option
  19375. @item mode
  19376. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  19377. Can be one of the following:
  19378. @table @samp
  19379. @item select
  19380. Select every frame with side data of @code{type}.
  19381. @item delete
  19382. Delete side data of @code{type}. If @code{type} is not set, delete all side
  19383. data in the frame.
  19384. @end table
  19385. @item type
  19386. Set side data type used with all modes. Must be set for @code{select} mode. For
  19387. the list of frame side data types, refer to the @code{AVFrameSideDataType} enum
  19388. in @file{libavutil/frame.h}. For example, to choose
  19389. @code{AV_FRAME_DATA_PANSCAN} side data, you must specify @code{PANSCAN}.
  19390. @end table
  19391. @section spectrumsynth
  19392. Synthesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  19393. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  19394. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  19395. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  19396. This filter is primarily created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  19397. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  19398. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  19399. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  19400. it's just recreated from random noise.
  19401. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  19402. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  19403. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  19404. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  19405. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  19406. The filter accepts the following options:
  19407. @table @option
  19408. @item sample_rate
  19409. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  19410. spectrum was generated may differ.
  19411. @item channels
  19412. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  19413. @item scale
  19414. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  19415. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  19416. @item slide
  19417. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  19418. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  19419. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  19420. @item win_func
  19421. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  19422. @item overlap
  19423. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  19424. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  19425. @item orientation
  19426. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  19427. Default is @code{vertical}.
  19428. @end table
  19429. @subsection Examples
  19430. @itemize
  19431. @item
  19432. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  19433. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  19434. @example
  19435. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  19436. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  19437. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  19438. @end example
  19439. @end itemize
  19440. @section split, asplit
  19441. Split input into several identical outputs.
  19442. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  19443. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  19444. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  19445. @subsection Examples
  19446. @itemize
  19447. @item
  19448. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  19449. @example
  19450. [in] split [out0][out1]
  19451. @end example
  19452. @item
  19453. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  19454. outputs, like in:
  19455. @example
  19456. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  19457. @end example
  19458. @item
  19459. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  19460. one padded:
  19461. @example
  19462. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  19463. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  19464. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  19465. @end example
  19466. @item
  19467. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  19468. @example
  19469. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  19470. @end example
  19471. @end itemize
  19472. @section zmq, azmq
  19473. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  19474. filters in the filtergraph.
  19475. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  19476. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  19477. audio filters. Both are capable to send messages to any filter type.
  19478. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  19479. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  19480. For more information about libzmq see:
  19481. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  19482. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  19483. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  19484. @option{bind_address} (or the abbreviation "@option{b}") option.
  19485. Default value of this option is @file{tcp://localhost:5555}. You may
  19486. want to alter this value to your needs, but do not forget to escape any
  19487. ':' signs (see @ref{filtergraph escaping}).
  19488. The received message must be in the form:
  19489. @example
  19490. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  19491. @end example
  19492. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  19493. the filter class or a specific filter instance name. The default
  19494. filter instance name uses the pattern @samp{Parsed_<filter_name>_<index>},
  19495. but you can override this by using the @samp{filter_name@@id} syntax
  19496. (see @ref{Filtergraph syntax}).
  19497. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  19498. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  19499. given @var{COMMAND}.
  19500. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  19501. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  19502. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  19503. @example
  19504. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  19505. @var{MESSAGE}
  19506. @end example
  19507. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  19508. @subsection Examples
  19509. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  19510. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  19511. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}.
  19512. In this example the last overlay filter has an instance name. All other
  19513. filters will have default instance names.
  19514. @example
  19515. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  19516. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  19517. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  19518. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  19519. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  19520. [bg+l][r] overlay@@my=x=100 "
  19521. @end example
  19522. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  19523. command can be used:
  19524. @example
  19525. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  19526. @end example
  19527. To change the right side:
  19528. @example
  19529. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  19530. @end example
  19531. To change the position of the right side:
  19532. @example
  19533. echo overlay@@my x 150 | tools/zmqsend
  19534. @end example
  19535. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  19536. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  19537. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  19538. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  19539. @section amovie
  19540. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  19541. stream by default.
  19542. @anchor{movie}
  19543. @section movie
  19544. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  19545. It accepts the following parameters:
  19546. @table @option
  19547. @item filename
  19548. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  19549. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  19550. @item format_name, f
  19551. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  19552. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  19553. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  19554. @item seek_point, sp
  19555. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  19556. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  19557. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  19558. postfix. The default value is "0".
  19559. @item streams, s
  19560. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  19561. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  19562. same order. The syntax is explained in the @ref{Stream specifiers,,"Stream specifiers"
  19563. section in the ffmpeg manual,ffmpeg}. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  19564. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  19565. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  19566. @item stream_index, si
  19567. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  19568. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  19569. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  19570. audio instead of video.
  19571. @item loop
  19572. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  19573. If the value is 0, the stream will be looped infinitely.
  19574. Default value is "1".
  19575. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  19576. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  19577. @item discontinuity
  19578. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  19579. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  19580. timestamps.
  19581. @end table
  19582. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  19583. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  19584. @example
  19585. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  19586. ^
  19587. |
  19588. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  19589. @end example
  19590. @subsection Examples
  19591. @itemize
  19592. @item
  19593. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  19594. on top of the input labelled "in":
  19595. @example
  19596. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  19597. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  19598. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  19599. @end example
  19600. @item
  19601. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  19602. labelled "in":
  19603. @example
  19604. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  19605. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  19606. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  19607. @end example
  19608. @item
  19609. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  19610. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  19611. connected to the pad named "audio":
  19612. @example
  19613. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  19614. @end example
  19615. @end itemize
  19616. @subsection Commands
  19617. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  19618. @table @option
  19619. @item seek
  19620. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  19621. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  19622. @itemize
  19623. @item
  19624. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  19625. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  19626. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  19627. @item
  19628. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  19629. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  19630. @item
  19631. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  19632. @end itemize
  19633. @item get_duration
  19634. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  19635. @end table
  19636. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES